Coverage Report

Created: 2025-07-11 06:05

/src/libgit2/deps/pcre/pcre_compile.c
Line
Count
Source (jump to first uncovered line)
1
/*************************************************
2
*      Perl-Compatible Regular Expressions       *
3
*************************************************/
4
5
/* PCRE is a library of functions to support regular expressions whose syntax
6
and semantics are as close as possible to those of the Perl 5 language.
7
8
                       Written by Philip Hazel
9
           Copyright (c) 1997-2021 University of Cambridge
10
11
-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
12
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
13
modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:
14
15
    * Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice,
16
      this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
17
18
    * Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
19
      notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
20
      documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
21
22
    * Neither the name of the University of Cambridge nor the names of its
23
      contributors may be used to endorse or promote products derived from
24
      this software without specific prior written permission.
25
26
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS "AS IS"
27
AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
28
IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
29
ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT OWNER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE
30
LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR
31
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF
32
SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS
33
INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN
34
CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)
35
ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
36
POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
37
-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
38
*/
39
40
41
/* This module contains the external function pcre_compile(), along with
42
supporting internal functions that are not used by other modules. */
43
44
45
#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
46
#include "config.h"
47
#endif
48
49
0
#define NLBLOCK cd             /* Block containing newline information */
50
#define PSSTART start_pattern  /* Field containing pattern start */
51
0
#define PSEND   end_pattern    /* Field containing pattern end */
52
53
#include "pcre_internal.h"
54
55
56
/* When PCRE_DEBUG is defined, we need the pcre(16|32)_printint() function, which
57
is also used by pcretest. PCRE_DEBUG is not defined when building a production
58
library. We do not need to select pcre16_printint.c specially, because the
59
COMPILE_PCREx macro will already be appropriately set. */
60
61
#ifdef PCRE_DEBUG
62
/* pcre_printint.c should not include any headers */
63
#define PCRE_INCLUDED
64
#include "pcre_printint.c"
65
#undef PCRE_INCLUDED
66
#endif
67
68
69
/* Macro for setting individual bits in class bitmaps. */
70
71
0
#define SETBIT(a,b) a[(b)/8] |= (1U << ((b)&7))
72
73
/* Maximum length value to check against when making sure that the integer that
74
holds the compiled pattern length does not overflow. We make it a bit less than
75
INT_MAX to allow for adding in group terminating bytes, so that we don't have
76
to check them every time. */
77
78
0
#define OFLOW_MAX (INT_MAX - 20)
79
80
/* Definitions to allow mutual recursion */
81
82
static int
83
  add_list_to_class(pcre_uint8 *, pcre_uchar **, int, compile_data *,
84
    const pcre_uint32 *, unsigned int);
85
86
static BOOL
87
  compile_regex(int, pcre_uchar **, const pcre_uchar **, int *, BOOL, BOOL, int, int,
88
    pcre_uint32 *, pcre_int32 *, pcre_uint32 *, pcre_int32 *, branch_chain *,
89
    compile_data *, int *);
90
91
92
93
/*************************************************
94
*      Code parameters and static tables         *
95
*************************************************/
96
97
/* This value specifies the size of stack workspace that is used during the
98
first pre-compile phase that determines how much memory is required. The regex
99
is partly compiled into this space, but the compiled parts are discarded as
100
soon as they can be, so that hopefully there will never be an overrun. The code
101
does, however, check for an overrun. The largest amount I've seen used is 218,
102
so this number is very generous.
103
104
The same workspace is used during the second, actual compile phase for
105
remembering forward references to groups so that they can be filled in at the
106
end. Each entry in this list occupies LINK_SIZE bytes, so even when LINK_SIZE
107
is 4 there is plenty of room for most patterns. However, the memory can get
108
filled up by repetitions of forward references, for example patterns like
109
/(?1){0,1999}(b)/, and one user did hit the limit. The code has been changed so
110
that the workspace is expanded using malloc() in this situation. The value
111
below is therefore a minimum, and we put a maximum on it for safety. The
112
minimum is now also defined in terms of LINK_SIZE so that the use of malloc()
113
kicks in at the same number of forward references in all cases. */
114
115
0
#define COMPILE_WORK_SIZE (2048*LINK_SIZE)
116
0
#define COMPILE_WORK_SIZE_MAX (100*COMPILE_WORK_SIZE)
117
118
/* This value determines the size of the initial vector that is used for
119
remembering named groups during the pre-compile. It is allocated on the stack,
120
but if it is too small, it is expanded using malloc(), in a similar way to the
121
workspace. The value is the number of slots in the list. */
122
123
0
#define NAMED_GROUP_LIST_SIZE  20
124
125
/* The overrun tests check for a slightly smaller size so that they detect the
126
overrun before it actually does run off the end of the data block. */
127
128
0
#define WORK_SIZE_SAFETY_MARGIN (100)
129
130
/* Private flags added to firstchar and reqchar. */
131
132
0
#define REQ_CASELESS    (1U << 0)        /* Indicates caselessness */
133
0
#define REQ_VARY        (1U << 1)        /* Reqchar followed non-literal item */
134
/* Negative values for the firstchar and reqchar flags */
135
0
#define REQ_UNSET       (-2)
136
0
#define REQ_NONE        (-1)
137
138
/* Repeated character flags. */
139
140
#define UTF_LENGTH     0x10000000l      /* The char contains its length. */
141
142
/* Table for handling escaped characters in the range '0'-'z'. Positive returns
143
are simple data values; negative values are for special things like \d and so
144
on. Zero means further processing is needed (for things like \x), or the escape
145
is invalid. */
146
147
#ifndef EBCDIC
148
149
/* This is the "normal" table for ASCII systems or for EBCDIC systems running
150
in UTF-8 mode. */
151
152
static const short int escapes[] = {
153
     0,                       0,
154
     0,                       0,
155
     0,                       0,
156
     0,                       0,
157
     0,                       0,
158
     CHAR_COLON,              CHAR_SEMICOLON,
159
     CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN,     CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN,
160
     CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN,  CHAR_QUESTION_MARK,
161
     CHAR_COMMERCIAL_AT,      -ESC_A,
162
     -ESC_B,                  -ESC_C,
163
     -ESC_D,                  -ESC_E,
164
     0,                       -ESC_G,
165
     -ESC_H,                  0,
166
     0,                       -ESC_K,
167
     0,                       0,
168
     -ESC_N,                  0,
169
     -ESC_P,                  -ESC_Q,
170
     -ESC_R,                  -ESC_S,
171
     0,                       0,
172
     -ESC_V,                  -ESC_W,
173
     -ESC_X,                  0,
174
     -ESC_Z,                  CHAR_LEFT_SQUARE_BRACKET,
175
     CHAR_BACKSLASH,          CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET,
176
     CHAR_CIRCUMFLEX_ACCENT,  CHAR_UNDERSCORE,
177
     CHAR_GRAVE_ACCENT,       ESC_a,
178
     -ESC_b,                  0,
179
     -ESC_d,                  ESC_e,
180
     ESC_f,                   0,
181
     -ESC_h,                  0,
182
     0,                       -ESC_k,
183
     0,                       0,
184
     ESC_n,                   0,
185
     -ESC_p,                  0,
186
     ESC_r,                   -ESC_s,
187
     ESC_tee,                 0,
188
     -ESC_v,                  -ESC_w,
189
     0,                       0,
190
     -ESC_z
191
};
192
193
#else
194
195
/* This is the "abnormal" table for EBCDIC systems without UTF-8 support. */
196
197
static const short int escapes[] = {
198
/*  48 */     0,     0,      0,     '.',    '<',   '(',    '+',    '|',
199
/*  50 */   '&',     0,      0,       0,      0,     0,      0,      0,
200
/*  58 */     0,     0,    '!',     '$',    '*',   ')',    ';',    '~',
201
/*  60 */   '-',   '/',      0,       0,      0,     0,      0,      0,
202
/*  68 */     0,     0,    '|',     ',',    '%',   '_',    '>',    '?',
203
/*  70 */     0,     0,      0,       0,      0,     0,      0,      0,
204
/*  78 */     0,   '`',    ':',     '#',    '@',  '\'',    '=',    '"',
205
/*  80 */     0, ESC_a, -ESC_b,       0, -ESC_d, ESC_e,  ESC_f,      0,
206
/*  88 */-ESC_h,     0,      0,     '{',      0,     0,      0,      0,
207
/*  90 */     0,     0, -ESC_k,       0,      0, ESC_n,      0, -ESC_p,
208
/*  98 */     0, ESC_r,      0,     '}',      0,     0,      0,      0,
209
/*  A0 */     0,   '~', -ESC_s, ESC_tee,      0,-ESC_v, -ESC_w,      0,
210
/*  A8 */     0,-ESC_z,      0,       0,      0,   '[',      0,      0,
211
/*  B0 */     0,     0,      0,       0,      0,     0,      0,      0,
212
/*  B8 */     0,     0,      0,       0,      0,   ']',    '=',    '-',
213
/*  C0 */   '{',-ESC_A, -ESC_B,  -ESC_C, -ESC_D,-ESC_E,      0, -ESC_G,
214
/*  C8 */-ESC_H,     0,      0,       0,      0,     0,      0,      0,
215
/*  D0 */   '}',     0, -ESC_K,       0,      0,-ESC_N,      0, -ESC_P,
216
/*  D8 */-ESC_Q,-ESC_R,      0,       0,      0,     0,      0,      0,
217
/*  E0 */  '\\',     0, -ESC_S,       0,      0,-ESC_V, -ESC_W, -ESC_X,
218
/*  E8 */     0,-ESC_Z,      0,       0,      0,     0,      0,      0,
219
/*  F0 */     0,     0,      0,       0,      0,     0,      0,      0,
220
/*  F8 */     0,     0,      0,       0,      0,     0,      0,      0
221
};
222
223
/* We also need a table of characters that may follow \c in an EBCDIC
224
environment for characters 0-31. */
225
226
static unsigned char ebcdic_escape_c[] = "@ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ[\\]^_";
227
228
#endif
229
230
231
/* Table of special "verbs" like (*PRUNE). This is a short table, so it is
232
searched linearly. Put all the names into a single string, in order to reduce
233
the number of relocations when a shared library is dynamically linked. The
234
string is built from string macros so that it works in UTF-8 mode on EBCDIC
235
platforms. */
236
237
typedef struct verbitem {
238
  int   len;                 /* Length of verb name */
239
  int   op;                  /* Op when no arg, or -1 if arg mandatory */
240
  int   op_arg;              /* Op when arg present, or -1 if not allowed */
241
} verbitem;
242
243
static const char verbnames[] =
244
  "\0"                       /* Empty name is a shorthand for MARK */
245
  STRING_MARK0
246
  STRING_ACCEPT0
247
  STRING_COMMIT0
248
  STRING_F0
249
  STRING_FAIL0
250
  STRING_PRUNE0
251
  STRING_SKIP0
252
  STRING_THEN;
253
254
static const verbitem verbs[] = {
255
  { 0, -1,        OP_MARK },
256
  { 4, -1,        OP_MARK },
257
  { 6, OP_ACCEPT, -1 },
258
  { 6, OP_COMMIT, -1 },
259
  { 1, OP_FAIL,   -1 },
260
  { 4, OP_FAIL,   -1 },
261
  { 5, OP_PRUNE,  OP_PRUNE_ARG },
262
  { 4, OP_SKIP,   OP_SKIP_ARG  },
263
  { 4, OP_THEN,   OP_THEN_ARG  }
264
};
265
266
static const int verbcount = sizeof(verbs)/sizeof(verbitem);
267
268
269
/* Substitutes for [[:<:]] and [[:>:]], which mean start and end of word in
270
another regex library. */
271
272
static const pcre_uchar sub_start_of_word[] = {
273
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_b, CHAR_LEFT_PARENTHESIS, CHAR_QUESTION_MARK,
274
  CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN, CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_w, CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS, '\0' };
275
276
static const pcre_uchar sub_end_of_word[] = {
277
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_b, CHAR_LEFT_PARENTHESIS, CHAR_QUESTION_MARK,
278
  CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN, CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN, CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_w,
279
  CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS, '\0' };
280
281
282
/* Tables of names of POSIX character classes and their lengths. The names are
283
now all in a single string, to reduce the number of relocations when a shared
284
library is dynamically loaded. The list of lengths is terminated by a zero
285
length entry. The first three must be alpha, lower, upper, as this is assumed
286
for handling case independence. The indices for graph, print, and punct are
287
needed, so identify them. */
288
289
static const char posix_names[] =
290
  STRING_alpha0 STRING_lower0 STRING_upper0 STRING_alnum0
291
  STRING_ascii0 STRING_blank0 STRING_cntrl0 STRING_digit0
292
  STRING_graph0 STRING_print0 STRING_punct0 STRING_space0
293
  STRING_word0  STRING_xdigit;
294
295
static const pcre_uint8 posix_name_lengths[] = {
296
  5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 4, 6, 0 };
297
298
#define PC_GRAPH  8
299
#define PC_PRINT  9
300
#define PC_PUNCT 10
301
302
303
/* Table of class bit maps for each POSIX class. Each class is formed from a
304
base map, with an optional addition or removal of another map. Then, for some
305
classes, there is some additional tweaking: for [:blank:] the vertical space
306
characters are removed, and for [:alpha:] and [:alnum:] the underscore
307
character is removed. The triples in the table consist of the base map offset,
308
second map offset or -1 if no second map, and a non-negative value for map
309
addition or a negative value for map subtraction (if there are two maps). The
310
absolute value of the third field has these meanings: 0 => no tweaking, 1 =>
311
remove vertical space characters, 2 => remove underscore. */
312
313
static const int posix_class_maps[] = {
314
  cbit_word,  cbit_digit, -2,             /* alpha */
315
  cbit_lower, -1,          0,             /* lower */
316
  cbit_upper, -1,          0,             /* upper */
317
  cbit_word,  -1,          2,             /* alnum - word without underscore */
318
  cbit_print, cbit_cntrl,  0,             /* ascii */
319
  cbit_space, -1,          1,             /* blank - a GNU extension */
320
  cbit_cntrl, -1,          0,             /* cntrl */
321
  cbit_digit, -1,          0,             /* digit */
322
  cbit_graph, -1,          0,             /* graph */
323
  cbit_print, -1,          0,             /* print */
324
  cbit_punct, -1,          0,             /* punct */
325
  cbit_space, -1,          0,             /* space */
326
  cbit_word,  -1,          0,             /* word - a Perl extension */
327
  cbit_xdigit,-1,          0              /* xdigit */
328
};
329
330
/* Table of substitutes for \d etc when PCRE_UCP is set. They are replaced by
331
Unicode property escapes. */
332
333
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
334
static const pcre_uchar string_PNd[]  = {
335
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_P, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
336
  CHAR_N, CHAR_d, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
337
static const pcre_uchar string_pNd[]  = {
338
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_p, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
339
  CHAR_N, CHAR_d, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
340
static const pcre_uchar string_PXsp[] = {
341
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_P, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
342
  CHAR_X, CHAR_s, CHAR_p, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
343
static const pcre_uchar string_pXsp[] = {
344
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_p, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
345
  CHAR_X, CHAR_s, CHAR_p, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
346
static const pcre_uchar string_PXwd[] = {
347
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_P, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
348
  CHAR_X, CHAR_w, CHAR_d, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
349
static const pcre_uchar string_pXwd[] = {
350
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_p, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
351
  CHAR_X, CHAR_w, CHAR_d, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
352
353
static const pcre_uchar *substitutes[] = {
354
  string_PNd,           /* \D */
355
  string_pNd,           /* \d */
356
  string_PXsp,          /* \S */   /* Xsp is Perl space, but from 8.34, Perl */
357
  string_pXsp,          /* \s */   /* space and POSIX space are the same. */
358
  string_PXwd,          /* \W */
359
  string_pXwd           /* \w */
360
};
361
362
/* The POSIX class substitutes must be in the order of the POSIX class names,
363
defined above, and there are both positive and negative cases. NULL means no
364
general substitute of a Unicode property escape (\p or \P). However, for some
365
POSIX classes (e.g. graph, print, punct) a special property code is compiled
366
directly. */
367
368
static const pcre_uchar string_pL[] =   {
369
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_p, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
370
  CHAR_L, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
371
static const pcre_uchar string_pLl[] =  {
372
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_p, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
373
  CHAR_L, CHAR_l, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
374
static const pcre_uchar string_pLu[] =  {
375
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_p, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
376
  CHAR_L, CHAR_u, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
377
static const pcre_uchar string_pXan[] = {
378
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_p, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
379
  CHAR_X, CHAR_a, CHAR_n, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
380
static const pcre_uchar string_h[] =    {
381
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_h, '\0' };
382
static const pcre_uchar string_pXps[] = {
383
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_p, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
384
  CHAR_X, CHAR_p, CHAR_s, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
385
static const pcre_uchar string_PL[] =   {
386
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_P, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
387
  CHAR_L, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
388
static const pcre_uchar string_PLl[] =  {
389
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_P, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
390
  CHAR_L, CHAR_l, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
391
static const pcre_uchar string_PLu[] =  {
392
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_P, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
393
  CHAR_L, CHAR_u, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
394
static const pcre_uchar string_PXan[] = {
395
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_P, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
396
  CHAR_X, CHAR_a, CHAR_n, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
397
static const pcre_uchar string_H[] =    {
398
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_H, '\0' };
399
static const pcre_uchar string_PXps[] = {
400
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_P, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
401
  CHAR_X, CHAR_p, CHAR_s, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
402
403
static const pcre_uchar *posix_substitutes[] = {
404
  string_pL,            /* alpha */
405
  string_pLl,           /* lower */
406
  string_pLu,           /* upper */
407
  string_pXan,          /* alnum */
408
  NULL,                 /* ascii */
409
  string_h,             /* blank */
410
  NULL,                 /* cntrl */
411
  string_pNd,           /* digit */
412
  NULL,                 /* graph */
413
  NULL,                 /* print */
414
  NULL,                 /* punct */
415
  string_pXps,          /* space */   /* Xps is POSIX space, but from 8.34 */
416
  string_pXwd,          /* word  */   /* Perl and POSIX space are the same */
417
  NULL,                 /* xdigit */
418
  /* Negated cases */
419
  string_PL,            /* ^alpha */
420
  string_PLl,           /* ^lower */
421
  string_PLu,           /* ^upper */
422
  string_PXan,          /* ^alnum */
423
  NULL,                 /* ^ascii */
424
  string_H,             /* ^blank */
425
  NULL,                 /* ^cntrl */
426
  string_PNd,           /* ^digit */
427
  NULL,                 /* ^graph */
428
  NULL,                 /* ^print */
429
  NULL,                 /* ^punct */
430
  string_PXps,          /* ^space */  /* Xps is POSIX space, but from 8.34 */
431
  string_PXwd,          /* ^word */   /* Perl and POSIX space are the same */
432
  NULL                  /* ^xdigit */
433
};
434
#define POSIX_SUBSIZE (sizeof(posix_substitutes) / sizeof(pcre_uchar *))
435
#endif
436
437
#define STRING(a)  # a
438
#define XSTRING(s) STRING(s)
439
440
/* The texts of compile-time error messages. These are "char *" because they
441
are passed to the outside world. Do not ever re-use any error number, because
442
they are documented. Always add a new error instead. Messages marked DEAD below
443
are no longer used. This used to be a table of strings, but in order to reduce
444
the number of relocations needed when a shared library is loaded dynamically,
445
it is now one long string. We cannot use a table of offsets, because the
446
lengths of inserts such as XSTRING(MAX_NAME_SIZE) are not known. Instead, we
447
simply count through to the one we want - this isn't a performance issue
448
because these strings are used only when there is a compilation error.
449
450
Each substring ends with \0 to insert a null character. This includes the final
451
substring, so that the whole string ends with \0\0, which can be detected when
452
counting through. */
453
454
static const char error_texts[] =
455
  "no error\0"
456
  "\\ at end of pattern\0"
457
  "\\c at end of pattern\0"
458
  "unrecognized character follows \\\0"
459
  "numbers out of order in {} quantifier\0"
460
  /* 5 */
461
  "number too big in {} quantifier\0"
462
  "missing terminating ] for character class\0"
463
  "invalid escape sequence in character class\0"
464
  "range out of order in character class\0"
465
  "nothing to repeat\0"
466
  /* 10 */
467
  "internal error: invalid forward reference offset\0"
468
  "internal error: unexpected repeat\0"
469
  "unrecognized character after (? or (?-\0"
470
  "POSIX named classes are supported only within a class\0"
471
  "missing )\0"
472
  /* 15 */
473
  "reference to non-existent subpattern\0"
474
  "erroffset passed as NULL\0"
475
  "unknown option bit(s) set\0"
476
  "missing ) after comment\0"
477
  "parentheses nested too deeply\0"  /** DEAD **/
478
  /* 20 */
479
  "regular expression is too large\0"
480
  "failed to get memory\0"
481
  "unmatched parentheses\0"
482
  "internal error: code overflow\0"
483
  "unrecognized character after (?<\0"
484
  /* 25 */
485
  "lookbehind assertion is not fixed length\0"
486
  "malformed number or name after (?(\0"
487
  "conditional group contains more than two branches\0"
488
  "assertion expected after (?( or (?(?C)\0"
489
  "(?R or (?[+-]digits must be followed by )\0"
490
  /* 30 */
491
  "unknown POSIX class name\0"
492
  "POSIX collating elements are not supported\0"
493
  "this version of PCRE is compiled without UTF support\0"
494
  "spare error\0"  /** DEAD **/
495
  "character value in \\x{} or \\o{} is too large\0"
496
  /* 35 */
497
  "invalid condition (?(0)\0"
498
  "\\C not allowed in lookbehind assertion\0"
499
  "PCRE does not support \\L, \\l, \\N{name}, \\U, or \\u\0"
500
  "number after (?C is > 255\0"
501
  "closing ) for (?C expected\0"
502
  /* 40 */
503
  "recursive call could loop indefinitely\0"
504
  "unrecognized character after (?P\0"
505
  "syntax error in subpattern name (missing terminator)\0"
506
  "two named subpatterns have the same name\0"
507
  "invalid UTF-8 string\0"
508
  /* 45 */
509
  "support for \\P, \\p, and \\X has not been compiled\0"
510
  "malformed \\P or \\p sequence\0"
511
  "unknown property name after \\P or \\p\0"
512
  "subpattern name is too long (maximum " XSTRING(MAX_NAME_SIZE) " characters)\0"
513
  "too many named subpatterns (maximum " XSTRING(MAX_NAME_COUNT) ")\0"
514
  /* 50 */
515
  "repeated subpattern is too long\0"    /** DEAD **/
516
  "octal value is greater than \\377 in 8-bit non-UTF-8 mode\0"
517
  "internal error: overran compiling workspace\0"
518
  "internal error: previously-checked referenced subpattern not found\0"
519
  "DEFINE group contains more than one branch\0"
520
  /* 55 */
521
  "repeating a DEFINE group is not allowed\0"  /** DEAD **/
522
  "inconsistent NEWLINE options\0"
523
  "\\g is not followed by a braced, angle-bracketed, or quoted name/number or by a plain number\0"
524
  "a numbered reference must not be zero\0"
525
  "an argument is not allowed for (*ACCEPT), (*FAIL), or (*COMMIT)\0"
526
  /* 60 */
527
  "(*VERB) not recognized or malformed\0"
528
  "number is too big\0"
529
  "subpattern name expected\0"
530
  "digit expected after (?+\0"
531
  "] is an invalid data character in JavaScript compatibility mode\0"
532
  /* 65 */
533
  "different names for subpatterns of the same number are not allowed\0"
534
  "(*MARK) must have an argument\0"
535
  "this version of PCRE is not compiled with Unicode property support\0"
536
#ifndef EBCDIC
537
  "\\c must be followed by an ASCII character\0"
538
#else
539
  "\\c must be followed by a letter or one of [\\]^_?\0"
540
#endif
541
  "\\k is not followed by a braced, angle-bracketed, or quoted name\0"
542
  /* 70 */
543
  "internal error: unknown opcode in find_fixedlength()\0"
544
  "\\N is not supported in a class\0"
545
  "too many forward references\0"
546
  "disallowed Unicode code point (>= 0xd800 && <= 0xdfff)\0"
547
  "invalid UTF-16 string\0"
548
  /* 75 */
549
  "name is too long in (*MARK), (*PRUNE), (*SKIP), or (*THEN)\0"
550
  "character value in \\u.... sequence is too large\0"
551
  "invalid UTF-32 string\0"
552
  "setting UTF is disabled by the application\0"
553
  "non-hex character in \\x{} (closing brace missing?)\0"
554
  /* 80 */
555
  "non-octal character in \\o{} (closing brace missing?)\0"
556
  "missing opening brace after \\o\0"
557
  "parentheses are too deeply nested\0"
558
  "invalid range in character class\0"
559
  "group name must start with a non-digit\0"
560
  /* 85 */
561
  "parentheses are too deeply nested (stack check)\0"
562
  "digits missing in \\x{} or \\o{}\0"
563
  "regular expression is too complicated\0"
564
  ;
565
566
/* Table to identify digits and hex digits. This is used when compiling
567
patterns. Note that the tables in chartables are dependent on the locale, and
568
may mark arbitrary characters as digits - but the PCRE compiling code expects
569
to handle only 0-9, a-z, and A-Z as digits when compiling. That is why we have
570
a private table here. It costs 256 bytes, but it is a lot faster than doing
571
character value tests (at least in some simple cases I timed), and in some
572
applications one wants PCRE to compile efficiently as well as match
573
efficiently.
574
575
For convenience, we use the same bit definitions as in chartables:
576
577
  0x04   decimal digit
578
  0x08   hexadecimal digit
579
580
Then we can use ctype_digit and ctype_xdigit in the code. */
581
582
/* Using a simple comparison for decimal numbers rather than a memory read
583
is much faster, and the resulting code is simpler (the compiler turns it
584
into a subtraction and unsigned comparison). */
585
586
0
#define IS_DIGIT(x) ((x) >= CHAR_0 && (x) <= CHAR_9)
587
588
#ifndef EBCDIC
589
590
/* This is the "normal" case, for ASCII systems, and EBCDIC systems running in
591
UTF-8 mode. */
592
593
static const pcre_uint8 digitab[] =
594
  {
595
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*   0-  7 */
596
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*   8- 15 */
597
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  16- 23 */
598
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  24- 31 */
599
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*    - '  */
600
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  ( - /  */
601
  0x0c,0x0c,0x0c,0x0c,0x0c,0x0c,0x0c,0x0c, /*  0 - 7  */
602
  0x0c,0x0c,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  8 - ?  */
603
  0x00,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x00, /*  @ - G  */
604
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  H - O  */
605
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  P - W  */
606
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  X - _  */
607
  0x00,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x00, /*  ` - g  */
608
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  h - o  */
609
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  p - w  */
610
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  x -127 */
611
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 128-135 */
612
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 136-143 */
613
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 144-151 */
614
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 152-159 */
615
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 160-167 */
616
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 168-175 */
617
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 176-183 */
618
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 184-191 */
619
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 192-199 */
620
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 200-207 */
621
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 208-215 */
622
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 216-223 */
623
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 224-231 */
624
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 232-239 */
625
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 240-247 */
626
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00};/* 248-255 */
627
628
#else
629
630
/* This is the "abnormal" case, for EBCDIC systems not running in UTF-8 mode. */
631
632
static const pcre_uint8 digitab[] =
633
  {
634
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*   0-  7  0 */
635
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*   8- 15    */
636
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  16- 23 10 */
637
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  24- 31    */
638
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  32- 39 20 */
639
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  40- 47    */
640
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  48- 55 30 */
641
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  56- 63    */
642
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*    - 71 40 */
643
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  72- |     */
644
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  & - 87 50 */
645
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  88- 95    */
646
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  - -103 60 */
647
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 104- ?     */
648
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 112-119 70 */
649
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 120- "     */
650
  0x00,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x00, /* 128- g  80 */
651
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  h -143    */
652
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 144- p  90 */
653
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  q -159    */
654
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 160- x  A0 */
655
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  y -175    */
656
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  ^ -183 B0 */
657
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 184-191    */
658
  0x00,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x00, /*  { - G  C0 */
659
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  H -207    */
660
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  } - P  D0 */
661
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  Q -223    */
662
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  \ - X  E0 */
663
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  Y -239    */
664
  0x0c,0x0c,0x0c,0x0c,0x0c,0x0c,0x0c,0x0c, /*  0 - 7  F0 */
665
  0x0c,0x0c,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00};/*  8 -255    */
666
667
static const pcre_uint8 ebcdic_chartab[] = { /* chartable partial dup */
668
  0x80,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x01,0x00,0x00, /*   0-  7 */
669
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x01,0x01,0x00,0x00, /*   8- 15 */
670
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x01,0x00,0x00, /*  16- 23 */
671
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  24- 31 */
672
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x01,0x00,0x00, /*  32- 39 */
673
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  40- 47 */
674
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  48- 55 */
675
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  56- 63 */
676
  0x01,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*    - 71 */
677
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x80,0x00,0x80,0x80,0x80, /*  72- |  */
678
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  & - 87 */
679
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x80,0x80,0x80,0x00,0x00, /*  88- 95 */
680
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  - -103 */
681
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x10,0x00,0x80, /* 104- ?  */
682
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 112-119 */
683
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 120- "  */
684
  0x00,0x1a,0x1a,0x1a,0x1a,0x1a,0x1a,0x12, /* 128- g  */
685
  0x12,0x12,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  h -143 */
686
  0x00,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12, /* 144- p  */
687
  0x12,0x12,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  q -159 */
688
  0x00,0x00,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12, /* 160- x  */
689
  0x12,0x12,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  y -175 */
690
  0x80,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  ^ -183 */
691
  0x00,0x00,0x80,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 184-191 */
692
  0x80,0x1a,0x1a,0x1a,0x1a,0x1a,0x1a,0x12, /*  { - G  */
693
  0x12,0x12,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  H -207 */
694
  0x00,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12, /*  } - P  */
695
  0x12,0x12,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  Q -223 */
696
  0x00,0x00,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12, /*  \ - X  */
697
  0x12,0x12,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  Y -239 */
698
  0x1c,0x1c,0x1c,0x1c,0x1c,0x1c,0x1c,0x1c, /*  0 - 7  */
699
  0x1c,0x1c,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00};/*  8 -255 */
700
#endif
701
702
703
/* This table is used to check whether auto-possessification is possible
704
between adjacent character-type opcodes. The left-hand (repeated) opcode is
705
used to select the row, and the right-hand opcode is use to select the column.
706
A value of 1 means that auto-possessification is OK. For example, the second
707
value in the first row means that \D+\d can be turned into \D++\d.
708
709
The Unicode property types (\P and \p) have to be present to fill out the table
710
because of what their opcode values are, but the table values should always be
711
zero because property types are handled separately in the code. The last four
712
columns apply to items that cannot be repeated, so there is no need to have
713
rows for them. Note that OP_DIGIT etc. are generated only when PCRE_UCP is
714
*not* set. When it is set, \d etc. are converted into OP_(NOT_)PROP codes. */
715
716
#define APTROWS (LAST_AUTOTAB_LEFT_OP - FIRST_AUTOTAB_OP + 1)
717
#define APTCOLS (LAST_AUTOTAB_RIGHT_OP - FIRST_AUTOTAB_OP + 1)
718
719
static const pcre_uint8 autoposstab[APTROWS][APTCOLS] = {
720
/* \D \d \S \s \W \w  . .+ \C \P \p \R \H \h \V \v \X \Z \z  $ $M */
721
  { 0, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 },  /* \D */
722
  { 1, 0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 1, 0, 1, 0, 1, 1, 1, 1 },  /* \d */
723
  { 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 1, 0, 1, 0, 1, 1, 1, 1 },  /* \S */
724
  { 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 },  /* \s */
725
  { 0, 1, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 },  /* \W */
726
  { 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 1, 0, 1, 0, 1, 1, 1, 1 },  /* \w */
727
  { 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 },  /* .  */
728
  { 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 },  /* .+ */
729
  { 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 },  /* \C */
730
  { 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0 },  /* \P */
731
  { 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0 },  /* \p */
732
  { 0, 1, 0, 1, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 },  /* \R */
733
  { 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 },  /* \H */
734
  { 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 },  /* \h */
735
  { 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 },  /* \V */
736
  { 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 },  /* \v */
737
  { 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 }   /* \X */
738
};
739
740
741
/* This table is used to check whether auto-possessification is possible
742
between adjacent Unicode property opcodes (OP_PROP and OP_NOTPROP). The
743
left-hand (repeated) opcode is used to select the row, and the right-hand
744
opcode is used to select the column. The values are as follows:
745
746
  0   Always return FALSE (never auto-possessify)
747
  1   Character groups are distinct (possessify if both are OP_PROP)
748
  2   Check character categories in the same group (general or particular)
749
  3   TRUE if the two opcodes are not the same (PROP vs NOTPROP)
750
751
  4   Check left general category vs right particular category
752
  5   Check right general category vs left particular category
753
754
  6   Left alphanum vs right general category
755
  7   Left space vs right general category
756
  8   Left word vs right general category
757
758
  9   Right alphanum vs left general category
759
 10   Right space vs left general category
760
 11   Right word vs left general category
761
762
 12   Left alphanum vs right particular category
763
 13   Left space vs right particular category
764
 14   Left word vs right particular category
765
766
 15   Right alphanum vs left particular category
767
 16   Right space vs left particular category
768
 17   Right word vs left particular category
769
*/
770
771
static const pcre_uint8 propposstab[PT_TABSIZE][PT_TABSIZE] = {
772
/* ANY LAMP GC  PC  SC ALNUM SPACE PXSPACE WORD CLIST UCNC */
773
  { 0,  0,  0,  0,  0,    0,    0,      0,   0,    0,   0 },  /* PT_ANY */
774
  { 0,  3,  0,  0,  0,    3,    1,      1,   0,    0,   0 },  /* PT_LAMP */
775
  { 0,  0,  2,  4,  0,    9,   10,     10,  11,    0,   0 },  /* PT_GC */
776
  { 0,  0,  5,  2,  0,   15,   16,     16,  17,    0,   0 },  /* PT_PC */
777
  { 0,  0,  0,  0,  2,    0,    0,      0,   0,    0,   0 },  /* PT_SC */
778
  { 0,  3,  6, 12,  0,    3,    1,      1,   0,    0,   0 },  /* PT_ALNUM */
779
  { 0,  1,  7, 13,  0,    1,    3,      3,   1,    0,   0 },  /* PT_SPACE */
780
  { 0,  1,  7, 13,  0,    1,    3,      3,   1,    0,   0 },  /* PT_PXSPACE */
781
  { 0,  0,  8, 14,  0,    0,    1,      1,   3,    0,   0 },  /* PT_WORD */
782
  { 0,  0,  0,  0,  0,    0,    0,      0,   0,    0,   0 },  /* PT_CLIST */
783
  { 0,  0,  0,  0,  0,    0,    0,      0,   0,    0,   3 }   /* PT_UCNC */
784
};
785
786
/* This table is used to check whether auto-possessification is possible
787
between adjacent Unicode property opcodes (OP_PROP and OP_NOTPROP) when one
788
specifies a general category and the other specifies a particular category. The
789
row is selected by the general category and the column by the particular
790
category. The value is 1 if the particular category is not part of the general
791
category. */
792
793
static const pcre_uint8 catposstab[7][30] = {
794
/* Cc Cf Cn Co Cs Ll Lm Lo Lt Lu Mc Me Mn Nd Nl No Pc Pd Pe Pf Pi Po Ps Sc Sk Sm So Zl Zp Zs */
795
  { 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1 },  /* C */
796
  { 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1 },  /* L */
797
  { 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1 },  /* M */
798
  { 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1 },  /* N */
799
  { 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1 },  /* P */
800
  { 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1 },  /* S */
801
  { 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0 }   /* Z */
802
};
803
804
/* This table is used when checking ALNUM, (PX)SPACE, SPACE, and WORD against
805
a general or particular category. The properties in each row are those
806
that apply to the character set in question. Duplication means that a little
807
unnecessary work is done when checking, but this keeps things much simpler
808
because they can all use the same code. For more details see the comment where
809
this table is used.
810
811
Note: SPACE and PXSPACE used to be different because Perl excluded VT from
812
"space", but from Perl 5.18 it's included, so both categories are treated the
813
same here. */
814
815
static const pcre_uint8 posspropstab[3][4] = {
816
  { ucp_L, ucp_N, ucp_N, ucp_Nl },  /* ALNUM, 3rd and 4th values redundant */
817
  { ucp_Z, ucp_Z, ucp_C, ucp_Cc },  /* SPACE and PXSPACE, 2nd value redundant */
818
  { ucp_L, ucp_N, ucp_P, ucp_Po }   /* WORD */
819
};
820
821
/* This table is used when converting repeating opcodes into possessified
822
versions as a result of an explicit possessive quantifier such as ++. A zero
823
value means there is no possessified version - in those cases the item in
824
question must be wrapped in ONCE brackets. The table is truncated at OP_CALLOUT
825
because all relevant opcodes are less than that. */
826
827
static const pcre_uint8 opcode_possessify[] = {
828
  0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0,   /* 0 - 15  */
829
  0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0,   /* 16 - 31 */
830
831
  0,                       /* NOTI */
832
  OP_POSSTAR, 0,           /* STAR, MINSTAR */
833
  OP_POSPLUS, 0,           /* PLUS, MINPLUS */
834
  OP_POSQUERY, 0,          /* QUERY, MINQUERY */
835
  OP_POSUPTO, 0,           /* UPTO, MINUPTO */
836
  0,                       /* EXACT */
837
  0, 0, 0, 0,              /* POS{STAR,PLUS,QUERY,UPTO} */
838
839
  OP_POSSTARI, 0,          /* STARI, MINSTARI */
840
  OP_POSPLUSI, 0,          /* PLUSI, MINPLUSI */
841
  OP_POSQUERYI, 0,         /* QUERYI, MINQUERYI */
842
  OP_POSUPTOI, 0,          /* UPTOI, MINUPTOI */
843
  0,                       /* EXACTI */
844
  0, 0, 0, 0,              /* POS{STARI,PLUSI,QUERYI,UPTOI} */
845
846
  OP_NOTPOSSTAR, 0,        /* NOTSTAR, NOTMINSTAR */
847
  OP_NOTPOSPLUS, 0,        /* NOTPLUS, NOTMINPLUS */
848
  OP_NOTPOSQUERY, 0,       /* NOTQUERY, NOTMINQUERY */
849
  OP_NOTPOSUPTO, 0,        /* NOTUPTO, NOTMINUPTO */
850
  0,                       /* NOTEXACT */
851
  0, 0, 0, 0,              /* NOTPOS{STAR,PLUS,QUERY,UPTO} */
852
853
  OP_NOTPOSSTARI, 0,       /* NOTSTARI, NOTMINSTARI */
854
  OP_NOTPOSPLUSI, 0,       /* NOTPLUSI, NOTMINPLUSI */
855
  OP_NOTPOSQUERYI, 0,      /* NOTQUERYI, NOTMINQUERYI */
856
  OP_NOTPOSUPTOI, 0,       /* NOTUPTOI, NOTMINUPTOI */
857
  0,                       /* NOTEXACTI */
858
  0, 0, 0, 0,              /* NOTPOS{STARI,PLUSI,QUERYI,UPTOI} */
859
860
  OP_TYPEPOSSTAR, 0,       /* TYPESTAR, TYPEMINSTAR */
861
  OP_TYPEPOSPLUS, 0,       /* TYPEPLUS, TYPEMINPLUS */
862
  OP_TYPEPOSQUERY, 0,      /* TYPEQUERY, TYPEMINQUERY */
863
  OP_TYPEPOSUPTO, 0,       /* TYPEUPTO, TYPEMINUPTO */
864
  0,                       /* TYPEEXACT */
865
  0, 0, 0, 0,              /* TYPEPOS{STAR,PLUS,QUERY,UPTO} */
866
867
  OP_CRPOSSTAR, 0,         /* CRSTAR, CRMINSTAR */
868
  OP_CRPOSPLUS, 0,         /* CRPLUS, CRMINPLUS */
869
  OP_CRPOSQUERY, 0,        /* CRQUERY, CRMINQUERY */
870
  OP_CRPOSRANGE, 0,        /* CRRANGE, CRMINRANGE */
871
  0, 0, 0, 0,              /* CRPOS{STAR,PLUS,QUERY,RANGE} */
872
873
  0, 0, 0,                 /* CLASS, NCLASS, XCLASS */
874
  0, 0,                    /* REF, REFI */
875
  0, 0,                    /* DNREF, DNREFI */
876
  0, 0                     /* RECURSE, CALLOUT */
877
};
878
879
880
881
/*************************************************
882
*            Find an error text                  *
883
*************************************************/
884
885
/* The error texts are now all in one long string, to save on relocations. As
886
some of the text is of unknown length, we can't use a table of offsets.
887
Instead, just count through the strings. This is not a performance issue
888
because it happens only when there has been a compilation error.
889
890
Argument:   the error number
891
Returns:    pointer to the error string
892
*/
893
894
static const char *
895
find_error_text(int n)
896
0
{
897
0
const char *s = error_texts;
898
0
for (; n > 0; n--)
899
0
  {
900
0
  while (*s++ != CHAR_NULL) {};
901
0
  if (*s == CHAR_NULL) return "Error text not found (please report)";
902
0
  }
903
0
return s;
904
0
}
905
906
907
908
/*************************************************
909
*           Expand the workspace                 *
910
*************************************************/
911
912
/* This function is called during the second compiling phase, if the number of
913
forward references fills the existing workspace, which is originally a block on
914
the stack. A larger block is obtained from malloc() unless the ultimate limit
915
has been reached or the increase will be rather small.
916
917
Argument: pointer to the compile data block
918
Returns:  0 if all went well, else an error number
919
*/
920
921
static int
922
expand_workspace(compile_data *cd)
923
0
{
924
0
pcre_uchar *newspace;
925
0
int newsize = cd->workspace_size * 2;
926
927
0
if (newsize > COMPILE_WORK_SIZE_MAX) newsize = COMPILE_WORK_SIZE_MAX;
928
0
if (cd->workspace_size >= COMPILE_WORK_SIZE_MAX ||
929
0
    newsize - cd->workspace_size < WORK_SIZE_SAFETY_MARGIN)
930
0
 return ERR72;
931
932
0
newspace = (PUBL(malloc))(IN_UCHARS(newsize));
933
0
if (newspace == NULL) return ERR21;
934
0
memcpy(newspace, cd->start_workspace, cd->workspace_size * sizeof(pcre_uchar));
935
0
cd->hwm = (pcre_uchar *)newspace + (cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace);
936
0
if (cd->workspace_size > COMPILE_WORK_SIZE)
937
0
  (PUBL(free))((void *)cd->start_workspace);
938
0
cd->start_workspace = newspace;
939
0
cd->workspace_size = newsize;
940
0
return 0;
941
0
}
942
943
944
945
/*************************************************
946
*            Check for counted repeat            *
947
*************************************************/
948
949
/* This function is called when a '{' is encountered in a place where it might
950
start a quantifier. It looks ahead to see if it really is a quantifier or not.
951
It is only a quantifier if it is one of the forms {ddd} {ddd,} or {ddd,ddd}
952
where the ddds are digits.
953
954
Arguments:
955
  p         pointer to the first char after '{'
956
957
Returns:    TRUE or FALSE
958
*/
959
960
static BOOL
961
is_counted_repeat(const pcre_uchar *p)
962
0
{
963
0
if (!IS_DIGIT(*p)) return FALSE;
964
0
p++;
965
0
while (IS_DIGIT(*p)) p++;
966
0
if (*p == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) return TRUE;
967
968
0
if (*p++ != CHAR_COMMA) return FALSE;
969
0
if (*p == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) return TRUE;
970
971
0
if (!IS_DIGIT(*p)) return FALSE;
972
0
p++;
973
0
while (IS_DIGIT(*p)) p++;
974
975
0
return (*p == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET);
976
0
}
977
978
979
980
/*************************************************
981
*            Handle escapes                      *
982
*************************************************/
983
984
/* This function is called when a \ has been encountered. It either returns a
985
positive value for a simple escape such as \n, or 0 for a data character which
986
will be placed in chptr. A backreference to group n is returned as negative n.
987
When UTF-8 is enabled, a positive value greater than 255 may be returned in
988
chptr. On entry, ptr is pointing at the \. On exit, it is on the final
989
character of the escape sequence.
990
991
Arguments:
992
  ptrptr         points to the pattern position pointer
993
  chptr          points to a returned data character
994
  errorcodeptr   points to the errorcode variable
995
  bracount       number of previous extracting brackets
996
  options        the options bits
997
  isclass        TRUE if inside a character class
998
999
Returns:         zero => a data character
1000
                 positive => a special escape sequence
1001
                 negative => a back reference
1002
                 on error, errorcodeptr is set
1003
*/
1004
1005
static int
1006
check_escape(const pcre_uchar **ptrptr, pcre_uint32 *chptr, int *errorcodeptr,
1007
  int bracount, int options, BOOL isclass)
1008
0
{
1009
/* PCRE_UTF16 has the same value as PCRE_UTF8. */
1010
0
BOOL utf = (options & PCRE_UTF8) != 0;
1011
0
const pcre_uchar *ptr = *ptrptr + 1;
1012
0
pcre_uint32 c;
1013
0
int escape = 0;
1014
0
int i;
1015
1016
0
GETCHARINCTEST(c, ptr);           /* Get character value, increment pointer */
1017
0
ptr--;                            /* Set pointer back to the last byte */
1018
1019
/* If backslash is at the end of the pattern, it's an error. */
1020
1021
0
if (c == CHAR_NULL) *errorcodeptr = ERR1;
1022
1023
/* Non-alphanumerics are literals. For digits or letters, do an initial lookup
1024
in a table. A non-zero result is something that can be returned immediately.
1025
Otherwise further processing may be required. */
1026
1027
0
#ifndef EBCDIC  /* ASCII/UTF-8 coding */
1028
/* Not alphanumeric */
1029
0
else if (c < CHAR_0 || c > CHAR_z) {}
1030
0
else if ((i = escapes[c - CHAR_0]) != 0)
1031
0
  { if (i > 0) c = (pcre_uint32)i; else escape = -i; }
1032
1033
#else           /* EBCDIC coding */
1034
/* Not alphanumeric */
1035
else if (c < CHAR_a || (!MAX_255(c) || (ebcdic_chartab[c] & 0x0E) == 0)) {}
1036
else if ((i = escapes[c - 0x48]) != 0)  { if (i > 0) c = (pcre_uint32)i; else escape = -i; }
1037
#endif
1038
1039
/* Escapes that need further processing, or are illegal. */
1040
1041
0
else
1042
0
  {
1043
0
  const pcre_uchar *oldptr;
1044
0
  BOOL braced, negated, overflow;
1045
0
  int s;
1046
1047
0
  switch (c)
1048
0
    {
1049
    /* A number of Perl escapes are not handled by PCRE. We give an explicit
1050
    error. */
1051
1052
0
    case CHAR_l:
1053
0
    case CHAR_L:
1054
0
    *errorcodeptr = ERR37;
1055
0
    break;
1056
1057
0
    case CHAR_u:
1058
0
    if ((options & PCRE_JAVASCRIPT_COMPAT) != 0)
1059
0
      {
1060
      /* In JavaScript, \u must be followed by four hexadecimal numbers.
1061
      Otherwise it is a lowercase u letter. */
1062
0
      if (MAX_255(ptr[1]) && (digitab[ptr[1]] & ctype_xdigit) != 0
1063
0
        && MAX_255(ptr[2]) && (digitab[ptr[2]] & ctype_xdigit) != 0
1064
0
        && MAX_255(ptr[3]) && (digitab[ptr[3]] & ctype_xdigit) != 0
1065
0
        && MAX_255(ptr[4]) && (digitab[ptr[4]] & ctype_xdigit) != 0)
1066
0
        {
1067
0
        c = 0;
1068
0
        for (i = 0; i < 4; ++i)
1069
0
          {
1070
0
          register pcre_uint32 cc = *(++ptr);
1071
0
#ifndef EBCDIC  /* ASCII/UTF-8 coding */
1072
0
          if (cc >= CHAR_a) cc -= 32;               /* Convert to upper case */
1073
0
          c = (c << 4) + cc - ((cc < CHAR_A)? CHAR_0 : (CHAR_A - 10));
1074
#else           /* EBCDIC coding */
1075
          if (cc >= CHAR_a && cc <= CHAR_z) cc += 64;  /* Convert to upper case */
1076
          c = (c << 4) + cc - ((cc >= CHAR_0)? CHAR_0 : (CHAR_A - 10));
1077
#endif
1078
0
          }
1079
1080
0
#if defined COMPILE_PCRE8
1081
0
        if (c > (utf ? 0x10ffffU : 0xffU))
1082
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16
1083
        if (c > (utf ? 0x10ffffU : 0xffffU))
1084
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32
1085
        if (utf && c > 0x10ffffU)
1086
#endif
1087
0
          {
1088
0
          *errorcodeptr = ERR76;
1089
0
          }
1090
0
        else if (utf && c >= 0xd800 && c <= 0xdfff) *errorcodeptr = ERR73;
1091
0
        }
1092
0
      }
1093
0
    else
1094
0
      *errorcodeptr = ERR37;
1095
0
    break;
1096
1097
0
    case CHAR_U:
1098
    /* In JavaScript, \U is an uppercase U letter. */
1099
0
    if ((options & PCRE_JAVASCRIPT_COMPAT) == 0) *errorcodeptr = ERR37;
1100
0
    break;
1101
1102
    /* In a character class, \g is just a literal "g". Outside a character
1103
    class, \g must be followed by one of a number of specific things:
1104
1105
    (1) A number, either plain or braced. If positive, it is an absolute
1106
    backreference. If negative, it is a relative backreference. This is a Perl
1107
    5.10 feature.
1108
1109
    (2) Perl 5.10 also supports \g{name} as a reference to a named group. This
1110
    is part of Perl's movement towards a unified syntax for back references. As
1111
    this is synonymous with \k{name}, we fudge it up by pretending it really
1112
    was \k.
1113
1114
    (3) For Oniguruma compatibility we also support \g followed by a name or a
1115
    number either in angle brackets or in single quotes. However, these are
1116
    (possibly recursive) subroutine calls, _not_ backreferences. Just return
1117
    the ESC_g code (cf \k). */
1118
1119
0
    case CHAR_g:
1120
0
    if (isclass) break;
1121
0
    if (ptr[1] == CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN || ptr[1] == CHAR_APOSTROPHE)
1122
0
      {
1123
0
      escape = ESC_g;
1124
0
      break;
1125
0
      }
1126
1127
    /* Handle the Perl-compatible cases */
1128
1129
0
    if (ptr[1] == CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET)
1130
0
      {
1131
0
      const pcre_uchar *p;
1132
0
      for (p = ptr+2; *p != CHAR_NULL && *p != CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET; p++)
1133
0
        if (*p != CHAR_MINUS && !IS_DIGIT(*p)) break;
1134
0
      if (*p != CHAR_NULL && *p != CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET)
1135
0
        {
1136
0
        escape = ESC_k;
1137
0
        break;
1138
0
        }
1139
0
      braced = TRUE;
1140
0
      ptr++;
1141
0
      }
1142
0
    else braced = FALSE;
1143
1144
0
    if (ptr[1] == CHAR_MINUS)
1145
0
      {
1146
0
      negated = TRUE;
1147
0
      ptr++;
1148
0
      }
1149
0
    else negated = FALSE;
1150
1151
    /* The integer range is limited by the machine's int representation. */
1152
0
    s = 0;
1153
0
    overflow = FALSE;
1154
0
    while (IS_DIGIT(ptr[1]))
1155
0
      {
1156
0
      if (s > INT_MAX / 10 - 1) /* Integer overflow */
1157
0
        {
1158
0
        overflow = TRUE;
1159
0
        break;
1160
0
        }
1161
0
      s = s * 10 + (int)(*(++ptr) - CHAR_0);
1162
0
      }
1163
0
    if (overflow) /* Integer overflow */
1164
0
      {
1165
0
      while (IS_DIGIT(ptr[1]))
1166
0
        ptr++;
1167
0
      *errorcodeptr = ERR61;
1168
0
      break;
1169
0
      }
1170
1171
0
    if (braced && *(++ptr) != CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET)
1172
0
      {
1173
0
      *errorcodeptr = ERR57;
1174
0
      break;
1175
0
      }
1176
1177
0
    if (s == 0)
1178
0
      {
1179
0
      *errorcodeptr = ERR58;
1180
0
      break;
1181
0
      }
1182
1183
0
    if (negated)
1184
0
      {
1185
0
      if (s > bracount)
1186
0
        {
1187
0
        *errorcodeptr = ERR15;
1188
0
        break;
1189
0
        }
1190
0
      s = bracount - (s - 1);
1191
0
      }
1192
1193
0
    escape = -s;
1194
0
    break;
1195
1196
    /* The handling of escape sequences consisting of a string of digits
1197
    starting with one that is not zero is not straightforward. Perl has changed
1198
    over the years. Nowadays \g{} for backreferences and \o{} for octal are
1199
    recommended to avoid the ambiguities in the old syntax.
1200
1201
    Outside a character class, the digits are read as a decimal number. If the
1202
    number is less than 8 (used to be 10), or if there are that many previous
1203
    extracting left brackets, then it is a back reference. Otherwise, up to
1204
    three octal digits are read to form an escaped byte. Thus \123 is likely to
1205
    be octal 123 (cf \0123, which is octal 012 followed by the literal 3). If
1206
    the octal value is greater than 377, the least significant 8 bits are
1207
    taken. \8 and \9 are treated as the literal characters 8 and 9.
1208
1209
    Inside a character class, \ followed by a digit is always either a literal
1210
    8 or 9 or an octal number. */
1211
1212
0
    case CHAR_1: case CHAR_2: case CHAR_3: case CHAR_4: case CHAR_5:
1213
0
    case CHAR_6: case CHAR_7: case CHAR_8: case CHAR_9:
1214
1215
0
    if (!isclass)
1216
0
      {
1217
0
      oldptr = ptr;
1218
      /* The integer range is limited by the machine's int representation. */
1219
0
      s = (int)(c -CHAR_0);
1220
0
      overflow = FALSE;
1221
0
      while (IS_DIGIT(ptr[1]))
1222
0
        {
1223
0
        if (s > INT_MAX / 10 - 1) /* Integer overflow */
1224
0
          {
1225
0
          overflow = TRUE;
1226
0
          break;
1227
0
          }
1228
0
        s = s * 10 + (int)(*(++ptr) - CHAR_0);
1229
0
        }
1230
0
      if (overflow) /* Integer overflow */
1231
0
        {
1232
0
        while (IS_DIGIT(ptr[1]))
1233
0
          ptr++;
1234
0
        *errorcodeptr = ERR61;
1235
0
        break;
1236
0
        }
1237
0
      if (s < 8 || s <= bracount)  /* Check for back reference */
1238
0
        {
1239
0
        escape = -s;
1240
0
        break;
1241
0
        }
1242
0
      ptr = oldptr;      /* Put the pointer back and fall through */
1243
0
      }
1244
1245
    /* Handle a digit following \ when the number is not a back reference. If
1246
    the first digit is 8 or 9, Perl used to generate a binary zero byte and
1247
    then treat the digit as a following literal. At least by Perl 5.18 this
1248
    changed so as not to insert the binary zero. */
1249
1250
0
    if ((c = *ptr) >= CHAR_8) break;
1251
1252
    /* Fall through with a digit less than 8 */
1253
1254
    /* \0 always starts an octal number, but we may drop through to here with a
1255
    larger first octal digit. The original code used just to take the least
1256
    significant 8 bits of octal numbers (I think this is what early Perls used
1257
    to do). Nowadays we allow for larger numbers in UTF-8 mode and 16-bit mode,
1258
    but no more than 3 octal digits. */
1259
1260
0
    case CHAR_0:
1261
0
    c -= CHAR_0;
1262
0
    while(i++ < 2 && ptr[1] >= CHAR_0 && ptr[1] <= CHAR_7)
1263
0
        c = c * 8 + *(++ptr) - CHAR_0;
1264
0
#ifdef COMPILE_PCRE8
1265
0
    if (!utf && c > 0xff) *errorcodeptr = ERR51;
1266
0
#endif
1267
0
    break;
1268
1269
    /* \o is a relatively new Perl feature, supporting a more general way of
1270
    specifying character codes in octal. The only supported form is \o{ddd}. */
1271
1272
0
    case CHAR_o:
1273
0
    if (ptr[1] != CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET) *errorcodeptr = ERR81; else
1274
0
    if (ptr[2] == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) *errorcodeptr = ERR86; else
1275
0
      {
1276
0
      ptr += 2;
1277
0
      c = 0;
1278
0
      overflow = FALSE;
1279
0
      while (*ptr >= CHAR_0 && *ptr <= CHAR_7)
1280
0
        {
1281
0
        register pcre_uint32 cc = *ptr++;
1282
0
        if (c == 0 && cc == CHAR_0) continue;     /* Leading zeroes */
1283
#ifdef COMPILE_PCRE32
1284
        if (c >= 0x20000000l) { overflow = TRUE; break; }
1285
#endif
1286
0
        c = (c << 3) + cc - CHAR_0 ;
1287
0
#if defined COMPILE_PCRE8
1288
0
        if (c > (utf ? 0x10ffffU : 0xffU)) { overflow = TRUE; break; }
1289
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16
1290
        if (c > (utf ? 0x10ffffU : 0xffffU)) { overflow = TRUE; break; }
1291
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32
1292
        if (utf && c > 0x10ffffU) { overflow = TRUE; break; }
1293
#endif
1294
0
        }
1295
0
      if (overflow)
1296
0
        {
1297
0
        while (*ptr >= CHAR_0 && *ptr <= CHAR_7) ptr++;
1298
0
        *errorcodeptr = ERR34;
1299
0
        }
1300
0
      else if (*ptr == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET)
1301
0
        {
1302
0
        if (utf && c >= 0xd800 && c <= 0xdfff) *errorcodeptr = ERR73;
1303
0
        }
1304
0
      else *errorcodeptr = ERR80;
1305
0
      }
1306
0
    break;
1307
1308
    /* \x is complicated. In JavaScript, \x must be followed by two hexadecimal
1309
    numbers. Otherwise it is a lowercase x letter. */
1310
1311
0
    case CHAR_x:
1312
0
    if ((options & PCRE_JAVASCRIPT_COMPAT) != 0)
1313
0
      {
1314
0
      if (MAX_255(ptr[1]) && (digitab[ptr[1]] & ctype_xdigit) != 0
1315
0
        && MAX_255(ptr[2]) && (digitab[ptr[2]] & ctype_xdigit) != 0)
1316
0
        {
1317
0
        c = 0;
1318
0
        for (i = 0; i < 2; ++i)
1319
0
          {
1320
0
          register pcre_uint32 cc = *(++ptr);
1321
0
#ifndef EBCDIC  /* ASCII/UTF-8 coding */
1322
0
          if (cc >= CHAR_a) cc -= 32;               /* Convert to upper case */
1323
0
          c = (c << 4) + cc - ((cc < CHAR_A)? CHAR_0 : (CHAR_A - 10));
1324
#else           /* EBCDIC coding */
1325
          if (cc >= CHAR_a && cc <= CHAR_z) cc += 64;  /* Convert to upper case */
1326
          c = (c << 4) + cc - ((cc >= CHAR_0)? CHAR_0 : (CHAR_A - 10));
1327
#endif
1328
0
          }
1329
0
        }
1330
0
      }    /* End JavaScript handling */
1331
1332
    /* Handle \x in Perl's style. \x{ddd} is a character number which can be
1333
    greater than 0xff in utf or non-8bit mode, but only if the ddd are hex
1334
    digits. If not, { used to be treated as a data character. However, Perl
1335
    seems to read hex digits up to the first non-such, and ignore the rest, so
1336
    that, for example \x{zz} matches a binary zero. This seems crazy, so PCRE
1337
    now gives an error. */
1338
1339
0
    else
1340
0
      {
1341
0
      if (ptr[1] == CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET)
1342
0
        {
1343
0
        ptr += 2;
1344
0
        if (*ptr == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET)
1345
0
          {
1346
0
          *errorcodeptr = ERR86;
1347
0
          break;
1348
0
          }
1349
0
        c = 0;
1350
0
        overflow = FALSE;
1351
0
        while (MAX_255(*ptr) && (digitab[*ptr] & ctype_xdigit) != 0)
1352
0
          {
1353
0
          register pcre_uint32 cc = *ptr++;
1354
0
          if (c == 0 && cc == CHAR_0) continue;     /* Leading zeroes */
1355
1356
#ifdef COMPILE_PCRE32
1357
          if (c >= 0x10000000l) { overflow = TRUE; break; }
1358
#endif
1359
1360
0
#ifndef EBCDIC  /* ASCII/UTF-8 coding */
1361
0
          if (cc >= CHAR_a) cc -= 32;               /* Convert to upper case */
1362
0
          c = (c << 4) + cc - ((cc < CHAR_A)? CHAR_0 : (CHAR_A - 10));
1363
#else           /* EBCDIC coding */
1364
          if (cc >= CHAR_a && cc <= CHAR_z) cc += 64;  /* Convert to upper case */
1365
          c = (c << 4) + cc - ((cc >= CHAR_0)? CHAR_0 : (CHAR_A - 10));
1366
#endif
1367
1368
0
#if defined COMPILE_PCRE8
1369
0
          if (c > (utf ? 0x10ffffU : 0xffU)) { overflow = TRUE; break; }
1370
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16
1371
          if (c > (utf ? 0x10ffffU : 0xffffU)) { overflow = TRUE; break; }
1372
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32
1373
          if (utf && c > 0x10ffffU) { overflow = TRUE; break; }
1374
#endif
1375
0
          }
1376
1377
0
        if (overflow)
1378
0
          {
1379
0
          while (MAX_255(*ptr) && (digitab[*ptr] & ctype_xdigit) != 0) ptr++;
1380
0
          *errorcodeptr = ERR34;
1381
0
          }
1382
1383
0
        else if (*ptr == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET)
1384
0
          {
1385
0
          if (utf && c >= 0xd800 && c <= 0xdfff) *errorcodeptr = ERR73;
1386
0
          }
1387
1388
        /* If the sequence of hex digits does not end with '}', give an error.
1389
        We used just to recognize this construct and fall through to the normal
1390
        \x handling, but nowadays Perl gives an error, which seems much more
1391
        sensible, so we do too. */
1392
1393
0
        else *errorcodeptr = ERR79;
1394
0
        }   /* End of \x{} processing */
1395
1396
      /* Read a single-byte hex-defined char (up to two hex digits after \x) */
1397
1398
0
      else
1399
0
        {
1400
0
        c = 0;
1401
0
        while (i++ < 2 && MAX_255(ptr[1]) && (digitab[ptr[1]] & ctype_xdigit) != 0)
1402
0
          {
1403
0
          pcre_uint32 cc;                          /* Some compilers don't like */
1404
0
          cc = *(++ptr);                           /* ++ in initializers */
1405
0
#ifndef EBCDIC  /* ASCII/UTF-8 coding */
1406
0
          if (cc >= CHAR_a) cc -= 32;              /* Convert to upper case */
1407
0
          c = c * 16 + cc - ((cc < CHAR_A)? CHAR_0 : (CHAR_A - 10));
1408
#else           /* EBCDIC coding */
1409
          if (cc <= CHAR_z) cc += 64;              /* Convert to upper case */
1410
          c = c * 16 + cc - ((cc >= CHAR_0)? CHAR_0 : (CHAR_A - 10));
1411
#endif
1412
0
          }
1413
0
        }     /* End of \xdd handling */
1414
0
      }       /* End of Perl-style \x handling */
1415
0
    break;
1416
1417
    /* For \c, a following letter is upper-cased; then the 0x40 bit is flipped.
1418
    An error is given if the byte following \c is not an ASCII character. This
1419
    coding is ASCII-specific, but then the whole concept of \cx is
1420
    ASCII-specific. (However, an EBCDIC equivalent has now been added.) */
1421
1422
0
    case CHAR_c:
1423
0
    c = *(++ptr);
1424
0
    if (c == CHAR_NULL)
1425
0
      {
1426
0
      *errorcodeptr = ERR2;
1427
0
      break;
1428
0
      }
1429
0
#ifndef EBCDIC    /* ASCII/UTF-8 coding */
1430
0
    if (c > 127)  /* Excludes all non-ASCII in either mode */
1431
0
      {
1432
0
      *errorcodeptr = ERR68;
1433
0
      break;
1434
0
      }
1435
0
    if (c >= CHAR_a && c <= CHAR_z) c -= 32;
1436
0
    c ^= 0x40;
1437
#else             /* EBCDIC coding */
1438
    if (c >= CHAR_a && c <= CHAR_z) c += 64;
1439
    if (c == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK)
1440
      c = ('\\' == 188 && '`' == 74)? 0x5f : 0xff;
1441
    else
1442
      {
1443
      for (i = 0; i < 32; i++)
1444
        {
1445
        if (c == ebcdic_escape_c[i]) break;
1446
        }
1447
      if (i < 32) c = i; else *errorcodeptr = ERR68;
1448
      }
1449
#endif
1450
0
    break;
1451
1452
    /* PCRE_EXTRA enables extensions to Perl in the matter of escapes. Any
1453
    other alphanumeric following \ is an error if PCRE_EXTRA was set;
1454
    otherwise, for Perl compatibility, it is a literal. This code looks a bit
1455
    odd, but there used to be some cases other than the default, and there may
1456
    be again in future, so I haven't "optimized" it. */
1457
1458
0
    default:
1459
0
    if ((options & PCRE_EXTRA) != 0) switch(c)
1460
0
      {
1461
0
      default:
1462
0
      *errorcodeptr = ERR3;
1463
0
      break;
1464
0
      }
1465
0
    break;
1466
0
    }
1467
0
  }
1468
1469
/* Perl supports \N{name} for character names, as well as plain \N for "not
1470
newline". PCRE does not support \N{name}. However, it does support
1471
quantification such as \N{2,3}. */
1472
1473
0
if (escape == ESC_N && ptr[1] == CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET &&
1474
0
     !is_counted_repeat(ptr+2))
1475
0
  *errorcodeptr = ERR37;
1476
1477
/* If PCRE_UCP is set, we change the values for \d etc. */
1478
1479
0
if ((options & PCRE_UCP) != 0 && escape >= ESC_D && escape <= ESC_w)
1480
0
  escape += (ESC_DU - ESC_D);
1481
1482
/* Set the pointer to the final character before returning. */
1483
1484
0
*ptrptr = ptr;
1485
0
*chptr = c;
1486
0
return escape;
1487
0
}
1488
1489
1490
1491
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
1492
/*************************************************
1493
*               Handle \P and \p                 *
1494
*************************************************/
1495
1496
/* This function is called after \P or \p has been encountered, provided that
1497
PCRE is compiled with support for Unicode properties. On entry, ptrptr is
1498
pointing at the P or p. On exit, it is pointing at the final character of the
1499
escape sequence.
1500
1501
Argument:
1502
  ptrptr         points to the pattern position pointer
1503
  negptr         points to a boolean that is set TRUE for negation else FALSE
1504
  ptypeptr       points to an unsigned int that is set to the type value
1505
  pdataptr       points to an unsigned int that is set to the detailed property value
1506
  errorcodeptr   points to the error code variable
1507
1508
Returns:         TRUE if the type value was found, or FALSE for an invalid type
1509
*/
1510
1511
static BOOL
1512
get_ucp(const pcre_uchar **ptrptr, BOOL *negptr, unsigned int *ptypeptr,
1513
  unsigned int *pdataptr, int *errorcodeptr)
1514
{
1515
pcre_uchar c;
1516
int i, bot, top;
1517
const pcre_uchar *ptr = *ptrptr;
1518
pcre_uchar name[32];
1519
1520
c = *(++ptr);
1521
if (c == CHAR_NULL) goto ERROR_RETURN;
1522
1523
*negptr = FALSE;
1524
1525
/* \P or \p can be followed by a name in {}, optionally preceded by ^ for
1526
negation. */
1527
1528
if (c == CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET)
1529
  {
1530
  if (ptr[1] == CHAR_CIRCUMFLEX_ACCENT)
1531
    {
1532
    *negptr = TRUE;
1533
    ptr++;
1534
    }
1535
  for (i = 0; i < (int)(sizeof(name) / sizeof(pcre_uchar)) - 1; i++)
1536
    {
1537
    c = *(++ptr);
1538
    if (c == CHAR_NULL) goto ERROR_RETURN;
1539
    if (c == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) break;
1540
    name[i] = c;
1541
    }
1542
  if (c != CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) goto ERROR_RETURN;
1543
  name[i] = 0;
1544
  }
1545
1546
/* Otherwise there is just one following character */
1547
1548
else
1549
  {
1550
  name[0] = c;
1551
  name[1] = 0;
1552
  }
1553
1554
*ptrptr = ptr;
1555
1556
/* Search for a recognized property name using binary chop */
1557
1558
bot = 0;
1559
top = PRIV(utt_size);
1560
1561
while (bot < top)
1562
  {
1563
  int r;
1564
  i = (bot + top) >> 1;
1565
  r = STRCMP_UC_C8(name, PRIV(utt_names) + PRIV(utt)[i].name_offset);
1566
  if (r == 0)
1567
    {
1568
    *ptypeptr = PRIV(utt)[i].type;
1569
    *pdataptr = PRIV(utt)[i].value;
1570
    return TRUE;
1571
    }
1572
  if (r > 0) bot = i + 1; else top = i;
1573
  }
1574
1575
*errorcodeptr = ERR47;
1576
*ptrptr = ptr;
1577
return FALSE;
1578
1579
ERROR_RETURN:
1580
*errorcodeptr = ERR46;
1581
*ptrptr = ptr;
1582
return FALSE;
1583
}
1584
#endif
1585
1586
1587
1588
/*************************************************
1589
*         Read repeat counts                     *
1590
*************************************************/
1591
1592
/* Read an item of the form {n,m} and return the values. This is called only
1593
after is_counted_repeat() has confirmed that a repeat-count quantifier exists,
1594
so the syntax is guaranteed to be correct, but we need to check the values.
1595
1596
Arguments:
1597
  p              pointer to first char after '{'
1598
  minp           pointer to int for min
1599
  maxp           pointer to int for max
1600
                 returned as -1 if no max
1601
  errorcodeptr   points to error code variable
1602
1603
Returns:         pointer to '}' on success;
1604
                 current ptr on error, with errorcodeptr set non-zero
1605
*/
1606
1607
static const pcre_uchar *
1608
read_repeat_counts(const pcre_uchar *p, int *minp, int *maxp, int *errorcodeptr)
1609
0
{
1610
0
int min = 0;
1611
0
int max = -1;
1612
1613
0
while (IS_DIGIT(*p))
1614
0
  {
1615
0
  min = min * 10 + (int)(*p++ - CHAR_0);
1616
0
  if (min > 65535)
1617
0
    {
1618
0
    *errorcodeptr = ERR5;
1619
0
    return p;
1620
0
    }
1621
0
  }
1622
1623
0
if (*p == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) max = min; else
1624
0
  {
1625
0
  if (*(++p) != CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET)
1626
0
    {
1627
0
    max = 0;
1628
0
    while(IS_DIGIT(*p))
1629
0
      {
1630
0
      max = max * 10 + (int)(*p++ - CHAR_0);
1631
0
      if (max > 65535)
1632
0
        {
1633
0
        *errorcodeptr = ERR5;
1634
0
        return p;
1635
0
        }
1636
0
      }
1637
0
    if (max < min)
1638
0
      {
1639
0
      *errorcodeptr = ERR4;
1640
0
      return p;
1641
0
      }
1642
0
    }
1643
0
  }
1644
1645
0
*minp = min;
1646
0
*maxp = max;
1647
0
return p;
1648
0
}
1649
1650
1651
1652
/*************************************************
1653
*      Find first significant op code            *
1654
*************************************************/
1655
1656
/* This is called by several functions that scan a compiled expression looking
1657
for a fixed first character, or an anchoring op code etc. It skips over things
1658
that do not influence this. For some calls, it makes sense to skip negative
1659
forward and all backward assertions, and also the \b assertion; for others it
1660
does not.
1661
1662
Arguments:
1663
  code         pointer to the start of the group
1664
  skipassert   TRUE if certain assertions are to be skipped
1665
1666
Returns:       pointer to the first significant opcode
1667
*/
1668
1669
static const pcre_uchar*
1670
first_significant_code(const pcre_uchar *code, BOOL skipassert)
1671
0
{
1672
0
for (;;)
1673
0
  {
1674
0
  switch ((int)*code)
1675
0
    {
1676
0
    case OP_ASSERT_NOT:
1677
0
    case OP_ASSERTBACK:
1678
0
    case OP_ASSERTBACK_NOT:
1679
0
    if (!skipassert) return code;
1680
0
    do code += GET(code, 1); while (*code == OP_ALT);
1681
0
    code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[*code];
1682
0
    break;
1683
1684
0
    case OP_WORD_BOUNDARY:
1685
0
    case OP_NOT_WORD_BOUNDARY:
1686
0
    if (!skipassert) return code;
1687
    /* Fall through */
1688
1689
0
    case OP_CALLOUT:
1690
0
    case OP_CREF:
1691
0
    case OP_DNCREF:
1692
0
    case OP_RREF:
1693
0
    case OP_DNRREF:
1694
0
    case OP_DEF:
1695
0
    code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[*code];
1696
0
    break;
1697
1698
0
    default:
1699
0
    return code;
1700
0
    }
1701
0
  }
1702
/* Control never reaches here */
1703
0
}
1704
1705
1706
1707
/*************************************************
1708
*        Find the fixed length of a branch       *
1709
*************************************************/
1710
1711
/* Scan a branch and compute the fixed length of subject that will match it,
1712
if the length is fixed. This is needed for dealing with backward assertions.
1713
In UTF8 mode, the result is in characters rather than bytes. The branch is
1714
temporarily terminated with OP_END when this function is called.
1715
1716
This function is called when a backward assertion is encountered, so that if it
1717
fails, the error message can point to the correct place in the pattern.
1718
However, we cannot do this when the assertion contains subroutine calls,
1719
because they can be forward references. We solve this by remembering this case
1720
and doing the check at the end; a flag specifies which mode we are running in.
1721
1722
Arguments:
1723
  code     points to the start of the pattern (the bracket)
1724
  utf      TRUE in UTF-8 / UTF-16 / UTF-32 mode
1725
  atend    TRUE if called when the pattern is complete
1726
  cd       the "compile data" structure
1727
  recurses    chain of recurse_check to catch mutual recursion
1728
1729
Returns:   the fixed length,
1730
             or -1 if there is no fixed length,
1731
             or -2 if \C was encountered (in UTF-8 mode only)
1732
             or -3 if an OP_RECURSE item was encountered and atend is FALSE
1733
             or -4 if an unknown opcode was encountered (internal error)
1734
*/
1735
1736
static int
1737
find_fixedlength(pcre_uchar *code, BOOL utf, BOOL atend, compile_data *cd,
1738
  recurse_check *recurses)
1739
0
{
1740
0
int length = -1;
1741
0
recurse_check this_recurse;
1742
0
register int branchlength = 0;
1743
0
register pcre_uchar *cc = code + 1 + LINK_SIZE;
1744
1745
/* Scan along the opcodes for this branch. If we get to the end of the
1746
branch, check the length against that of the other branches. */
1747
1748
0
for (;;)
1749
0
  {
1750
0
  int d;
1751
0
  pcre_uchar *ce, *cs;
1752
0
  register pcre_uchar op = *cc;
1753
1754
0
  switch (op)
1755
0
    {
1756
    /* We only need to continue for OP_CBRA (normal capturing bracket) and
1757
    OP_BRA (normal non-capturing bracket) because the other variants of these
1758
    opcodes are all concerned with unlimited repeated groups, which of course
1759
    are not of fixed length. */
1760
1761
0
    case OP_CBRA:
1762
0
    case OP_BRA:
1763
0
    case OP_ONCE:
1764
0
    case OP_ONCE_NC:
1765
0
    case OP_COND:
1766
0
    d = find_fixedlength(cc + ((op == OP_CBRA)? IMM2_SIZE : 0), utf, atend, cd,
1767
0
      recurses);
1768
0
    if (d < 0) return d;
1769
0
    branchlength += d;
1770
0
    do cc += GET(cc, 1); while (*cc == OP_ALT);
1771
0
    cc += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
1772
0
    break;
1773
1774
    /* Reached end of a branch; if it's a ket it is the end of a nested call.
1775
    If it's ALT it is an alternation in a nested call. An ACCEPT is effectively
1776
    an ALT. If it is END it's the end of the outer call. All can be handled by
1777
    the same code. Note that we must not include the OP_KETRxxx opcodes here,
1778
    because they all imply an unlimited repeat. */
1779
1780
0
    case OP_ALT:
1781
0
    case OP_KET:
1782
0
    case OP_END:
1783
0
    case OP_ACCEPT:
1784
0
    case OP_ASSERT_ACCEPT:
1785
0
    if (length < 0) length = branchlength;
1786
0
      else if (length != branchlength) return -1;
1787
0
    if (*cc != OP_ALT) return length;
1788
0
    cc += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
1789
0
    branchlength = 0;
1790
0
    break;
1791
1792
    /* A true recursion implies not fixed length, but a subroutine call may
1793
    be OK. If the subroutine is a forward reference, we can't deal with
1794
    it until the end of the pattern, so return -3. */
1795
1796
0
    case OP_RECURSE:
1797
0
    if (!atend) return -3;
1798
0
    cs = ce = (pcre_uchar *)cd->start_code + GET(cc, 1);  /* Start subpattern */
1799
0
    do ce += GET(ce, 1); while (*ce == OP_ALT);           /* End subpattern */
1800
0
    if (cc > cs && cc < ce) return -1;                    /* Recursion */
1801
0
    else   /* Check for mutual recursion */
1802
0
      {
1803
0
      recurse_check *r = recurses;
1804
0
      for (r = recurses; r != NULL; r = r->prev) if (r->group == cs) break;
1805
0
      if (r != NULL) return -1;   /* Mutual recursion */
1806
0
      }
1807
0
    this_recurse.prev = recurses;
1808
0
    this_recurse.group = cs;
1809
0
    d = find_fixedlength(cs + IMM2_SIZE, utf, atend, cd, &this_recurse);
1810
0
    if (d < 0) return d;
1811
0
    branchlength += d;
1812
0
    cc += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
1813
0
    break;
1814
1815
    /* Skip over assertive subpatterns */
1816
1817
0
    case OP_ASSERT:
1818
0
    case OP_ASSERT_NOT:
1819
0
    case OP_ASSERTBACK:
1820
0
    case OP_ASSERTBACK_NOT:
1821
0
    do cc += GET(cc, 1); while (*cc == OP_ALT);
1822
0
    cc += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
1823
0
    break;
1824
1825
    /* Skip over things that don't match chars */
1826
1827
0
    case OP_MARK:
1828
0
    case OP_PRUNE_ARG:
1829
0
    case OP_SKIP_ARG:
1830
0
    case OP_THEN_ARG:
1831
0
    cc += cc[1] + PRIV(OP_lengths)[*cc];
1832
0
    break;
1833
1834
0
    case OP_CALLOUT:
1835
0
    case OP_CIRC:
1836
0
    case OP_CIRCM:
1837
0
    case OP_CLOSE:
1838
0
    case OP_COMMIT:
1839
0
    case OP_CREF:
1840
0
    case OP_DEF:
1841
0
    case OP_DNCREF:
1842
0
    case OP_DNRREF:
1843
0
    case OP_DOLL:
1844
0
    case OP_DOLLM:
1845
0
    case OP_EOD:
1846
0
    case OP_EODN:
1847
0
    case OP_FAIL:
1848
0
    case OP_NOT_WORD_BOUNDARY:
1849
0
    case OP_PRUNE:
1850
0
    case OP_REVERSE:
1851
0
    case OP_RREF:
1852
0
    case OP_SET_SOM:
1853
0
    case OP_SKIP:
1854
0
    case OP_SOD:
1855
0
    case OP_SOM:
1856
0
    case OP_THEN:
1857
0
    case OP_WORD_BOUNDARY:
1858
0
    cc += PRIV(OP_lengths)[*cc];
1859
0
    break;
1860
1861
    /* Handle literal characters */
1862
1863
0
    case OP_CHAR:
1864
0
    case OP_CHARI:
1865
0
    case OP_NOT:
1866
0
    case OP_NOTI:
1867
0
    branchlength++;
1868
0
    cc += 2;
1869
#ifdef SUPPORT_UTF
1870
    if (utf && HAS_EXTRALEN(cc[-1])) cc += GET_EXTRALEN(cc[-1]);
1871
#endif
1872
0
    break;
1873
1874
    /* Handle exact repetitions. The count is already in characters, but we
1875
    need to skip over a multibyte character in UTF8 mode.  */
1876
1877
0
    case OP_EXACT:
1878
0
    case OP_EXACTI:
1879
0
    case OP_NOTEXACT:
1880
0
    case OP_NOTEXACTI:
1881
0
    branchlength += (int)GET2(cc,1);
1882
0
    cc += 2 + IMM2_SIZE;
1883
#ifdef SUPPORT_UTF
1884
    if (utf && HAS_EXTRALEN(cc[-1])) cc += GET_EXTRALEN(cc[-1]);
1885
#endif
1886
0
    break;
1887
1888
0
    case OP_TYPEEXACT:
1889
0
    branchlength += GET2(cc,1);
1890
0
    if (cc[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_PROP || cc[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_NOTPROP)
1891
0
      cc += 2;
1892
0
    cc += 1 + IMM2_SIZE + 1;
1893
0
    break;
1894
1895
    /* Handle single-char matchers */
1896
1897
0
    case OP_PROP:
1898
0
    case OP_NOTPROP:
1899
0
    cc += 2;
1900
    /* Fall through */
1901
1902
0
    case OP_HSPACE:
1903
0
    case OP_VSPACE:
1904
0
    case OP_NOT_HSPACE:
1905
0
    case OP_NOT_VSPACE:
1906
0
    case OP_NOT_DIGIT:
1907
0
    case OP_DIGIT:
1908
0
    case OP_NOT_WHITESPACE:
1909
0
    case OP_WHITESPACE:
1910
0
    case OP_NOT_WORDCHAR:
1911
0
    case OP_WORDCHAR:
1912
0
    case OP_ANY:
1913
0
    case OP_ALLANY:
1914
0
    branchlength++;
1915
0
    cc++;
1916
0
    break;
1917
1918
    /* The single-byte matcher isn't allowed. This only happens in UTF-8 mode;
1919
    otherwise \C is coded as OP_ALLANY. */
1920
1921
0
    case OP_ANYBYTE:
1922
0
    return -2;
1923
1924
    /* Check a class for variable quantification */
1925
1926
0
    case OP_CLASS:
1927
0
    case OP_NCLASS:
1928
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || defined COMPILE_PCRE16 || defined COMPILE_PCRE32
1929
    case OP_XCLASS:
1930
    /* The original code caused an unsigned overflow in 64 bit systems,
1931
    so now we use a conditional statement. */
1932
    if (op == OP_XCLASS)
1933
      cc += GET(cc, 1);
1934
    else
1935
      cc += PRIV(OP_lengths)[OP_CLASS];
1936
#else
1937
0
    cc += PRIV(OP_lengths)[OP_CLASS];
1938
0
#endif
1939
1940
0
    switch (*cc)
1941
0
      {
1942
0
      case OP_CRSTAR:
1943
0
      case OP_CRMINSTAR:
1944
0
      case OP_CRPLUS:
1945
0
      case OP_CRMINPLUS:
1946
0
      case OP_CRQUERY:
1947
0
      case OP_CRMINQUERY:
1948
0
      case OP_CRPOSSTAR:
1949
0
      case OP_CRPOSPLUS:
1950
0
      case OP_CRPOSQUERY:
1951
0
      return -1;
1952
1953
0
      case OP_CRRANGE:
1954
0
      case OP_CRMINRANGE:
1955
0
      case OP_CRPOSRANGE:
1956
0
      if (GET2(cc,1) != GET2(cc,1+IMM2_SIZE)) return -1;
1957
0
      branchlength += (int)GET2(cc,1);
1958
0
      cc += 1 + 2 * IMM2_SIZE;
1959
0
      break;
1960
1961
0
      default:
1962
0
      branchlength++;
1963
0
      }
1964
0
    break;
1965
1966
    /* Anything else is variable length */
1967
1968
0
    case OP_ANYNL:
1969
0
    case OP_BRAMINZERO:
1970
0
    case OP_BRAPOS:
1971
0
    case OP_BRAPOSZERO:
1972
0
    case OP_BRAZERO:
1973
0
    case OP_CBRAPOS:
1974
0
    case OP_EXTUNI:
1975
0
    case OP_KETRMAX:
1976
0
    case OP_KETRMIN:
1977
0
    case OP_KETRPOS:
1978
0
    case OP_MINPLUS:
1979
0
    case OP_MINPLUSI:
1980
0
    case OP_MINQUERY:
1981
0
    case OP_MINQUERYI:
1982
0
    case OP_MINSTAR:
1983
0
    case OP_MINSTARI:
1984
0
    case OP_MINUPTO:
1985
0
    case OP_MINUPTOI:
1986
0
    case OP_NOTMINPLUS:
1987
0
    case OP_NOTMINPLUSI:
1988
0
    case OP_NOTMINQUERY:
1989
0
    case OP_NOTMINQUERYI:
1990
0
    case OP_NOTMINSTAR:
1991
0
    case OP_NOTMINSTARI:
1992
0
    case OP_NOTMINUPTO:
1993
0
    case OP_NOTMINUPTOI:
1994
0
    case OP_NOTPLUS:
1995
0
    case OP_NOTPLUSI:
1996
0
    case OP_NOTPOSPLUS:
1997
0
    case OP_NOTPOSPLUSI:
1998
0
    case OP_NOTPOSQUERY:
1999
0
    case OP_NOTPOSQUERYI:
2000
0
    case OP_NOTPOSSTAR:
2001
0
    case OP_NOTPOSSTARI:
2002
0
    case OP_NOTPOSUPTO:
2003
0
    case OP_NOTPOSUPTOI:
2004
0
    case OP_NOTQUERY:
2005
0
    case OP_NOTQUERYI:
2006
0
    case OP_NOTSTAR:
2007
0
    case OP_NOTSTARI:
2008
0
    case OP_NOTUPTO:
2009
0
    case OP_NOTUPTOI:
2010
0
    case OP_PLUS:
2011
0
    case OP_PLUSI:
2012
0
    case OP_POSPLUS:
2013
0
    case OP_POSPLUSI:
2014
0
    case OP_POSQUERY:
2015
0
    case OP_POSQUERYI:
2016
0
    case OP_POSSTAR:
2017
0
    case OP_POSSTARI:
2018
0
    case OP_POSUPTO:
2019
0
    case OP_POSUPTOI:
2020
0
    case OP_QUERY:
2021
0
    case OP_QUERYI:
2022
0
    case OP_REF:
2023
0
    case OP_REFI:
2024
0
    case OP_DNREF:
2025
0
    case OP_DNREFI:
2026
0
    case OP_SBRA:
2027
0
    case OP_SBRAPOS:
2028
0
    case OP_SCBRA:
2029
0
    case OP_SCBRAPOS:
2030
0
    case OP_SCOND:
2031
0
    case OP_SKIPZERO:
2032
0
    case OP_STAR:
2033
0
    case OP_STARI:
2034
0
    case OP_TYPEMINPLUS:
2035
0
    case OP_TYPEMINQUERY:
2036
0
    case OP_TYPEMINSTAR:
2037
0
    case OP_TYPEMINUPTO:
2038
0
    case OP_TYPEPLUS:
2039
0
    case OP_TYPEPOSPLUS:
2040
0
    case OP_TYPEPOSQUERY:
2041
0
    case OP_TYPEPOSSTAR:
2042
0
    case OP_TYPEPOSUPTO:
2043
0
    case OP_TYPEQUERY:
2044
0
    case OP_TYPESTAR:
2045
0
    case OP_TYPEUPTO:
2046
0
    case OP_UPTO:
2047
0
    case OP_UPTOI:
2048
0
    return -1;
2049
2050
    /* Catch unrecognized opcodes so that when new ones are added they
2051
    are not forgotten, as has happened in the past. */
2052
2053
0
    default:
2054
0
    return -4;
2055
0
    }
2056
0
  }
2057
/* Control never gets here */
2058
0
}
2059
2060
2061
2062
/*************************************************
2063
*    Scan compiled regex for specific bracket    *
2064
*************************************************/
2065
2066
/* This little function scans through a compiled pattern until it finds a
2067
capturing bracket with the given number, or, if the number is negative, an
2068
instance of OP_REVERSE for a lookbehind. The function is global in the C sense
2069
so that it can be called from pcre_study() when finding the minimum matching
2070
length.
2071
2072
Arguments:
2073
  code        points to start of expression
2074
  utf         TRUE in UTF-8 / UTF-16 / UTF-32 mode
2075
  number      the required bracket number or negative to find a lookbehind
2076
2077
Returns:      pointer to the opcode for the bracket, or NULL if not found
2078
*/
2079
2080
const pcre_uchar *
2081
PRIV(find_bracket)(const pcre_uchar *code, BOOL utf, int number)
2082
0
{
2083
0
for (;;)
2084
0
  {
2085
0
  register pcre_uchar c = *code;
2086
2087
0
  if (c == OP_END) return NULL;
2088
2089
  /* XCLASS is used for classes that cannot be represented just by a bit
2090
  map. This includes negated single high-valued characters. The length in
2091
  the table is zero; the actual length is stored in the compiled code. */
2092
2093
0
  if (c == OP_XCLASS) code += GET(code, 1);
2094
2095
  /* Handle recursion */
2096
2097
0
  else if (c == OP_REVERSE)
2098
0
    {
2099
0
    if (number < 0) return (pcre_uchar *)code;
2100
0
    code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[c];
2101
0
    }
2102
2103
  /* Handle capturing bracket */
2104
2105
0
  else if (c == OP_CBRA || c == OP_SCBRA ||
2106
0
           c == OP_CBRAPOS || c == OP_SCBRAPOS)
2107
0
    {
2108
0
    int n = (int)GET2(code, 1+LINK_SIZE);
2109
0
    if (n == number) return (pcre_uchar *)code;
2110
0
    code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[c];
2111
0
    }
2112
2113
  /* Otherwise, we can get the item's length from the table, except that for
2114
  repeated character types, we have to test for \p and \P, which have an extra
2115
  two bytes of parameters, and for MARK/PRUNE/SKIP/THEN with an argument, we
2116
  must add in its length. */
2117
2118
0
  else
2119
0
    {
2120
0
    switch(c)
2121
0
      {
2122
0
      case OP_TYPESTAR:
2123
0
      case OP_TYPEMINSTAR:
2124
0
      case OP_TYPEPLUS:
2125
0
      case OP_TYPEMINPLUS:
2126
0
      case OP_TYPEQUERY:
2127
0
      case OP_TYPEMINQUERY:
2128
0
      case OP_TYPEPOSSTAR:
2129
0
      case OP_TYPEPOSPLUS:
2130
0
      case OP_TYPEPOSQUERY:
2131
0
      if (code[1] == OP_PROP || code[1] == OP_NOTPROP) code += 2;
2132
0
      break;
2133
2134
0
      case OP_TYPEUPTO:
2135
0
      case OP_TYPEMINUPTO:
2136
0
      case OP_TYPEEXACT:
2137
0
      case OP_TYPEPOSUPTO:
2138
0
      if (code[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_PROP || code[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_NOTPROP)
2139
0
        code += 2;
2140
0
      break;
2141
2142
0
      case OP_MARK:
2143
0
      case OP_PRUNE_ARG:
2144
0
      case OP_SKIP_ARG:
2145
0
      case OP_THEN_ARG:
2146
0
      code += code[1];
2147
0
      break;
2148
0
      }
2149
2150
    /* Add in the fixed length from the table */
2151
2152
0
    code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[c];
2153
2154
  /* In UTF-8 mode, opcodes that are followed by a character may be followed by
2155
  a multi-byte character. The length in the table is a minimum, so we have to
2156
  arrange to skip the extra bytes. */
2157
2158
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF && !defined COMPILE_PCRE32
2159
    if (utf) switch(c)
2160
      {
2161
      case OP_CHAR:
2162
      case OP_CHARI:
2163
      case OP_NOT:
2164
      case OP_NOTI:
2165
      case OP_EXACT:
2166
      case OP_EXACTI:
2167
      case OP_NOTEXACT:
2168
      case OP_NOTEXACTI:
2169
      case OP_UPTO:
2170
      case OP_UPTOI:
2171
      case OP_NOTUPTO:
2172
      case OP_NOTUPTOI:
2173
      case OP_MINUPTO:
2174
      case OP_MINUPTOI:
2175
      case OP_NOTMINUPTO:
2176
      case OP_NOTMINUPTOI:
2177
      case OP_POSUPTO:
2178
      case OP_POSUPTOI:
2179
      case OP_NOTPOSUPTO:
2180
      case OP_NOTPOSUPTOI:
2181
      case OP_STAR:
2182
      case OP_STARI:
2183
      case OP_NOTSTAR:
2184
      case OP_NOTSTARI:
2185
      case OP_MINSTAR:
2186
      case OP_MINSTARI:
2187
      case OP_NOTMINSTAR:
2188
      case OP_NOTMINSTARI:
2189
      case OP_POSSTAR:
2190
      case OP_POSSTARI:
2191
      case OP_NOTPOSSTAR:
2192
      case OP_NOTPOSSTARI:
2193
      case OP_PLUS:
2194
      case OP_PLUSI:
2195
      case OP_NOTPLUS:
2196
      case OP_NOTPLUSI:
2197
      case OP_MINPLUS:
2198
      case OP_MINPLUSI:
2199
      case OP_NOTMINPLUS:
2200
      case OP_NOTMINPLUSI:
2201
      case OP_POSPLUS:
2202
      case OP_POSPLUSI:
2203
      case OP_NOTPOSPLUS:
2204
      case OP_NOTPOSPLUSI:
2205
      case OP_QUERY:
2206
      case OP_QUERYI:
2207
      case OP_NOTQUERY:
2208
      case OP_NOTQUERYI:
2209
      case OP_MINQUERY:
2210
      case OP_MINQUERYI:
2211
      case OP_NOTMINQUERY:
2212
      case OP_NOTMINQUERYI:
2213
      case OP_POSQUERY:
2214
      case OP_POSQUERYI:
2215
      case OP_NOTPOSQUERY:
2216
      case OP_NOTPOSQUERYI:
2217
      if (HAS_EXTRALEN(code[-1])) code += GET_EXTRALEN(code[-1]);
2218
      break;
2219
      }
2220
#else
2221
0
    (void)(utf);  /* Keep compiler happy by referencing function argument */
2222
0
#endif
2223
0
    }
2224
0
  }
2225
0
}
2226
2227
2228
2229
/*************************************************
2230
*   Scan compiled regex for recursion reference  *
2231
*************************************************/
2232
2233
/* This little function scans through a compiled pattern until it finds an
2234
instance of OP_RECURSE.
2235
2236
Arguments:
2237
  code        points to start of expression
2238
  utf         TRUE in UTF-8 / UTF-16 / UTF-32 mode
2239
2240
Returns:      pointer to the opcode for OP_RECURSE, or NULL if not found
2241
*/
2242
2243
static const pcre_uchar *
2244
find_recurse(const pcre_uchar *code, BOOL utf)
2245
0
{
2246
0
for (;;)
2247
0
  {
2248
0
  register pcre_uchar c = *code;
2249
0
  if (c == OP_END) return NULL;
2250
0
  if (c == OP_RECURSE) return code;
2251
2252
  /* XCLASS is used for classes that cannot be represented just by a bit
2253
  map. This includes negated single high-valued characters. The length in
2254
  the table is zero; the actual length is stored in the compiled code. */
2255
2256
0
  if (c == OP_XCLASS) code += GET(code, 1);
2257
2258
  /* Otherwise, we can get the item's length from the table, except that for
2259
  repeated character types, we have to test for \p and \P, which have an extra
2260
  two bytes of parameters, and for MARK/PRUNE/SKIP/THEN with an argument, we
2261
  must add in its length. */
2262
2263
0
  else
2264
0
    {
2265
0
    switch(c)
2266
0
      {
2267
0
      case OP_TYPESTAR:
2268
0
      case OP_TYPEMINSTAR:
2269
0
      case OP_TYPEPLUS:
2270
0
      case OP_TYPEMINPLUS:
2271
0
      case OP_TYPEQUERY:
2272
0
      case OP_TYPEMINQUERY:
2273
0
      case OP_TYPEPOSSTAR:
2274
0
      case OP_TYPEPOSPLUS:
2275
0
      case OP_TYPEPOSQUERY:
2276
0
      if (code[1] == OP_PROP || code[1] == OP_NOTPROP) code += 2;
2277
0
      break;
2278
2279
0
      case OP_TYPEPOSUPTO:
2280
0
      case OP_TYPEUPTO:
2281
0
      case OP_TYPEMINUPTO:
2282
0
      case OP_TYPEEXACT:
2283
0
      if (code[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_PROP || code[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_NOTPROP)
2284
0
        code += 2;
2285
0
      break;
2286
2287
0
      case OP_MARK:
2288
0
      case OP_PRUNE_ARG:
2289
0
      case OP_SKIP_ARG:
2290
0
      case OP_THEN_ARG:
2291
0
      code += code[1];
2292
0
      break;
2293
0
      }
2294
2295
    /* Add in the fixed length from the table */
2296
2297
0
    code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[c];
2298
2299
    /* In UTF-8 mode, opcodes that are followed by a character may be followed
2300
    by a multi-byte character. The length in the table is a minimum, so we have
2301
    to arrange to skip the extra bytes. */
2302
2303
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF && !defined COMPILE_PCRE32
2304
    if (utf) switch(c)
2305
      {
2306
      case OP_CHAR:
2307
      case OP_CHARI:
2308
      case OP_NOT:
2309
      case OP_NOTI:
2310
      case OP_EXACT:
2311
      case OP_EXACTI:
2312
      case OP_NOTEXACT:
2313
      case OP_NOTEXACTI:
2314
      case OP_UPTO:
2315
      case OP_UPTOI:
2316
      case OP_NOTUPTO:
2317
      case OP_NOTUPTOI:
2318
      case OP_MINUPTO:
2319
      case OP_MINUPTOI:
2320
      case OP_NOTMINUPTO:
2321
      case OP_NOTMINUPTOI:
2322
      case OP_POSUPTO:
2323
      case OP_POSUPTOI:
2324
      case OP_NOTPOSUPTO:
2325
      case OP_NOTPOSUPTOI:
2326
      case OP_STAR:
2327
      case OP_STARI:
2328
      case OP_NOTSTAR:
2329
      case OP_NOTSTARI:
2330
      case OP_MINSTAR:
2331
      case OP_MINSTARI:
2332
      case OP_NOTMINSTAR:
2333
      case OP_NOTMINSTARI:
2334
      case OP_POSSTAR:
2335
      case OP_POSSTARI:
2336
      case OP_NOTPOSSTAR:
2337
      case OP_NOTPOSSTARI:
2338
      case OP_PLUS:
2339
      case OP_PLUSI:
2340
      case OP_NOTPLUS:
2341
      case OP_NOTPLUSI:
2342
      case OP_MINPLUS:
2343
      case OP_MINPLUSI:
2344
      case OP_NOTMINPLUS:
2345
      case OP_NOTMINPLUSI:
2346
      case OP_POSPLUS:
2347
      case OP_POSPLUSI:
2348
      case OP_NOTPOSPLUS:
2349
      case OP_NOTPOSPLUSI:
2350
      case OP_QUERY:
2351
      case OP_QUERYI:
2352
      case OP_NOTQUERY:
2353
      case OP_NOTQUERYI:
2354
      case OP_MINQUERY:
2355
      case OP_MINQUERYI:
2356
      case OP_NOTMINQUERY:
2357
      case OP_NOTMINQUERYI:
2358
      case OP_POSQUERY:
2359
      case OP_POSQUERYI:
2360
      case OP_NOTPOSQUERY:
2361
      case OP_NOTPOSQUERYI:
2362
      if (HAS_EXTRALEN(code[-1])) code += GET_EXTRALEN(code[-1]);
2363
      break;
2364
      }
2365
#else
2366
0
    (void)(utf);  /* Keep compiler happy by referencing function argument */
2367
0
#endif
2368
0
    }
2369
0
  }
2370
0
}
2371
2372
2373
2374
/*************************************************
2375
*    Scan compiled branch for non-emptiness      *
2376
*************************************************/
2377
2378
/* This function scans through a branch of a compiled pattern to see whether it
2379
can match the empty string or not. It is called from could_be_empty()
2380
below and from compile_branch() when checking for an unlimited repeat of a
2381
group that can match nothing. Note that first_significant_code() skips over
2382
backward and negative forward assertions when its final argument is TRUE. If we
2383
hit an unclosed bracket, we return "empty" - this means we've struck an inner
2384
bracket whose current branch will already have been scanned.
2385
2386
Arguments:
2387
  code        points to start of search
2388
  endcode     points to where to stop
2389
  utf         TRUE if in UTF-8 / UTF-16 / UTF-32 mode
2390
  cd          contains pointers to tables etc.
2391
  recurses    chain of recurse_check to catch mutual recursion
2392
2393
Returns:      TRUE if what is matched could be empty
2394
*/
2395
2396
static BOOL
2397
could_be_empty_branch(const pcre_uchar *code, const pcre_uchar *endcode,
2398
  BOOL utf, compile_data *cd, recurse_check *recurses)
2399
0
{
2400
0
register pcre_uchar c;
2401
0
recurse_check this_recurse;
2402
2403
0
for (code = first_significant_code(code + PRIV(OP_lengths)[*code], TRUE);
2404
0
     code < endcode;
2405
0
     code = first_significant_code(code + PRIV(OP_lengths)[c], TRUE))
2406
0
  {
2407
0
  const pcre_uchar *ccode;
2408
2409
0
  c = *code;
2410
2411
  /* Skip over forward assertions; the other assertions are skipped by
2412
  first_significant_code() with a TRUE final argument. */
2413
2414
0
  if (c == OP_ASSERT)
2415
0
    {
2416
0
    do code += GET(code, 1); while (*code == OP_ALT);
2417
0
    c = *code;
2418
0
    continue;
2419
0
    }
2420
2421
  /* For a recursion/subroutine call, if its end has been reached, which
2422
  implies a backward reference subroutine call, we can scan it. If it's a
2423
  forward reference subroutine call, we can't. To detect forward reference
2424
  we have to scan up the list that is kept in the workspace. This function is
2425
  called only when doing the real compile, not during the pre-compile that
2426
  measures the size of the compiled pattern. */
2427
2428
0
  if (c == OP_RECURSE)
2429
0
    {
2430
0
    const pcre_uchar *scode = cd->start_code + GET(code, 1);
2431
0
    const pcre_uchar *endgroup = scode;
2432
0
    BOOL empty_branch;
2433
2434
    /* Test for forward reference or uncompleted reference. This is disabled
2435
    when called to scan a completed pattern by setting cd->start_workspace to
2436
    NULL. */
2437
2438
0
    if (cd->start_workspace != NULL)
2439
0
      {
2440
0
      const pcre_uchar *tcode;
2441
0
      for (tcode = cd->start_workspace; tcode < cd->hwm; tcode += LINK_SIZE)
2442
0
        if ((int)GET(tcode, 0) == (int)(code + 1 - cd->start_code)) return TRUE;
2443
0
      if (GET(scode, 1) == 0) return TRUE;    /* Unclosed */
2444
0
      }
2445
2446
    /* If the reference is to a completed group, we need to detect whether this
2447
    is a recursive call, as otherwise there will be an infinite loop. If it is
2448
    a recursion, just skip over it. Simple recursions are easily detected. For
2449
    mutual recursions we keep a chain on the stack. */
2450
2451
0
    do endgroup += GET(endgroup, 1); while (*endgroup == OP_ALT);
2452
0
    if (code >= scode && code <= endgroup) continue;  /* Simple recursion */
2453
0
    else
2454
0
      {
2455
0
      recurse_check *r = recurses;
2456
0
      for (r = recurses; r != NULL; r = r->prev)
2457
0
        if (r->group == scode) break;
2458
0
      if (r != NULL) continue;   /* Mutual recursion */
2459
0
      }
2460
2461
    /* Completed reference; scan the referenced group, remembering it on the
2462
    stack chain to detect mutual recursions. */
2463
2464
0
    empty_branch = FALSE;
2465
0
    this_recurse.prev = recurses;
2466
0
    this_recurse.group = scode;
2467
2468
0
    do
2469
0
      {
2470
0
      if (could_be_empty_branch(scode, endcode, utf, cd, &this_recurse))
2471
0
        {
2472
0
        empty_branch = TRUE;
2473
0
        break;
2474
0
        }
2475
0
      scode += GET(scode, 1);
2476
0
      }
2477
0
    while (*scode == OP_ALT);
2478
2479
0
    if (!empty_branch) return FALSE;  /* All branches are non-empty */
2480
0
    continue;
2481
0
    }
2482
2483
  /* Groups with zero repeats can of course be empty; skip them. */
2484
2485
0
  if (c == OP_BRAZERO || c == OP_BRAMINZERO || c == OP_SKIPZERO ||
2486
0
      c == OP_BRAPOSZERO)
2487
0
    {
2488
0
    code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[c];
2489
0
    do code += GET(code, 1); while (*code == OP_ALT);
2490
0
    c = *code;
2491
0
    continue;
2492
0
    }
2493
2494
  /* A nested group that is already marked as "could be empty" can just be
2495
  skipped. */
2496
2497
0
  if (c == OP_SBRA  || c == OP_SBRAPOS ||
2498
0
      c == OP_SCBRA || c == OP_SCBRAPOS)
2499
0
    {
2500
0
    do code += GET(code, 1); while (*code == OP_ALT);
2501
0
    c = *code;
2502
0
    continue;
2503
0
    }
2504
2505
  /* For other groups, scan the branches. */
2506
2507
0
  if (c == OP_BRA  || c == OP_BRAPOS ||
2508
0
      c == OP_CBRA || c == OP_CBRAPOS ||
2509
0
      c == OP_ONCE || c == OP_ONCE_NC ||
2510
0
      c == OP_COND || c == OP_SCOND)
2511
0
    {
2512
0
    BOOL empty_branch;
2513
0
    if (GET(code, 1) == 0) return TRUE;    /* Hit unclosed bracket */
2514
2515
    /* If a conditional group has only one branch, there is a second, implied,
2516
    empty branch, so just skip over the conditional, because it could be empty.
2517
    Otherwise, scan the individual branches of the group. */
2518
2519
0
    if (c == OP_COND && code[GET(code, 1)] != OP_ALT)
2520
0
      code += GET(code, 1);
2521
0
    else
2522
0
      {
2523
0
      empty_branch = FALSE;
2524
0
      do
2525
0
        {
2526
0
        if (!empty_branch && could_be_empty_branch(code, endcode, utf, cd,
2527
0
          recurses)) empty_branch = TRUE;
2528
0
        code += GET(code, 1);
2529
0
        }
2530
0
      while (*code == OP_ALT);
2531
0
      if (!empty_branch) return FALSE;   /* All branches are non-empty */
2532
0
      }
2533
2534
0
    c = *code;
2535
0
    continue;
2536
0
    }
2537
2538
  /* Handle the other opcodes */
2539
2540
0
  switch (c)
2541
0
    {
2542
    /* Check for quantifiers after a class. XCLASS is used for classes that
2543
    cannot be represented just by a bit map. This includes negated single
2544
    high-valued characters. The length in PRIV(OP_lengths)[] is zero; the
2545
    actual length is stored in the compiled code, so we must update "code"
2546
    here. */
2547
2548
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
2549
    case OP_XCLASS:
2550
    ccode = code += GET(code, 1);
2551
    goto CHECK_CLASS_REPEAT;
2552
#endif
2553
2554
0
    case OP_CLASS:
2555
0
    case OP_NCLASS:
2556
0
    ccode = code + PRIV(OP_lengths)[OP_CLASS];
2557
2558
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
2559
    CHECK_CLASS_REPEAT:
2560
#endif
2561
2562
0
    switch (*ccode)
2563
0
      {
2564
0
      case OP_CRSTAR:            /* These could be empty; continue */
2565
0
      case OP_CRMINSTAR:
2566
0
      case OP_CRQUERY:
2567
0
      case OP_CRMINQUERY:
2568
0
      case OP_CRPOSSTAR:
2569
0
      case OP_CRPOSQUERY:
2570
0
      break;
2571
2572
0
      default:                   /* Non-repeat => class must match */
2573
0
      case OP_CRPLUS:            /* These repeats aren't empty */
2574
0
      case OP_CRMINPLUS:
2575
0
      case OP_CRPOSPLUS:
2576
0
      return FALSE;
2577
2578
0
      case OP_CRRANGE:
2579
0
      case OP_CRMINRANGE:
2580
0
      case OP_CRPOSRANGE:
2581
0
      if (GET2(ccode, 1) > 0) return FALSE;  /* Minimum > 0 */
2582
0
      break;
2583
0
      }
2584
0
    break;
2585
2586
    /* Opcodes that must match a character */
2587
2588
0
    case OP_ANY:
2589
0
    case OP_ALLANY:
2590
0
    case OP_ANYBYTE:
2591
2592
0
    case OP_PROP:
2593
0
    case OP_NOTPROP:
2594
0
    case OP_ANYNL:
2595
2596
0
    case OP_NOT_HSPACE:
2597
0
    case OP_HSPACE:
2598
0
    case OP_NOT_VSPACE:
2599
0
    case OP_VSPACE:
2600
0
    case OP_EXTUNI:
2601
2602
0
    case OP_NOT_DIGIT:
2603
0
    case OP_DIGIT:
2604
0
    case OP_NOT_WHITESPACE:
2605
0
    case OP_WHITESPACE:
2606
0
    case OP_NOT_WORDCHAR:
2607
0
    case OP_WORDCHAR:
2608
2609
0
    case OP_CHAR:
2610
0
    case OP_CHARI:
2611
0
    case OP_NOT:
2612
0
    case OP_NOTI:
2613
2614
0
    case OP_PLUS:
2615
0
    case OP_PLUSI:
2616
0
    case OP_MINPLUS:
2617
0
    case OP_MINPLUSI:
2618
2619
0
    case OP_NOTPLUS:
2620
0
    case OP_NOTPLUSI:
2621
0
    case OP_NOTMINPLUS:
2622
0
    case OP_NOTMINPLUSI:
2623
2624
0
    case OP_POSPLUS:
2625
0
    case OP_POSPLUSI:
2626
0
    case OP_NOTPOSPLUS:
2627
0
    case OP_NOTPOSPLUSI:
2628
2629
0
    case OP_EXACT:
2630
0
    case OP_EXACTI:
2631
0
    case OP_NOTEXACT:
2632
0
    case OP_NOTEXACTI:
2633
2634
0
    case OP_TYPEPLUS:
2635
0
    case OP_TYPEMINPLUS:
2636
0
    case OP_TYPEPOSPLUS:
2637
0
    case OP_TYPEEXACT:
2638
2639
0
    return FALSE;
2640
2641
    /* These are going to continue, as they may be empty, but we have to
2642
    fudge the length for the \p and \P cases. */
2643
2644
0
    case OP_TYPESTAR:
2645
0
    case OP_TYPEMINSTAR:
2646
0
    case OP_TYPEPOSSTAR:
2647
0
    case OP_TYPEQUERY:
2648
0
    case OP_TYPEMINQUERY:
2649
0
    case OP_TYPEPOSQUERY:
2650
0
    if (code[1] == OP_PROP || code[1] == OP_NOTPROP) code += 2;
2651
0
    break;
2652
2653
    /* Same for these */
2654
2655
0
    case OP_TYPEUPTO:
2656
0
    case OP_TYPEMINUPTO:
2657
0
    case OP_TYPEPOSUPTO:
2658
0
    if (code[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_PROP || code[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_NOTPROP)
2659
0
      code += 2;
2660
0
    break;
2661
2662
    /* End of branch */
2663
2664
0
    case OP_KET:
2665
0
    case OP_KETRMAX:
2666
0
    case OP_KETRMIN:
2667
0
    case OP_KETRPOS:
2668
0
    case OP_ALT:
2669
0
    return TRUE;
2670
2671
    /* In UTF-8 mode, STAR, MINSTAR, POSSTAR, QUERY, MINQUERY, POSQUERY, UPTO,
2672
    MINUPTO, and POSUPTO and their caseless and negative versions may be
2673
    followed by a multibyte character. */
2674
2675
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF && !defined COMPILE_PCRE32
2676
    case OP_STAR:
2677
    case OP_STARI:
2678
    case OP_NOTSTAR:
2679
    case OP_NOTSTARI:
2680
2681
    case OP_MINSTAR:
2682
    case OP_MINSTARI:
2683
    case OP_NOTMINSTAR:
2684
    case OP_NOTMINSTARI:
2685
2686
    case OP_POSSTAR:
2687
    case OP_POSSTARI:
2688
    case OP_NOTPOSSTAR:
2689
    case OP_NOTPOSSTARI:
2690
2691
    case OP_QUERY:
2692
    case OP_QUERYI:
2693
    case OP_NOTQUERY:
2694
    case OP_NOTQUERYI:
2695
2696
    case OP_MINQUERY:
2697
    case OP_MINQUERYI:
2698
    case OP_NOTMINQUERY:
2699
    case OP_NOTMINQUERYI:
2700
2701
    case OP_POSQUERY:
2702
    case OP_POSQUERYI:
2703
    case OP_NOTPOSQUERY:
2704
    case OP_NOTPOSQUERYI:
2705
2706
    if (utf && HAS_EXTRALEN(code[1])) code += GET_EXTRALEN(code[1]);
2707
    break;
2708
2709
    case OP_UPTO:
2710
    case OP_UPTOI:
2711
    case OP_NOTUPTO:
2712
    case OP_NOTUPTOI:
2713
2714
    case OP_MINUPTO:
2715
    case OP_MINUPTOI:
2716
    case OP_NOTMINUPTO:
2717
    case OP_NOTMINUPTOI:
2718
2719
    case OP_POSUPTO:
2720
    case OP_POSUPTOI:
2721
    case OP_NOTPOSUPTO:
2722
    case OP_NOTPOSUPTOI:
2723
2724
    if (utf && HAS_EXTRALEN(code[1 + IMM2_SIZE])) code += GET_EXTRALEN(code[1 + IMM2_SIZE]);
2725
    break;
2726
#endif
2727
2728
    /* MARK, and PRUNE/SKIP/THEN with an argument must skip over the argument
2729
    string. */
2730
2731
0
    case OP_MARK:
2732
0
    case OP_PRUNE_ARG:
2733
0
    case OP_SKIP_ARG:
2734
0
    case OP_THEN_ARG:
2735
0
    code += code[1];
2736
0
    break;
2737
2738
    /* None of the remaining opcodes are required to match a character. */
2739
2740
0
    default:
2741
0
    break;
2742
0
    }
2743
0
  }
2744
2745
0
return TRUE;
2746
0
}
2747
2748
2749
2750
/*************************************************
2751
*    Scan compiled regex for non-emptiness       *
2752
*************************************************/
2753
2754
/* This function is called to check for left recursive calls. We want to check
2755
the current branch of the current pattern to see if it could match the empty
2756
string. If it could, we must look outwards for branches at other levels,
2757
stopping when we pass beyond the bracket which is the subject of the recursion.
2758
This function is called only during the real compile, not during the
2759
pre-compile.
2760
2761
Arguments:
2762
  code        points to start of the recursion
2763
  endcode     points to where to stop (current RECURSE item)
2764
  bcptr       points to the chain of current (unclosed) branch starts
2765
  utf         TRUE if in UTF-8 / UTF-16 / UTF-32 mode
2766
  cd          pointers to tables etc
2767
2768
Returns:      TRUE if what is matched could be empty
2769
*/
2770
2771
static BOOL
2772
could_be_empty(const pcre_uchar *code, const pcre_uchar *endcode,
2773
  branch_chain *bcptr, BOOL utf, compile_data *cd)
2774
0
{
2775
0
while (bcptr != NULL && bcptr->current_branch >= code)
2776
0
  {
2777
0
  if (!could_be_empty_branch(bcptr->current_branch, endcode, utf, cd, NULL))
2778
0
    return FALSE;
2779
0
  bcptr = bcptr->outer;
2780
0
  }
2781
0
return TRUE;
2782
0
}
2783
2784
2785
2786
/*************************************************
2787
*        Base opcode of repeated opcodes         *
2788
*************************************************/
2789
2790
/* Returns the base opcode for repeated single character type opcodes. If the
2791
opcode is not a repeated character type, it returns with the original value.
2792
2793
Arguments:  c opcode
2794
Returns:    base opcode for the type
2795
*/
2796
2797
static pcre_uchar
2798
get_repeat_base(pcre_uchar c)
2799
0
{
2800
0
return (c > OP_TYPEPOSUPTO)? c :
2801
0
       (c >= OP_TYPESTAR)?   OP_TYPESTAR :
2802
0
       (c >= OP_NOTSTARI)?   OP_NOTSTARI :
2803
0
       (c >= OP_NOTSTAR)?    OP_NOTSTAR :
2804
0
       (c >= OP_STARI)?      OP_STARI :
2805
0
                             OP_STAR;
2806
0
}
2807
2808
2809
2810
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
2811
/*************************************************
2812
*        Check a character and a property        *
2813
*************************************************/
2814
2815
/* This function is called by check_auto_possessive() when a property item
2816
is adjacent to a fixed character.
2817
2818
Arguments:
2819
  c            the character
2820
  ptype        the property type
2821
  pdata        the data for the type
2822
  negated      TRUE if it's a negated property (\P or \p{^)
2823
2824
Returns:       TRUE if auto-possessifying is OK
2825
*/
2826
2827
static BOOL
2828
check_char_prop(pcre_uint32 c, unsigned int ptype, unsigned int pdata,
2829
  BOOL negated)
2830
{
2831
const pcre_uint32 *p;
2832
const ucd_record *prop = GET_UCD(c);
2833
2834
switch(ptype)
2835
  {
2836
  case PT_LAMP:
2837
  return (prop->chartype == ucp_Lu ||
2838
          prop->chartype == ucp_Ll ||
2839
          prop->chartype == ucp_Lt) == negated;
2840
2841
  case PT_GC:
2842
  return (pdata == PRIV(ucp_gentype)[prop->chartype]) == negated;
2843
2844
  case PT_PC:
2845
  return (pdata == prop->chartype) == negated;
2846
2847
  case PT_SC:
2848
  return (pdata == prop->script) == negated;
2849
2850
  /* These are specials */
2851
2852
  case PT_ALNUM:
2853
  return (PRIV(ucp_gentype)[prop->chartype] == ucp_L ||
2854
          PRIV(ucp_gentype)[prop->chartype] == ucp_N) == negated;
2855
2856
  /* Perl space used to exclude VT, but from Perl 5.18 it is included, which
2857
  means that Perl space and POSIX space are now identical. PCRE was changed
2858
  at release 8.34. */
2859
2860
  case PT_SPACE:    /* Perl space */
2861
  case PT_PXSPACE:  /* POSIX space */
2862
  switch(c)
2863
    {
2864
    HSPACE_CASES:
2865
    VSPACE_CASES:
2866
    return negated;
2867
2868
    default:
2869
    return (PRIV(ucp_gentype)[prop->chartype] == ucp_Z) == negated;
2870
    }
2871
  break;  /* Control never reaches here */
2872
2873
  case PT_WORD:
2874
  return (PRIV(ucp_gentype)[prop->chartype] == ucp_L ||
2875
          PRIV(ucp_gentype)[prop->chartype] == ucp_N ||
2876
          c == CHAR_UNDERSCORE) == negated;
2877
2878
  case PT_CLIST:
2879
  p = PRIV(ucd_caseless_sets) + prop->caseset;
2880
  for (;;)
2881
    {
2882
    if (c < *p) return !negated;
2883
    if (c == *p++) return negated;
2884
    }
2885
  break;  /* Control never reaches here */
2886
  }
2887
2888
return FALSE;
2889
}
2890
#endif  /* SUPPORT_UCP */
2891
2892
2893
2894
/*************************************************
2895
*        Fill the character property list        *
2896
*************************************************/
2897
2898
/* Checks whether the code points to an opcode that can take part in auto-
2899
possessification, and if so, fills a list with its properties.
2900
2901
Arguments:
2902
  code        points to start of expression
2903
  utf         TRUE if in UTF-8 / UTF-16 / UTF-32 mode
2904
  fcc         points to case-flipping table
2905
  list        points to output list
2906
              list[0] will be filled with the opcode
2907
              list[1] will be non-zero if this opcode
2908
                can match an empty character string
2909
              list[2..7] depends on the opcode
2910
2911
Returns:      points to the start of the next opcode if *code is accepted
2912
              NULL if *code is not accepted
2913
*/
2914
2915
static const pcre_uchar *
2916
get_chr_property_list(const pcre_uchar *code, BOOL utf,
2917
  const pcre_uint8 *fcc, pcre_uint32 *list)
2918
0
{
2919
0
pcre_uchar c = *code;
2920
0
pcre_uchar base;
2921
0
const pcre_uchar *end;
2922
0
pcre_uint32 chr;
2923
2924
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
2925
pcre_uint32 *clist_dest;
2926
const pcre_uint32 *clist_src;
2927
#else
2928
0
((void)utf); /* Suppress "unused parameter" compiler warning */
2929
0
#endif
2930
2931
0
list[0] = c;
2932
0
list[1] = FALSE;
2933
0
code++;
2934
2935
0
if (c >= OP_STAR && c <= OP_TYPEPOSUPTO)
2936
0
  {
2937
0
  base = get_repeat_base(c);
2938
0
  c -= (base - OP_STAR);
2939
2940
0
  if (c == OP_UPTO || c == OP_MINUPTO || c == OP_EXACT || c == OP_POSUPTO)
2941
0
    code += IMM2_SIZE;
2942
2943
0
  list[1] = (c != OP_PLUS && c != OP_MINPLUS && c != OP_EXACT && c != OP_POSPLUS);
2944
2945
0
  switch(base)
2946
0
    {
2947
0
    case OP_STAR:
2948
0
    list[0] = OP_CHAR;
2949
0
    break;
2950
2951
0
    case OP_STARI:
2952
0
    list[0] = OP_CHARI;
2953
0
    break;
2954
2955
0
    case OP_NOTSTAR:
2956
0
    list[0] = OP_NOT;
2957
0
    break;
2958
2959
0
    case OP_NOTSTARI:
2960
0
    list[0] = OP_NOTI;
2961
0
    break;
2962
2963
0
    case OP_TYPESTAR:
2964
0
    list[0] = *code;
2965
0
    code++;
2966
0
    break;
2967
0
    }
2968
0
  c = list[0];
2969
0
  }
2970
2971
0
switch(c)
2972
0
  {
2973
0
  case OP_NOT_DIGIT:
2974
0
  case OP_DIGIT:
2975
0
  case OP_NOT_WHITESPACE:
2976
0
  case OP_WHITESPACE:
2977
0
  case OP_NOT_WORDCHAR:
2978
0
  case OP_WORDCHAR:
2979
0
  case OP_ANY:
2980
0
  case OP_ALLANY:
2981
0
  case OP_ANYNL:
2982
0
  case OP_NOT_HSPACE:
2983
0
  case OP_HSPACE:
2984
0
  case OP_NOT_VSPACE:
2985
0
  case OP_VSPACE:
2986
0
  case OP_EXTUNI:
2987
0
  case OP_EODN:
2988
0
  case OP_EOD:
2989
0
  case OP_DOLL:
2990
0
  case OP_DOLLM:
2991
0
  return code;
2992
2993
0
  case OP_CHAR:
2994
0
  case OP_NOT:
2995
0
  GETCHARINCTEST(chr, code);
2996
0
  list[2] = chr;
2997
0
  list[3] = NOTACHAR;
2998
0
  return code;
2999
3000
0
  case OP_CHARI:
3001
0
  case OP_NOTI:
3002
0
  list[0] = (c == OP_CHARI) ? OP_CHAR : OP_NOT;
3003
0
  GETCHARINCTEST(chr, code);
3004
0
  list[2] = chr;
3005
3006
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
3007
  if (chr < 128 || (chr < 256 && !utf))
3008
    list[3] = fcc[chr];
3009
  else
3010
    list[3] = UCD_OTHERCASE(chr);
3011
#elif defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
3012
  list[3] = (chr < 256) ? fcc[chr] : chr;
3013
#else
3014
0
  list[3] = fcc[chr];
3015
0
#endif
3016
3017
  /* The othercase might be the same value. */
3018
3019
0
  if (chr == list[3])
3020
0
    list[3] = NOTACHAR;
3021
0
  else
3022
0
    list[4] = NOTACHAR;
3023
0
  return code;
3024
3025
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
3026
  case OP_PROP:
3027
  case OP_NOTPROP:
3028
  if (code[0] != PT_CLIST)
3029
    {
3030
    list[2] = code[0];
3031
    list[3] = code[1];
3032
    return code + 2;
3033
    }
3034
3035
  /* Convert only if we have enough space. */
3036
3037
  clist_src = PRIV(ucd_caseless_sets) + code[1];
3038
  clist_dest = list + 2;
3039
  code += 2;
3040
3041
  do {
3042
     if (clist_dest >= list + 8)
3043
       {
3044
       /* Early return if there is not enough space. This should never
3045
       happen, since all clists are shorter than 5 character now. */
3046
       list[2] = code[0];
3047
       list[3] = code[1];
3048
       return code;
3049
       }
3050
     *clist_dest++ = *clist_src;
3051
     }
3052
  while(*clist_src++ != NOTACHAR);
3053
3054
  /* All characters are stored. The terminating NOTACHAR
3055
  is copied form the clist itself. */
3056
3057
  list[0] = (c == OP_PROP) ? OP_CHAR : OP_NOT;
3058
  return code;
3059
#endif
3060
3061
0
  case OP_NCLASS:
3062
0
  case OP_CLASS:
3063
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
3064
  case OP_XCLASS:
3065
  if (c == OP_XCLASS)
3066
    end = code + GET(code, 0) - 1;
3067
  else
3068
#endif
3069
0
    end = code + 32 / sizeof(pcre_uchar);
3070
3071
0
  switch(*end)
3072
0
    {
3073
0
    case OP_CRSTAR:
3074
0
    case OP_CRMINSTAR:
3075
0
    case OP_CRQUERY:
3076
0
    case OP_CRMINQUERY:
3077
0
    case OP_CRPOSSTAR:
3078
0
    case OP_CRPOSQUERY:
3079
0
    list[1] = TRUE;
3080
0
    end++;
3081
0
    break;
3082
3083
0
    case OP_CRPLUS:
3084
0
    case OP_CRMINPLUS:
3085
0
    case OP_CRPOSPLUS:
3086
0
    end++;
3087
0
    break;
3088
3089
0
    case OP_CRRANGE:
3090
0
    case OP_CRMINRANGE:
3091
0
    case OP_CRPOSRANGE:
3092
0
    list[1] = (GET2(end, 1) == 0);
3093
0
    end += 1 + 2 * IMM2_SIZE;
3094
0
    break;
3095
0
    }
3096
0
  list[2] = (pcre_uint32)(end - code);
3097
0
  return end;
3098
0
  }
3099
0
return NULL;    /* Opcode not accepted */
3100
0
}
3101
3102
3103
3104
/*************************************************
3105
*    Scan further character sets for match       *
3106
*************************************************/
3107
3108
/* Checks whether the base and the current opcode have a common character, in
3109
which case the base cannot be possessified.
3110
3111
Arguments:
3112
  code        points to the byte code
3113
  utf         TRUE in UTF-8 / UTF-16 / UTF-32 mode
3114
  cd          static compile data
3115
  base_list   the data list of the base opcode
3116
3117
Returns:      TRUE if the auto-possessification is possible
3118
*/
3119
3120
static BOOL
3121
compare_opcodes(const pcre_uchar *code, BOOL utf, const compile_data *cd,
3122
  const pcre_uint32 *base_list, const pcre_uchar *base_end, int *rec_limit)
3123
0
{
3124
0
pcre_uchar c;
3125
0
pcre_uint32 list[8];
3126
0
const pcre_uint32 *chr_ptr;
3127
0
const pcre_uint32 *ochr_ptr;
3128
0
const pcre_uint32 *list_ptr;
3129
0
const pcre_uchar *next_code;
3130
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
3131
const pcre_uchar *xclass_flags;
3132
#endif
3133
0
const pcre_uint8 *class_bitset;
3134
0
const pcre_uint8 *set1, *set2, *set_end;
3135
0
pcre_uint32 chr;
3136
0
BOOL accepted, invert_bits;
3137
0
BOOL entered_a_group = FALSE;
3138
3139
0
if (*rec_limit == 0) return FALSE;
3140
0
--(*rec_limit);
3141
3142
/* Note: the base_list[1] contains whether the current opcode has greedy
3143
(represented by a non-zero value) quantifier. This is a different from
3144
other character type lists, which stores here that the character iterator
3145
matches to an empty string (also represented by a non-zero value). */
3146
3147
0
for(;;)
3148
0
  {
3149
  /* All operations move the code pointer forward.
3150
  Therefore infinite recursions are not possible. */
3151
3152
0
  c = *code;
3153
3154
  /* Skip over callouts */
3155
3156
0
  if (c == OP_CALLOUT)
3157
0
    {
3158
0
    code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[c];
3159
0
    continue;
3160
0
    }
3161
3162
0
  if (c == OP_ALT)
3163
0
    {
3164
0
    do code += GET(code, 1); while (*code == OP_ALT);
3165
0
    c = *code;
3166
0
    }
3167
3168
0
  switch(c)
3169
0
    {
3170
0
    case OP_END:
3171
0
    case OP_KETRPOS:
3172
    /* TRUE only in greedy case. The non-greedy case could be replaced by
3173
    an OP_EXACT, but it is probably not worth it. (And note that OP_EXACT
3174
    uses more memory, which we cannot get at this stage.) */
3175
3176
0
    return base_list[1] != 0;
3177
3178
0
    case OP_KET:
3179
    /* If the bracket is capturing, and referenced by an OP_RECURSE, or
3180
    it is an atomic sub-pattern (assert, once, etc.) the non-greedy case
3181
    cannot be converted to a possessive form. */
3182
3183
0
    if (base_list[1] == 0) return FALSE;
3184
3185
0
    switch(*(code - GET(code, 1)))
3186
0
      {
3187
0
      case OP_ASSERT:
3188
0
      case OP_ASSERT_NOT:
3189
0
      case OP_ASSERTBACK:
3190
0
      case OP_ASSERTBACK_NOT:
3191
0
      case OP_ONCE:
3192
0
      case OP_ONCE_NC:
3193
      /* Atomic sub-patterns and assertions can always auto-possessify their
3194
      last iterator. However, if the group was entered as a result of checking
3195
      a previous iterator, this is not possible. */
3196
3197
0
      return !entered_a_group;
3198
0
      }
3199
3200
0
    code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[c];
3201
0
    continue;
3202
3203
0
    case OP_ONCE:
3204
0
    case OP_ONCE_NC:
3205
0
    case OP_BRA:
3206
0
    case OP_CBRA:
3207
0
    next_code = code + GET(code, 1);
3208
0
    code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[c];
3209
3210
0
    while (*next_code == OP_ALT)
3211
0
      {
3212
0
      if (!compare_opcodes(code, utf, cd, base_list, base_end, rec_limit))
3213
0
        return FALSE;
3214
0
      code = next_code + 1 + LINK_SIZE;
3215
0
      next_code += GET(next_code, 1);
3216
0
      }
3217
3218
0
    entered_a_group = TRUE;
3219
0
    continue;
3220
3221
0
    case OP_BRAZERO:
3222
0
    case OP_BRAMINZERO:
3223
3224
0
    next_code = code + 1;
3225
0
    if (*next_code != OP_BRA && *next_code != OP_CBRA
3226
0
        && *next_code != OP_ONCE && *next_code != OP_ONCE_NC) return FALSE;
3227
3228
0
    do next_code += GET(next_code, 1); while (*next_code == OP_ALT);
3229
3230
    /* The bracket content will be checked by the
3231
    OP_BRA/OP_CBRA case above. */
3232
0
    next_code += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
3233
0
    if (!compare_opcodes(next_code, utf, cd, base_list, base_end, rec_limit))
3234
0
      return FALSE;
3235
3236
0
    code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[c];
3237
0
    continue;
3238
3239
0
    default:
3240
0
    break;
3241
0
    }
3242
3243
  /* Check for a supported opcode, and load its properties. */
3244
3245
0
  code = get_chr_property_list(code, utf, cd->fcc, list);
3246
0
  if (code == NULL) return FALSE;    /* Unsupported */
3247
3248
  /* If either opcode is a small character list, set pointers for comparing
3249
  characters from that list with another list, or with a property. */
3250
3251
0
  if (base_list[0] == OP_CHAR)
3252
0
    {
3253
0
    chr_ptr = base_list + 2;
3254
0
    list_ptr = list;
3255
0
    }
3256
0
  else if (list[0] == OP_CHAR)
3257
0
    {
3258
0
    chr_ptr = list + 2;
3259
0
    list_ptr = base_list;
3260
0
    }
3261
3262
  /* Character bitsets can also be compared to certain opcodes. */
3263
3264
0
  else if (base_list[0] == OP_CLASS || list[0] == OP_CLASS
3265
0
#ifdef COMPILE_PCRE8
3266
      /* In 8 bit, non-UTF mode, OP_CLASS and OP_NCLASS are the same. */
3267
0
      || (!utf && (base_list[0] == OP_NCLASS || list[0] == OP_NCLASS))
3268
0
#endif
3269
0
      )
3270
0
    {
3271
0
#ifdef COMPILE_PCRE8
3272
0
    if (base_list[0] == OP_CLASS || (!utf && base_list[0] == OP_NCLASS))
3273
#else
3274
    if (base_list[0] == OP_CLASS)
3275
#endif
3276
0
      {
3277
0
      set1 = (pcre_uint8 *)(base_end - base_list[2]);
3278
0
      list_ptr = list;
3279
0
      }
3280
0
    else
3281
0
      {
3282
0
      set1 = (pcre_uint8 *)(code - list[2]);
3283
0
      list_ptr = base_list;
3284
0
      }
3285
3286
0
    invert_bits = FALSE;
3287
0
    switch(list_ptr[0])
3288
0
      {
3289
0
      case OP_CLASS:
3290
0
      case OP_NCLASS:
3291
0
      set2 = (pcre_uint8 *)
3292
0
        ((list_ptr == list ? code : base_end) - list_ptr[2]);
3293
0
      break;
3294
3295
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
3296
      case OP_XCLASS:
3297
      xclass_flags = (list_ptr == list ? code : base_end) - list_ptr[2] + LINK_SIZE;
3298
      if ((*xclass_flags & XCL_HASPROP) != 0) return FALSE;
3299
      if ((*xclass_flags & XCL_MAP) == 0)
3300
        {
3301
        /* No bits are set for characters < 256. */
3302
        if (list[1] == 0) return (*xclass_flags & XCL_NOT) == 0;
3303
        /* Might be an empty repeat. */
3304
        continue;
3305
        }
3306
      set2 = (pcre_uint8 *)(xclass_flags + 1);
3307
      break;
3308
#endif
3309
3310
0
      case OP_NOT_DIGIT:
3311
0
      invert_bits = TRUE;
3312
      /* Fall through */
3313
0
      case OP_DIGIT:
3314
0
      set2 = (pcre_uint8 *)(cd->cbits + cbit_digit);
3315
0
      break;
3316
3317
0
      case OP_NOT_WHITESPACE:
3318
0
      invert_bits = TRUE;
3319
      /* Fall through */
3320
0
      case OP_WHITESPACE:
3321
0
      set2 = (pcre_uint8 *)(cd->cbits + cbit_space);
3322
0
      break;
3323
3324
0
      case OP_NOT_WORDCHAR:
3325
0
      invert_bits = TRUE;
3326
      /* Fall through */
3327
0
      case OP_WORDCHAR:
3328
0
      set2 = (pcre_uint8 *)(cd->cbits + cbit_word);
3329
0
      break;
3330
3331
0
      default:
3332
0
      return FALSE;
3333
0
      }
3334
3335
    /* Because the sets are unaligned, we need
3336
    to perform byte comparison here. */
3337
0
    set_end = set1 + 32;
3338
0
    if (invert_bits)
3339
0
      {
3340
0
      do
3341
0
        {
3342
0
        if ((*set1++ & ~(*set2++)) != 0) return FALSE;
3343
0
        }
3344
0
      while (set1 < set_end);
3345
0
      }
3346
0
    else
3347
0
      {
3348
0
      do
3349
0
        {
3350
0
        if ((*set1++ & *set2++) != 0) return FALSE;
3351
0
        }
3352
0
      while (set1 < set_end);
3353
0
      }
3354
3355
0
    if (list[1] == 0) return TRUE;
3356
    /* Might be an empty repeat. */
3357
0
    continue;
3358
0
    }
3359
3360
  /* Some property combinations also acceptable. Unicode property opcodes are
3361
  processed specially; the rest can be handled with a lookup table. */
3362
3363
0
  else
3364
0
    {
3365
0
    pcre_uint32 leftop, rightop;
3366
3367
0
    leftop = base_list[0];
3368
0
    rightop = list[0];
3369
3370
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
3371
    accepted = FALSE; /* Always set in non-unicode case. */
3372
    if (leftop == OP_PROP || leftop == OP_NOTPROP)
3373
      {
3374
      if (rightop == OP_EOD)
3375
        accepted = TRUE;
3376
      else if (rightop == OP_PROP || rightop == OP_NOTPROP)
3377
        {
3378
        int n;
3379
        const pcre_uint8 *p;
3380
        BOOL same = leftop == rightop;
3381
        BOOL lisprop = leftop == OP_PROP;
3382
        BOOL risprop = rightop == OP_PROP;
3383
        BOOL bothprop = lisprop && risprop;
3384
3385
        /* There's a table that specifies how each combination is to be
3386
        processed:
3387
          0   Always return FALSE (never auto-possessify)
3388
          1   Character groups are distinct (possessify if both are OP_PROP)
3389
          2   Check character categories in the same group (general or particular)
3390
          3   Return TRUE if the two opcodes are not the same
3391
          ... see comments below
3392
        */
3393
3394
        n = propposstab[base_list[2]][list[2]];
3395
        switch(n)
3396
          {
3397
          case 0: break;
3398
          case 1: accepted = bothprop; break;
3399
          case 2: accepted = (base_list[3] == list[3]) != same; break;
3400
          case 3: accepted = !same; break;
3401
3402
          case 4:  /* Left general category, right particular category */
3403
          accepted = risprop && catposstab[base_list[3]][list[3]] == same;
3404
          break;
3405
3406
          case 5:  /* Right general category, left particular category */
3407
          accepted = lisprop && catposstab[list[3]][base_list[3]] == same;
3408
          break;
3409
3410
          /* This code is logically tricky. Think hard before fiddling with it.
3411
          The posspropstab table has four entries per row. Each row relates to
3412
          one of PCRE's special properties such as ALNUM or SPACE or WORD.
3413
          Only WORD actually needs all four entries, but using repeats for the
3414
          others means they can all use the same code below.
3415
3416
          The first two entries in each row are Unicode general categories, and
3417
          apply always, because all the characters they include are part of the
3418
          PCRE character set. The third and fourth entries are a general and a
3419
          particular category, respectively, that include one or more relevant
3420
          characters. One or the other is used, depending on whether the check
3421
          is for a general or a particular category. However, in both cases the
3422
          category contains more characters than the specials that are defined
3423
          for the property being tested against. Therefore, it cannot be used
3424
          in a NOTPROP case.
3425
3426
          Example: the row for WORD contains ucp_L, ucp_N, ucp_P, ucp_Po.
3427
          Underscore is covered by ucp_P or ucp_Po. */
3428
3429
          case 6:  /* Left alphanum vs right general category */
3430
          case 7:  /* Left space vs right general category */
3431
          case 8:  /* Left word vs right general category */
3432
          p = posspropstab[n-6];
3433
          accepted = risprop && lisprop ==
3434
            (list[3] != p[0] &&
3435
             list[3] != p[1] &&
3436
            (list[3] != p[2] || !lisprop));
3437
          break;
3438
3439
          case 9:   /* Right alphanum vs left general category */
3440
          case 10:  /* Right space vs left general category */
3441
          case 11:  /* Right word vs left general category */
3442
          p = posspropstab[n-9];
3443
          accepted = lisprop && risprop ==
3444
            (base_list[3] != p[0] &&
3445
             base_list[3] != p[1] &&
3446
            (base_list[3] != p[2] || !risprop));
3447
          break;
3448
3449
          case 12:  /* Left alphanum vs right particular category */
3450
          case 13:  /* Left space vs right particular category */
3451
          case 14:  /* Left word vs right particular category */
3452
          p = posspropstab[n-12];
3453
          accepted = risprop && lisprop ==
3454
            (catposstab[p[0]][list[3]] &&
3455
             catposstab[p[1]][list[3]] &&
3456
            (list[3] != p[3] || !lisprop));
3457
          break;
3458
3459
          case 15:  /* Right alphanum vs left particular category */
3460
          case 16:  /* Right space vs left particular category */
3461
          case 17:  /* Right word vs left particular category */
3462
          p = posspropstab[n-15];
3463
          accepted = lisprop && risprop ==
3464
            (catposstab[p[0]][base_list[3]] &&
3465
             catposstab[p[1]][base_list[3]] &&
3466
            (base_list[3] != p[3] || !risprop));
3467
          break;
3468
          }
3469
        }
3470
      }
3471
3472
    else
3473
#endif  /* SUPPORT_UCP */
3474
3475
0
    accepted = leftop >= FIRST_AUTOTAB_OP && leftop <= LAST_AUTOTAB_LEFT_OP &&
3476
0
           rightop >= FIRST_AUTOTAB_OP && rightop <= LAST_AUTOTAB_RIGHT_OP &&
3477
0
           autoposstab[leftop - FIRST_AUTOTAB_OP][rightop - FIRST_AUTOTAB_OP];
3478
3479
0
    if (!accepted) return FALSE;
3480
3481
0
    if (list[1] == 0) return TRUE;
3482
    /* Might be an empty repeat. */
3483
0
    continue;
3484
0
    }
3485
3486
  /* Control reaches here only if one of the items is a small character list.
3487
  All characters are checked against the other side. */
3488
3489
0
  do
3490
0
    {
3491
0
    chr = *chr_ptr;
3492
3493
0
    switch(list_ptr[0])
3494
0
      {
3495
0
      case OP_CHAR:
3496
0
      ochr_ptr = list_ptr + 2;
3497
0
      do
3498
0
        {
3499
0
        if (chr == *ochr_ptr) return FALSE;
3500
0
        ochr_ptr++;
3501
0
        }
3502
0
      while(*ochr_ptr != NOTACHAR);
3503
0
      break;
3504
3505
0
      case OP_NOT:
3506
0
      ochr_ptr = list_ptr + 2;
3507
0
      do
3508
0
        {
3509
0
        if (chr == *ochr_ptr)
3510
0
          break;
3511
0
        ochr_ptr++;
3512
0
        }
3513
0
      while(*ochr_ptr != NOTACHAR);
3514
0
      if (*ochr_ptr == NOTACHAR) return FALSE;   /* Not found */
3515
0
      break;
3516
3517
      /* Note that OP_DIGIT etc. are generated only when PCRE_UCP is *not*
3518
      set. When it is set, \d etc. are converted into OP_(NOT_)PROP codes. */
3519
3520
0
      case OP_DIGIT:
3521
0
      if (chr < 256 && (cd->ctypes[chr] & ctype_digit) != 0) return FALSE;
3522
0
      break;
3523
3524
0
      case OP_NOT_DIGIT:
3525
0
      if (chr > 255 || (cd->ctypes[chr] & ctype_digit) == 0) return FALSE;
3526
0
      break;
3527
3528
0
      case OP_WHITESPACE:
3529
0
      if (chr < 256 && (cd->ctypes[chr] & ctype_space) != 0) return FALSE;
3530
0
      break;
3531
3532
0
      case OP_NOT_WHITESPACE:
3533
0
      if (chr > 255 || (cd->ctypes[chr] & ctype_space) == 0) return FALSE;
3534
0
      break;
3535
3536
0
      case OP_WORDCHAR:
3537
0
      if (chr < 255 && (cd->ctypes[chr] & ctype_word) != 0) return FALSE;
3538
0
      break;
3539
3540
0
      case OP_NOT_WORDCHAR:
3541
0
      if (chr > 255 || (cd->ctypes[chr] & ctype_word) == 0) return FALSE;
3542
0
      break;
3543
3544
0
      case OP_HSPACE:
3545
0
      switch(chr)
3546
0
        {
3547
0
        HSPACE_CASES: return FALSE;
3548
0
        default: break;
3549
0
        }
3550
0
      break;
3551
3552
0
      case OP_NOT_HSPACE:
3553
0
      switch(chr)
3554
0
        {
3555
0
        HSPACE_CASES: break;
3556
0
        default: return FALSE;
3557
0
        }
3558
0
      break;
3559
3560
0
      case OP_ANYNL:
3561
0
      case OP_VSPACE:
3562
0
      switch(chr)
3563
0
        {
3564
0
        VSPACE_CASES: return FALSE;
3565
0
        default: break;
3566
0
        }
3567
0
      break;
3568
3569
0
      case OP_NOT_VSPACE:
3570
0
      switch(chr)
3571
0
        {
3572
0
        VSPACE_CASES: break;
3573
0
        default: return FALSE;
3574
0
        }
3575
0
      break;
3576
3577
0
      case OP_DOLL:
3578
0
      case OP_EODN:
3579
0
      switch (chr)
3580
0
        {
3581
0
        case CHAR_CR:
3582
0
        case CHAR_LF:
3583
0
        case CHAR_VT:
3584
0
        case CHAR_FF:
3585
0
        case CHAR_NEL:
3586
0
#ifndef EBCDIC
3587
0
        case 0x2028:
3588
0
        case 0x2029:
3589
0
#endif  /* Not EBCDIC */
3590
0
        return FALSE;
3591
0
        }
3592
0
      break;
3593
3594
0
      case OP_EOD:    /* Can always possessify before \z */
3595
0
      break;
3596
3597
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
3598
      case OP_PROP:
3599
      case OP_NOTPROP:
3600
      if (!check_char_prop(chr, list_ptr[2], list_ptr[3],
3601
            list_ptr[0] == OP_NOTPROP))
3602
        return FALSE;
3603
      break;
3604
#endif
3605
3606
0
      case OP_NCLASS:
3607
0
      if (chr > 255) return FALSE;
3608
      /* Fall through */
3609
3610
0
      case OP_CLASS:
3611
0
      if (chr > 255) break;
3612
0
      class_bitset = (pcre_uint8 *)
3613
0
        ((list_ptr == list ? code : base_end) - list_ptr[2]);
3614
0
      if ((class_bitset[chr >> 3] & (1U << (chr & 7))) != 0) return FALSE;
3615
0
      break;
3616
3617
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
3618
      case OP_XCLASS:
3619
      if (PRIV(xclass)(chr, (list_ptr == list ? code : base_end) -
3620
          list_ptr[2] + LINK_SIZE, utf)) return FALSE;
3621
      break;
3622
#endif
3623
3624
0
      default:
3625
0
      return FALSE;
3626
0
      }
3627
3628
0
    chr_ptr++;
3629
0
    }
3630
0
  while(*chr_ptr != NOTACHAR);
3631
3632
  /* At least one character must be matched from this opcode. */
3633
3634
0
  if (list[1] == 0) return TRUE;
3635
0
  }
3636
3637
/* Control never reaches here. There used to be a fail-save return FALSE; here,
3638
but some compilers complain about an unreachable statement. */
3639
3640
0
}
3641
3642
3643
3644
/*************************************************
3645
*    Scan compiled regex for auto-possession     *
3646
*************************************************/
3647
3648
/* Replaces single character iterations with their possessive alternatives
3649
if appropriate. This function modifies the compiled opcode!
3650
3651
Arguments:
3652
  code        points to start of the byte code
3653
  utf         TRUE in UTF-8 / UTF-16 / UTF-32 mode
3654
  cd          static compile data
3655
3656
Returns:      nothing
3657
*/
3658
3659
static void
3660
auto_possessify(pcre_uchar *code, BOOL utf, const compile_data *cd)
3661
0
{
3662
0
register pcre_uchar c;
3663
0
const pcre_uchar *end;
3664
0
pcre_uchar *repeat_opcode;
3665
0
pcre_uint32 list[8];
3666
0
int rec_limit;
3667
3668
0
for (;;)
3669
0
  {
3670
0
  c = *code;
3671
3672
  /* When a pattern with bad UTF-8 encoding is compiled with NO_UTF_CHECK,
3673
  it may compile without complaining, but may get into a loop here if the code
3674
  pointer points to a bad value. This is, of course a documentated possibility,
3675
  when NO_UTF_CHECK is set, so it isn't a bug, but we can detect this case and
3676
  just give up on this optimization. */
3677
3678
0
  if (c >= OP_TABLE_LENGTH) return;
3679
3680
0
  if (c >= OP_STAR && c <= OP_TYPEPOSUPTO)
3681
0
    {
3682
0
    c -= get_repeat_base(c) - OP_STAR;
3683
0
    end = (c <= OP_MINUPTO) ?
3684
0
      get_chr_property_list(code, utf, cd->fcc, list) : NULL;
3685
0
    list[1] = c == OP_STAR || c == OP_PLUS || c == OP_QUERY || c == OP_UPTO;
3686
3687
0
    rec_limit = 1000;
3688
0
    if (end != NULL && compare_opcodes(end, utf, cd, list, end, &rec_limit))
3689
0
      {
3690
0
      switch(c)
3691
0
        {
3692
0
        case OP_STAR:
3693
0
        *code += OP_POSSTAR - OP_STAR;
3694
0
        break;
3695
3696
0
        case OP_MINSTAR:
3697
0
        *code += OP_POSSTAR - OP_MINSTAR;
3698
0
        break;
3699
3700
0
        case OP_PLUS:
3701
0
        *code += OP_POSPLUS - OP_PLUS;
3702
0
        break;
3703
3704
0
        case OP_MINPLUS:
3705
0
        *code += OP_POSPLUS - OP_MINPLUS;
3706
0
        break;
3707
3708
0
        case OP_QUERY:
3709
0
        *code += OP_POSQUERY - OP_QUERY;
3710
0
        break;
3711
3712
0
        case OP_MINQUERY:
3713
0
        *code += OP_POSQUERY - OP_MINQUERY;
3714
0
        break;
3715
3716
0
        case OP_UPTO:
3717
0
        *code += OP_POSUPTO - OP_UPTO;
3718
0
        break;
3719
3720
0
        case OP_MINUPTO:
3721
0
        *code += OP_POSUPTO - OP_MINUPTO;
3722
0
        break;
3723
0
        }
3724
0
      }
3725
0
    c = *code;
3726
0
    }
3727
0
  else if (c == OP_CLASS || c == OP_NCLASS || c == OP_XCLASS)
3728
0
    {
3729
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
3730
    if (c == OP_XCLASS)
3731
      repeat_opcode = code + GET(code, 1);
3732
    else
3733
#endif
3734
0
      repeat_opcode = code + 1 + (32 / sizeof(pcre_uchar));
3735
3736
0
    c = *repeat_opcode;
3737
0
    if (c >= OP_CRSTAR && c <= OP_CRMINRANGE)
3738
0
      {
3739
      /* end must not be NULL. */
3740
0
      end = get_chr_property_list(code, utf, cd->fcc, list);
3741
3742
0
      list[1] = (c & 1) == 0;
3743
3744
0
      rec_limit = 1000;
3745
0
      if (compare_opcodes(end, utf, cd, list, end, &rec_limit))
3746
0
        {
3747
0
        switch (c)
3748
0
          {
3749
0
          case OP_CRSTAR:
3750
0
          case OP_CRMINSTAR:
3751
0
          *repeat_opcode = OP_CRPOSSTAR;
3752
0
          break;
3753
3754
0
          case OP_CRPLUS:
3755
0
          case OP_CRMINPLUS:
3756
0
          *repeat_opcode = OP_CRPOSPLUS;
3757
0
          break;
3758
3759
0
          case OP_CRQUERY:
3760
0
          case OP_CRMINQUERY:
3761
0
          *repeat_opcode = OP_CRPOSQUERY;
3762
0
          break;
3763
3764
0
          case OP_CRRANGE:
3765
0
          case OP_CRMINRANGE:
3766
0
          *repeat_opcode = OP_CRPOSRANGE;
3767
0
          break;
3768
0
          }
3769
0
        }
3770
0
      }
3771
0
    c = *code;
3772
0
    }
3773
3774
0
  switch(c)
3775
0
    {
3776
0
    case OP_END:
3777
0
    return;
3778
3779
0
    case OP_TYPESTAR:
3780
0
    case OP_TYPEMINSTAR:
3781
0
    case OP_TYPEPLUS:
3782
0
    case OP_TYPEMINPLUS:
3783
0
    case OP_TYPEQUERY:
3784
0
    case OP_TYPEMINQUERY:
3785
0
    case OP_TYPEPOSSTAR:
3786
0
    case OP_TYPEPOSPLUS:
3787
0
    case OP_TYPEPOSQUERY:
3788
0
    if (code[1] == OP_PROP || code[1] == OP_NOTPROP) code += 2;
3789
0
    break;
3790
3791
0
    case OP_TYPEUPTO:
3792
0
    case OP_TYPEMINUPTO:
3793
0
    case OP_TYPEEXACT:
3794
0
    case OP_TYPEPOSUPTO:
3795
0
    if (code[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_PROP || code[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_NOTPROP)
3796
0
      code += 2;
3797
0
    break;
3798
3799
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
3800
    case OP_XCLASS:
3801
    code += GET(code, 1);
3802
    break;
3803
#endif
3804
3805
0
    case OP_MARK:
3806
0
    case OP_PRUNE_ARG:
3807
0
    case OP_SKIP_ARG:
3808
0
    case OP_THEN_ARG:
3809
0
    code += code[1];
3810
0
    break;
3811
0
    }
3812
3813
  /* Add in the fixed length from the table */
3814
3815
0
  code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[c];
3816
3817
  /* In UTF-8 mode, opcodes that are followed by a character may be followed by
3818
  a multi-byte character. The length in the table is a minimum, so we have to
3819
  arrange to skip the extra bytes. */
3820
3821
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF && !defined COMPILE_PCRE32
3822
  if (utf) switch(c)
3823
    {
3824
    case OP_CHAR:
3825
    case OP_CHARI:
3826
    case OP_NOT:
3827
    case OP_NOTI:
3828
    case OP_STAR:
3829
    case OP_MINSTAR:
3830
    case OP_PLUS:
3831
    case OP_MINPLUS:
3832
    case OP_QUERY:
3833
    case OP_MINQUERY:
3834
    case OP_UPTO:
3835
    case OP_MINUPTO:
3836
    case OP_EXACT:
3837
    case OP_POSSTAR:
3838
    case OP_POSPLUS:
3839
    case OP_POSQUERY:
3840
    case OP_POSUPTO:
3841
    case OP_STARI:
3842
    case OP_MINSTARI:
3843
    case OP_PLUSI:
3844
    case OP_MINPLUSI:
3845
    case OP_QUERYI:
3846
    case OP_MINQUERYI:
3847
    case OP_UPTOI:
3848
    case OP_MINUPTOI:
3849
    case OP_EXACTI:
3850
    case OP_POSSTARI:
3851
    case OP_POSPLUSI:
3852
    case OP_POSQUERYI:
3853
    case OP_POSUPTOI:
3854
    case OP_NOTSTAR:
3855
    case OP_NOTMINSTAR:
3856
    case OP_NOTPLUS:
3857
    case OP_NOTMINPLUS:
3858
    case OP_NOTQUERY:
3859
    case OP_NOTMINQUERY:
3860
    case OP_NOTUPTO:
3861
    case OP_NOTMINUPTO:
3862
    case OP_NOTEXACT:
3863
    case OP_NOTPOSSTAR:
3864
    case OP_NOTPOSPLUS:
3865
    case OP_NOTPOSQUERY:
3866
    case OP_NOTPOSUPTO:
3867
    case OP_NOTSTARI:
3868
    case OP_NOTMINSTARI:
3869
    case OP_NOTPLUSI:
3870
    case OP_NOTMINPLUSI:
3871
    case OP_NOTQUERYI:
3872
    case OP_NOTMINQUERYI:
3873
    case OP_NOTUPTOI:
3874
    case OP_NOTMINUPTOI:
3875
    case OP_NOTEXACTI:
3876
    case OP_NOTPOSSTARI:
3877
    case OP_NOTPOSPLUSI:
3878
    case OP_NOTPOSQUERYI:
3879
    case OP_NOTPOSUPTOI:
3880
    if (HAS_EXTRALEN(code[-1])) code += GET_EXTRALEN(code[-1]);
3881
    break;
3882
    }
3883
#else
3884
0
  (void)(utf);  /* Keep compiler happy by referencing function argument */
3885
0
#endif
3886
0
  }
3887
0
}
3888
3889
3890
3891
/*************************************************
3892
*           Check for POSIX class syntax         *
3893
*************************************************/
3894
3895
/* This function is called when the sequence "[:" or "[." or "[=" is
3896
encountered in a character class. It checks whether this is followed by a
3897
sequence of characters terminated by a matching ":]" or ".]" or "=]". If we
3898
reach an unescaped ']' without the special preceding character, return FALSE.
3899
3900
Originally, this function only recognized a sequence of letters between the
3901
terminators, but it seems that Perl recognizes any sequence of characters,
3902
though of course unknown POSIX names are subsequently rejected. Perl gives an
3903
"Unknown POSIX class" error for [:f\oo:] for example, where previously PCRE
3904
didn't consider this to be a POSIX class. Likewise for [:1234:].
3905
3906
The problem in trying to be exactly like Perl is in the handling of escapes. We
3907
have to be sure that [abc[:x\]pqr] is *not* treated as containing a POSIX
3908
class, but [abc[:x\]pqr:]] is (so that an error can be generated). The code
3909
below handles the special cases \\ and \], but does not try to do any other
3910
escape processing. This makes it different from Perl for cases such as
3911
[:l\ower:] where Perl recognizes it as the POSIX class "lower" but PCRE does
3912
not recognize "l\ower". This is a lesser evil than not diagnosing bad classes
3913
when Perl does, I think.
3914
3915
A user pointed out that PCRE was rejecting [:a[:digit:]] whereas Perl was not.
3916
It seems that the appearance of a nested POSIX class supersedes an apparent
3917
external class. For example, [:a[:digit:]b:] matches "a", "b", ":", or
3918
a digit.
3919
3920
In Perl, unescaped square brackets may also appear as part of class names. For
3921
example, [:a[:abc]b:] gives unknown POSIX class "[:abc]b:]". However, for
3922
[:a[:abc]b][b:] it gives unknown POSIX class "[:abc]b][b:]", which does not
3923
seem right at all. PCRE does not allow closing square brackets in POSIX class
3924
names.
3925
3926
Arguments:
3927
  ptr      pointer to the initial [
3928
  endptr   where to return the end pointer
3929
3930
Returns:   TRUE or FALSE
3931
*/
3932
3933
static BOOL
3934
check_posix_syntax(const pcre_uchar *ptr, const pcre_uchar **endptr)
3935
0
{
3936
0
pcre_uchar terminator;          /* Don't combine these lines; the Solaris cc */
3937
0
terminator = *(++ptr);   /* compiler warns about "non-constant" initializer. */
3938
0
for (++ptr; *ptr != CHAR_NULL; ptr++)
3939
0
  {
3940
0
  if (*ptr == CHAR_BACKSLASH &&
3941
0
      (ptr[1] == CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET ||
3942
0
       ptr[1] == CHAR_BACKSLASH))
3943
0
    ptr++;
3944
0
  else if ((*ptr == CHAR_LEFT_SQUARE_BRACKET && ptr[1] == terminator) ||
3945
0
            *ptr == CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET) return FALSE;
3946
0
  else if (*ptr == terminator && ptr[1] == CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET)
3947
0
    {
3948
0
    *endptr = ptr;
3949
0
    return TRUE;
3950
0
    }
3951
0
  }
3952
0
return FALSE;
3953
0
}
3954
3955
3956
3957
3958
/*************************************************
3959
*          Check POSIX class name                *
3960
*************************************************/
3961
3962
/* This function is called to check the name given in a POSIX-style class entry
3963
such as [:alnum:].
3964
3965
Arguments:
3966
  ptr        points to the first letter
3967
  len        the length of the name
3968
3969
Returns:     a value representing the name, or -1 if unknown
3970
*/
3971
3972
static int
3973
check_posix_name(const pcre_uchar *ptr, int len)
3974
0
{
3975
0
const char *pn = posix_names;
3976
0
register int yield = 0;
3977
0
while (posix_name_lengths[yield] != 0)
3978
0
  {
3979
0
  if (len == posix_name_lengths[yield] &&
3980
0
    STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr, pn, (unsigned int)len) == 0) return yield;
3981
0
  pn += posix_name_lengths[yield] + 1;
3982
0
  yield++;
3983
0
  }
3984
0
return -1;
3985
0
}
3986
3987
3988
/*************************************************
3989
*    Adjust OP_RECURSE items in repeated group   *
3990
*************************************************/
3991
3992
/* OP_RECURSE items contain an offset from the start of the regex to the group
3993
that is referenced. This means that groups can be replicated for fixed
3994
repetition simply by copying (because the recursion is allowed to refer to
3995
earlier groups that are outside the current group). However, when a group is
3996
optional (i.e. the minimum quantifier is zero), OP_BRAZERO or OP_SKIPZERO is
3997
inserted before it, after it has been compiled. This means that any OP_RECURSE
3998
items within it that refer to the group itself or any contained groups have to
3999
have their offsets adjusted. That one of the jobs of this function. Before it
4000
is called, the partially compiled regex must be temporarily terminated with
4001
OP_END.
4002
4003
This function has been extended to cope with forward references for recursions
4004
and subroutine calls. It must check the list of such references for the
4005
group we are dealing with. If it finds that one of the recursions in the
4006
current group is on this list, it does not adjust the value in the reference
4007
(which is a group number). After the group has been scanned, all the offsets in
4008
the forward reference list for the group are adjusted.
4009
4010
Arguments:
4011
  group      points to the start of the group
4012
  adjust     the amount by which the group is to be moved
4013
  utf        TRUE in UTF-8 / UTF-16 / UTF-32 mode
4014
  cd         contains pointers to tables etc.
4015
  save_hwm_offset   the hwm forward reference offset at the start of the group
4016
4017
Returns:     nothing
4018
*/
4019
4020
static void
4021
adjust_recurse(pcre_uchar *group, int adjust, BOOL utf, compile_data *cd,
4022
  size_t save_hwm_offset)
4023
0
{
4024
0
int offset;
4025
0
pcre_uchar *hc;
4026
0
pcre_uchar *ptr = group;
4027
4028
0
while ((ptr = (pcre_uchar *)find_recurse(ptr, utf)) != NULL)
4029
0
  {
4030
0
  for (hc = (pcre_uchar *)cd->start_workspace + save_hwm_offset; hc < cd->hwm;
4031
0
       hc += LINK_SIZE)
4032
0
    {
4033
0
    offset = (int)GET(hc, 0);
4034
0
    if (cd->start_code + offset == ptr + 1) break;
4035
0
    }
4036
4037
  /* If we have not found this recursion on the forward reference list, adjust
4038
  the recursion's offset if it's after the start of this group. */
4039
4040
0
  if (hc >= cd->hwm)
4041
0
    {
4042
0
    offset = (int)GET(ptr, 1);
4043
0
    if (cd->start_code + offset >= group) PUT(ptr, 1, offset + adjust);
4044
0
    }
4045
4046
0
  ptr += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
4047
0
  }
4048
4049
/* Now adjust all forward reference offsets for the group. */
4050
4051
0
for (hc = (pcre_uchar *)cd->start_workspace + save_hwm_offset; hc < cd->hwm;
4052
0
     hc += LINK_SIZE)
4053
0
  {
4054
0
  offset = (int)GET(hc, 0);
4055
0
  PUT(hc, 0, offset + adjust);
4056
0
  }
4057
0
}
4058
4059
4060
4061
/*************************************************
4062
*        Insert an automatic callout point       *
4063
*************************************************/
4064
4065
/* This function is called when the PCRE_AUTO_CALLOUT option is set, to insert
4066
callout points before each pattern item.
4067
4068
Arguments:
4069
  code           current code pointer
4070
  ptr            current pattern pointer
4071
  cd             pointers to tables etc
4072
4073
Returns:         new code pointer
4074
*/
4075
4076
static pcre_uchar *
4077
auto_callout(pcre_uchar *code, const pcre_uchar *ptr, compile_data *cd)
4078
0
{
4079
0
*code++ = OP_CALLOUT;
4080
0
*code++ = 255;
4081
0
PUT(code, 0, (int)(ptr - cd->start_pattern));  /* Pattern offset */
4082
0
PUT(code, LINK_SIZE, 0);                       /* Default length */
4083
0
return code + 2 * LINK_SIZE;
4084
0
}
4085
4086
4087
4088
/*************************************************
4089
*         Complete a callout item                *
4090
*************************************************/
4091
4092
/* A callout item contains the length of the next item in the pattern, which
4093
we can't fill in till after we have reached the relevant point. This is used
4094
for both automatic and manual callouts.
4095
4096
Arguments:
4097
  previous_callout   points to previous callout item
4098
  ptr                current pattern pointer
4099
  cd                 pointers to tables etc
4100
4101
Returns:             nothing
4102
*/
4103
4104
static void
4105
complete_callout(pcre_uchar *previous_callout, const pcre_uchar *ptr, compile_data *cd)
4106
0
{
4107
0
int length = (int)(ptr - cd->start_pattern - GET(previous_callout, 2));
4108
0
PUT(previous_callout, 2 + LINK_SIZE, length);
4109
0
}
4110
4111
4112
4113
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
4114
/*************************************************
4115
*           Get othercase range                  *
4116
*************************************************/
4117
4118
/* This function is passed the start and end of a class range, in UTF-8 mode
4119
with UCP support. It searches up the characters, looking for ranges of
4120
characters in the "other" case. Each call returns the next one, updating the
4121
start address. A character with multiple other cases is returned on its own
4122
with a special return value.
4123
4124
Arguments:
4125
  cptr        points to starting character value; updated
4126
  d           end value
4127
  ocptr       where to put start of othercase range
4128
  odptr       where to put end of othercase range
4129
4130
Yield:        -1 when no more
4131
               0 when a range is returned
4132
              >0 the CASESET offset for char with multiple other cases
4133
                in this case, ocptr contains the original
4134
*/
4135
4136
static int
4137
get_othercase_range(pcre_uint32 *cptr, pcre_uint32 d, pcre_uint32 *ocptr,
4138
  pcre_uint32 *odptr)
4139
{
4140
pcre_uint32 c, othercase, next;
4141
unsigned int co;
4142
4143
/* Find the first character that has an other case. If it has multiple other
4144
cases, return its case offset value. */
4145
4146
for (c = *cptr; c <= d; c++)
4147
  {
4148
  if ((co = UCD_CASESET(c)) != 0)
4149
    {
4150
    *ocptr = c++;   /* Character that has the set */
4151
    *cptr = c;      /* Rest of input range */
4152
    return (int)co;
4153
    }
4154
  if ((othercase = UCD_OTHERCASE(c)) != c) break;
4155
  }
4156
4157
if (c > d) return -1;  /* Reached end of range */
4158
4159
/* Found a character that has a single other case. Search for the end of the
4160
range, which is either the end of the input range, or a character that has zero
4161
or more than one other cases. */
4162
4163
*ocptr = othercase;
4164
next = othercase + 1;
4165
4166
for (++c; c <= d; c++)
4167
  {
4168
  if ((co = UCD_CASESET(c)) != 0 || UCD_OTHERCASE(c) != next) break;
4169
  next++;
4170
  }
4171
4172
*odptr = next - 1;     /* End of othercase range */
4173
*cptr = c;             /* Rest of input range */
4174
return 0;
4175
}
4176
#endif  /* SUPPORT_UCP */
4177
4178
4179
4180
/*************************************************
4181
*        Add a character or range to a class     *
4182
*************************************************/
4183
4184
/* This function packages up the logic of adding a character or range of
4185
characters to a class. The character values in the arguments will be within the
4186
valid values for the current mode (8-bit, 16-bit, UTF, etc). This function is
4187
mutually recursive with the function immediately below.
4188
4189
Arguments:
4190
  classbits     the bit map for characters < 256
4191
  uchardptr     points to the pointer for extra data
4192
  options       the options word
4193
  cd            contains pointers to tables etc.
4194
  start         start of range character
4195
  end           end of range character
4196
4197
Returns:        the number of < 256 characters added
4198
                the pointer to extra data is updated
4199
*/
4200
4201
static int
4202
add_to_class(pcre_uint8 *classbits, pcre_uchar **uchardptr, int options,
4203
  compile_data *cd, pcre_uint32 start, pcre_uint32 end)
4204
0
{
4205
0
pcre_uint32 c;
4206
0
pcre_uint32 classbits_end = (end <= 0xff ? end : 0xff);
4207
0
int n8 = 0;
4208
4209
0
((void)uchardptr);
4210
0
((void)propposstab);
4211
0
((void)catposstab);
4212
0
((void)posspropstab);
4213
4214
/* If caseless matching is required, scan the range and process alternate
4215
cases. In Unicode, there are 8-bit characters that have alternate cases that
4216
are greater than 255 and vice-versa. Sometimes we can just extend the original
4217
range. */
4218
4219
0
if ((options & PCRE_CASELESS) != 0)
4220
0
  {
4221
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
4222
  if ((options & PCRE_UTF8) != 0)
4223
    {
4224
    int rc;
4225
    pcre_uint32 oc, od;
4226
4227
    options &= ~PCRE_CASELESS;   /* Remove for recursive calls */
4228
    c = start;
4229
4230
    while ((rc = get_othercase_range(&c, end, &oc, &od)) >= 0)
4231
      {
4232
      /* Handle a single character that has more than one other case. */
4233
4234
      if (rc > 0) n8 += add_list_to_class(classbits, uchardptr, options, cd,
4235
        PRIV(ucd_caseless_sets) + rc, oc);
4236
4237
      /* Do nothing if the other case range is within the original range. */
4238
4239
      else if (oc >= start && od <= end) continue;
4240
4241
      /* Extend the original range if there is overlap, noting that if oc < c, we
4242
      can't have od > end because a subrange is always shorter than the basic
4243
      range. Otherwise, use a recursive call to add the additional range. */
4244
4245
      else if (oc < start && od >= start - 1) start = oc; /* Extend downwards */
4246
      else if (od > end && oc <= end + 1)
4247
        {
4248
        end = od;       /* Extend upwards */
4249
        if (end > classbits_end) classbits_end = (end <= 0xff ? end : 0xff);
4250
        }
4251
      else n8 += add_to_class(classbits, uchardptr, options, cd, oc, od);
4252
      }
4253
    }
4254
  else
4255
#endif  /* SUPPORT_UCP */
4256
4257
  /* Not UTF-mode, or no UCP */
4258
4259
0
  for (c = start; c <= classbits_end; c++)
4260
0
    {
4261
0
    SETBIT(classbits, cd->fcc[c]);
4262
0
    n8++;
4263
0
    }
4264
0
  }
4265
4266
/* Now handle the original range. Adjust the final value according to the bit
4267
length - this means that the same lists of (e.g.) horizontal spaces can be used
4268
in all cases. */
4269
4270
0
#if defined COMPILE_PCRE8
4271
#ifdef SUPPORT_UTF
4272
  if ((options & PCRE_UTF8) == 0)
4273
#endif
4274
0
  if (end > 0xff) end = 0xff;
4275
4276
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16
4277
#ifdef SUPPORT_UTF
4278
  if ((options & PCRE_UTF16) == 0)
4279
#endif
4280
  if (end > 0xffff) end = 0xffff;
4281
4282
#endif /* COMPILE_PCRE[8|16] */
4283
4284
/* Use the bitmap for characters < 256. Otherwise use extra data.*/
4285
4286
0
for (c = start; c <= classbits_end; c++)
4287
0
  {
4288
  /* Regardless of start, c will always be <= 255. */
4289
0
  SETBIT(classbits, c);
4290
0
  n8++;
4291
0
  }
4292
4293
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
4294
if (start <= 0xff) start = 0xff + 1;
4295
4296
if (end >= start)
4297
  {
4298
  pcre_uchar *uchardata = *uchardptr;
4299
#ifdef SUPPORT_UTF
4300
  if ((options & PCRE_UTF8) != 0)  /* All UTFs use the same flag bit */
4301
    {
4302
    if (start < end)
4303
      {
4304
      *uchardata++ = XCL_RANGE;
4305
      uchardata += PRIV(ord2utf)(start, uchardata);
4306
      uchardata += PRIV(ord2utf)(end, uchardata);
4307
      }
4308
    else if (start == end)
4309
      {
4310
      *uchardata++ = XCL_SINGLE;
4311
      uchardata += PRIV(ord2utf)(start, uchardata);
4312
      }
4313
    }
4314
  else
4315
#endif  /* SUPPORT_UTF */
4316
4317
  /* Without UTF support, character values are constrained by the bit length,
4318
  and can only be > 256 for 16-bit and 32-bit libraries. */
4319
4320
#ifdef COMPILE_PCRE8
4321
    {}
4322
#else
4323
  if (start < end)
4324
    {
4325
    *uchardata++ = XCL_RANGE;
4326
    *uchardata++ = start;
4327
    *uchardata++ = end;
4328
    }
4329
  else if (start == end)
4330
    {
4331
    *uchardata++ = XCL_SINGLE;
4332
    *uchardata++ = start;
4333
    }
4334
#endif
4335
4336
  *uchardptr = uchardata;   /* Updata extra data pointer */
4337
  }
4338
#endif /* SUPPORT_UTF || !COMPILE_PCRE8 */
4339
4340
0
return n8;    /* Number of 8-bit characters */
4341
0
}
4342
4343
4344
4345
4346
/*************************************************
4347
*        Add a list of characters to a class     *
4348
*************************************************/
4349
4350
/* This function is used for adding a list of case-equivalent characters to a
4351
class, and also for adding a list of horizontal or vertical whitespace. If the
4352
list is in order (which it should be), ranges of characters are detected and
4353
handled appropriately. This function is mutually recursive with the function
4354
above.
4355
4356
Arguments:
4357
  classbits     the bit map for characters < 256
4358
  uchardptr     points to the pointer for extra data
4359
  options       the options word
4360
  cd            contains pointers to tables etc.
4361
  p             points to row of 32-bit values, terminated by NOTACHAR
4362
  except        character to omit; this is used when adding lists of
4363
                  case-equivalent characters to avoid including the one we
4364
                  already know about
4365
4366
Returns:        the number of < 256 characters added
4367
                the pointer to extra data is updated
4368
*/
4369
4370
static int
4371
add_list_to_class(pcre_uint8 *classbits, pcre_uchar **uchardptr, int options,
4372
  compile_data *cd, const pcre_uint32 *p, unsigned int except)
4373
0
{
4374
0
int n8 = 0;
4375
0
while (p[0] < NOTACHAR)
4376
0
  {
4377
0
  int n = 0;
4378
0
  if (p[0] != except)
4379
0
    {
4380
0
    while(p[n+1] == p[0] + n + 1) n++;
4381
0
    n8 += add_to_class(classbits, uchardptr, options, cd, p[0], p[n]);
4382
0
    }
4383
0
  p += n + 1;
4384
0
  }
4385
0
return n8;
4386
0
}
4387
4388
4389
4390
/*************************************************
4391
*    Add characters not in a list to a class     *
4392
*************************************************/
4393
4394
/* This function is used for adding the complement of a list of horizontal or
4395
vertical whitespace to a class. The list must be in order.
4396
4397
Arguments:
4398
  classbits     the bit map for characters < 256
4399
  uchardptr     points to the pointer for extra data
4400
  options       the options word
4401
  cd            contains pointers to tables etc.
4402
  p             points to row of 32-bit values, terminated by NOTACHAR
4403
4404
Returns:        the number of < 256 characters added
4405
                the pointer to extra data is updated
4406
*/
4407
4408
static int
4409
add_not_list_to_class(pcre_uint8 *classbits, pcre_uchar **uchardptr,
4410
  int options, compile_data *cd, const pcre_uint32 *p)
4411
0
{
4412
0
BOOL utf = (options & PCRE_UTF8) != 0;
4413
0
int n8 = 0;
4414
0
if (p[0] > 0)
4415
0
  n8 += add_to_class(classbits, uchardptr, options, cd, 0, p[0] - 1);
4416
0
while (p[0] < NOTACHAR)
4417
0
  {
4418
0
  while (p[1] == p[0] + 1) p++;
4419
0
  n8 += add_to_class(classbits, uchardptr, options, cd, p[0] + 1,
4420
0
    (p[1] == NOTACHAR) ? (utf ? 0x10ffffu : 0xffffffffu) : p[1] - 1);
4421
0
  p++;
4422
0
  }
4423
0
return n8;
4424
0
}
4425
4426
4427
4428
/*************************************************
4429
*           Compile one branch                   *
4430
*************************************************/
4431
4432
/* Scan the pattern, compiling it into the a vector. If the options are
4433
changed during the branch, the pointer is used to change the external options
4434
bits. This function is used during the pre-compile phase when we are trying
4435
to find out the amount of memory needed, as well as during the real compile
4436
phase. The value of lengthptr distinguishes the two phases.
4437
4438
Arguments:
4439
  optionsptr        pointer to the option bits
4440
  codeptr           points to the pointer to the current code point
4441
  ptrptr            points to the current pattern pointer
4442
  errorcodeptr      points to error code variable
4443
  firstcharptr      place to put the first required character
4444
  firstcharflagsptr place to put the first character flags, or a negative number
4445
  reqcharptr        place to put the last required character
4446
  reqcharflagsptr   place to put the last required character flags, or a negative number
4447
  bcptr             points to current branch chain
4448
  cond_depth        conditional nesting depth
4449
  cd                contains pointers to tables etc.
4450
  lengthptr         NULL during the real compile phase
4451
                    points to length accumulator during pre-compile phase
4452
4453
Returns:            TRUE on success
4454
                    FALSE, with *errorcodeptr set non-zero on error
4455
*/
4456
4457
static BOOL
4458
compile_branch(int *optionsptr, pcre_uchar **codeptr,
4459
  const pcre_uchar **ptrptr, int *errorcodeptr,
4460
  pcre_uint32 *firstcharptr, pcre_int32 *firstcharflagsptr,
4461
  pcre_uint32 *reqcharptr, pcre_int32 *reqcharflagsptr,
4462
  branch_chain *bcptr, int cond_depth,
4463
  compile_data *cd, int *lengthptr)
4464
0
{
4465
0
int repeat_type, op_type;
4466
0
int repeat_min = 0, repeat_max = 0;      /* To please picky compilers */
4467
0
int bravalue = 0;
4468
0
int greedy_default, greedy_non_default;
4469
0
pcre_uint32 firstchar, reqchar;
4470
0
pcre_int32 firstcharflags, reqcharflags;
4471
0
pcre_uint32 zeroreqchar, zerofirstchar;
4472
0
pcre_int32 zeroreqcharflags, zerofirstcharflags;
4473
0
pcre_int32 req_caseopt, reqvary, tempreqvary;
4474
0
int options = *optionsptr;               /* May change dynamically */
4475
0
int after_manual_callout = 0;
4476
0
int length_prevgroup = 0;
4477
0
register pcre_uint32 c;
4478
0
int escape;
4479
0
register pcre_uchar *code = *codeptr;
4480
0
pcre_uchar *last_code = code;
4481
0
pcre_uchar *orig_code = code;
4482
0
pcre_uchar *tempcode;
4483
0
BOOL inescq = FALSE;
4484
0
BOOL groupsetfirstchar = FALSE;
4485
0
const pcre_uchar *ptr = *ptrptr;
4486
0
const pcre_uchar *tempptr;
4487
0
const pcre_uchar *nestptr = NULL;
4488
0
pcre_uchar *previous = NULL;
4489
0
pcre_uchar *previous_callout = NULL;
4490
0
size_t item_hwm_offset = 0;
4491
0
pcre_uint8 classbits[32];
4492
4493
/* We can fish out the UTF-8 setting once and for all into a BOOL, but we
4494
must not do this for other options (e.g. PCRE_EXTENDED) because they may change
4495
dynamically as we process the pattern. */
4496
4497
#ifdef SUPPORT_UTF
4498
/* PCRE_UTF[16|32] have the same value as PCRE_UTF8. */
4499
BOOL utf = (options & PCRE_UTF8) != 0;
4500
#ifndef COMPILE_PCRE32
4501
pcre_uchar utf_chars[6];
4502
#endif
4503
#else
4504
0
BOOL utf = FALSE;
4505
0
#endif
4506
4507
/* Helper variables for OP_XCLASS opcode (for characters > 255). We define
4508
class_uchardata always so that it can be passed to add_to_class() always,
4509
though it will not be used in non-UTF 8-bit cases. This avoids having to supply
4510
alternative calls for the different cases. */
4511
4512
0
pcre_uchar *class_uchardata;
4513
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
4514
BOOL xclass;
4515
pcre_uchar *class_uchardata_base;
4516
#endif
4517
4518
#ifdef PCRE_DEBUG
4519
if (lengthptr != NULL) DPRINTF((">> start branch\n"));
4520
#endif
4521
4522
/* Set up the default and non-default settings for greediness */
4523
4524
0
greedy_default = ((options & PCRE_UNGREEDY) != 0);
4525
0
greedy_non_default = greedy_default ^ 1;
4526
4527
/* Initialize no first byte, no required byte. REQ_UNSET means "no char
4528
matching encountered yet". It gets changed to REQ_NONE if we hit something that
4529
matches a non-fixed char first char; reqchar just remains unset if we never
4530
find one.
4531
4532
When we hit a repeat whose minimum is zero, we may have to adjust these values
4533
to take the zero repeat into account. This is implemented by setting them to
4534
zerofirstbyte and zeroreqchar when such a repeat is encountered. The individual
4535
item types that can be repeated set these backoff variables appropriately. */
4536
4537
0
firstchar = reqchar = zerofirstchar = zeroreqchar = 0;
4538
0
firstcharflags = reqcharflags = zerofirstcharflags = zeroreqcharflags = REQ_UNSET;
4539
4540
/* The variable req_caseopt contains either the REQ_CASELESS value
4541
or zero, according to the current setting of the caseless flag. The
4542
REQ_CASELESS leaves the lower 28 bit empty. It is added into the
4543
firstchar or reqchar variables to record the case status of the
4544
value. This is used only for ASCII characters. */
4545
4546
0
req_caseopt = ((options & PCRE_CASELESS) != 0)? REQ_CASELESS:0;
4547
4548
/* Switch on next character until the end of the branch */
4549
4550
0
for (;; ptr++)
4551
0
  {
4552
0
  BOOL negate_class;
4553
0
  BOOL should_flip_negation;
4554
0
  BOOL possessive_quantifier;
4555
0
  BOOL is_quantifier;
4556
0
  BOOL is_recurse;
4557
0
  BOOL reset_bracount;
4558
0
  int class_has_8bitchar;
4559
0
  int class_one_char;
4560
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
4561
  BOOL xclass_has_prop;
4562
#endif
4563
0
  int newoptions;
4564
0
  int recno;
4565
0
  int refsign;
4566
0
  int skipbytes;
4567
0
  pcre_uint32 subreqchar, subfirstchar;
4568
0
  pcre_int32 subreqcharflags, subfirstcharflags;
4569
0
  int terminator;
4570
0
  unsigned int mclength;
4571
0
  unsigned int tempbracount;
4572
0
  pcre_uint32 ec;
4573
0
  pcre_uchar mcbuffer[8];
4574
4575
  /* Come here to restart the loop without advancing the pointer. */
4576
4577
0
  REDO_LOOP:
4578
4579
  /* Get next character in the pattern */
4580
4581
0
  c = *ptr;
4582
4583
  /* If we are at the end of a nested substitution, revert to the outer level
4584
  string. Nesting only happens one level deep. */
4585
4586
0
  if (c == CHAR_NULL && nestptr != NULL)
4587
0
    {
4588
0
    ptr = nestptr;
4589
0
    nestptr = NULL;
4590
0
    c = *ptr;
4591
0
    }
4592
4593
  /* If we are in the pre-compile phase, accumulate the length used for the
4594
  previous cycle of this loop. */
4595
4596
0
  if (lengthptr != NULL)
4597
0
    {
4598
#ifdef PCRE_DEBUG
4599
    if (code > cd->hwm) cd->hwm = code;                 /* High water info */
4600
#endif
4601
0
    if (code > cd->start_workspace + cd->workspace_size -
4602
0
        WORK_SIZE_SAFETY_MARGIN)                       /* Check for overrun */
4603
0
      {
4604
0
      *errorcodeptr = (code >= cd->start_workspace + cd->workspace_size)?
4605
0
        ERR52 : ERR87;
4606
0
      goto FAILED;
4607
0
      }
4608
4609
    /* There is at least one situation where code goes backwards: this is the
4610
    case of a zero quantifier after a class (e.g. [ab]{0}). At compile time,
4611
    the class is simply eliminated. However, it is created first, so we have to
4612
    allow memory for it. Therefore, don't ever reduce the length at this point.
4613
    */
4614
4615
0
    if (code < last_code) code = last_code;
4616
4617
    /* Paranoid check for integer overflow */
4618
4619
0
    if (OFLOW_MAX - *lengthptr < code - last_code)
4620
0
      {
4621
0
      *errorcodeptr = ERR20;
4622
0
      goto FAILED;
4623
0
      }
4624
4625
0
    *lengthptr += (int)(code - last_code);
4626
0
    DPRINTF(("length=%d added %d c=%c (0x%x)\n", *lengthptr,
4627
0
      (int)(code - last_code), c, c));
4628
4629
    /* If "previous" is set and it is not at the start of the work space, move
4630
    it back to there, in order to avoid filling up the work space. Otherwise,
4631
    if "previous" is NULL, reset the current code pointer to the start. */
4632
4633
0
    if (previous != NULL)
4634
0
      {
4635
0
      if (previous > orig_code)
4636
0
        {
4637
0
        memmove(orig_code, previous, IN_UCHARS(code - previous));
4638
0
        code -= previous - orig_code;
4639
0
        previous = orig_code;
4640
0
        }
4641
0
      }
4642
0
    else code = orig_code;
4643
4644
    /* Remember where this code item starts so we can pick up the length
4645
    next time round. */
4646
4647
0
    last_code = code;
4648
0
    }
4649
4650
  /* In the real compile phase, just check the workspace used by the forward
4651
  reference list. */
4652
4653
0
  else if (cd->hwm > cd->start_workspace + cd->workspace_size)
4654
0
    {
4655
0
    *errorcodeptr = ERR52;
4656
0
    goto FAILED;
4657
0
    }
4658
4659
  /* If in \Q...\E, check for the end; if not, we have a literal. Otherwise an
4660
  isolated \E is ignored. */
4661
4662
0
  if (c != CHAR_NULL)
4663
0
    {
4664
0
    if (c == CHAR_BACKSLASH && ptr[1] == CHAR_E)
4665
0
      {
4666
0
      inescq = FALSE;
4667
0
      ptr++;
4668
0
      continue;
4669
0
      }
4670
0
    else if (inescq)
4671
0
      {
4672
0
      if (previous_callout != NULL)
4673
0
        {
4674
0
        if (lengthptr == NULL)  /* Don't attempt in pre-compile phase */
4675
0
          complete_callout(previous_callout, ptr, cd);
4676
0
        previous_callout = NULL;
4677
0
        }
4678
0
      if ((options & PCRE_AUTO_CALLOUT) != 0)
4679
0
        {
4680
0
        previous_callout = code;
4681
0
        code = auto_callout(code, ptr, cd);
4682
0
        }
4683
0
      goto NORMAL_CHAR;
4684
0
      }
4685
4686
    /* Check for the start of a \Q...\E sequence. We must do this here rather
4687
    than later in case it is immediately followed by \E, which turns it into a
4688
    "do nothing" sequence. */
4689
4690
0
    if (c == CHAR_BACKSLASH && ptr[1] == CHAR_Q)
4691
0
      {
4692
0
      inescq = TRUE;
4693
0
      ptr++;
4694
0
      continue;
4695
0
      }
4696
0
    }
4697
4698
  /* In extended mode, skip white space and comments. */
4699
4700
0
  if ((options & PCRE_EXTENDED) != 0)
4701
0
    {
4702
0
    const pcre_uchar *wscptr = ptr;
4703
0
    while (MAX_255(c) && (cd->ctypes[c] & ctype_space) != 0) c = *(++ptr);
4704
0
    if (c == CHAR_NUMBER_SIGN)
4705
0
      {
4706
0
      ptr++;
4707
0
      while (*ptr != CHAR_NULL)
4708
0
        {
4709
0
        if (IS_NEWLINE(ptr))         /* For non-fixed-length newline cases, */
4710
0
          {                          /* IS_NEWLINE sets cd->nllen. */
4711
0
          ptr += cd->nllen;
4712
0
          break;
4713
0
          }
4714
0
        ptr++;
4715
#ifdef SUPPORT_UTF
4716
        if (utf) FORWARDCHAR(ptr);
4717
#endif
4718
0
        }
4719
0
      }
4720
4721
    /* If we skipped any characters, restart the loop. Otherwise, we didn't see
4722
    a comment. */
4723
4724
0
    if (ptr > wscptr) goto REDO_LOOP;
4725
0
    }
4726
4727
  /* Skip over (?# comments. We need to do this here because we want to know if
4728
  the next thing is a quantifier, and these comments may come between an item
4729
  and its quantifier. */
4730
4731
0
  if (c == CHAR_LEFT_PARENTHESIS && ptr[1] == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK &&
4732
0
      ptr[2] == CHAR_NUMBER_SIGN)
4733
0
    {
4734
0
    ptr += 3;
4735
0
    while (*ptr != CHAR_NULL && *ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS) ptr++;
4736
0
    if (*ptr == CHAR_NULL)
4737
0
      {
4738
0
      *errorcodeptr = ERR18;
4739
0
      goto FAILED;
4740
0
      }
4741
0
    continue;
4742
0
    }
4743
4744
  /* See if the next thing is a quantifier. */
4745
4746
0
  is_quantifier =
4747
0
    c == CHAR_ASTERISK || c == CHAR_PLUS || c == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK ||
4748
0
    (c == CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET && is_counted_repeat(ptr+1));
4749
4750
  /* Fill in length of a previous callout, except when the next thing is a
4751
  quantifier or when processing a property substitution string in UCP mode. */
4752
4753
0
  if (!is_quantifier && previous_callout != NULL && nestptr == NULL &&
4754
0
       after_manual_callout-- <= 0)
4755
0
    {
4756
0
    if (lengthptr == NULL)      /* Don't attempt in pre-compile phase */
4757
0
      complete_callout(previous_callout, ptr, cd);
4758
0
    previous_callout = NULL;
4759
0
    }
4760
4761
  /* Create auto callout, except for quantifiers, or while processing property
4762
  strings that are substituted for \w etc in UCP mode. */
4763
4764
0
  if ((options & PCRE_AUTO_CALLOUT) != 0 && !is_quantifier && nestptr == NULL)
4765
0
    {
4766
0
    previous_callout = code;
4767
0
    code = auto_callout(code, ptr, cd);
4768
0
    }
4769
4770
  /* Process the next pattern item. */
4771
4772
0
  switch(c)
4773
0
    {
4774
    /* ===================================================================*/
4775
0
    case CHAR_NULL:                /* The branch terminates at string end */
4776
0
    case CHAR_VERTICAL_LINE:       /* or | or ) */
4777
0
    case CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS:
4778
0
    *firstcharptr = firstchar;
4779
0
    *firstcharflagsptr = firstcharflags;
4780
0
    *reqcharptr = reqchar;
4781
0
    *reqcharflagsptr = reqcharflags;
4782
0
    *codeptr = code;
4783
0
    *ptrptr = ptr;
4784
0
    if (lengthptr != NULL)
4785
0
      {
4786
0
      if (OFLOW_MAX - *lengthptr < code - last_code)
4787
0
        {
4788
0
        *errorcodeptr = ERR20;
4789
0
        goto FAILED;
4790
0
        }
4791
0
      *lengthptr += (int)(code - last_code);   /* To include callout length */
4792
0
      DPRINTF((">> end branch\n"));
4793
0
      }
4794
0
    return TRUE;
4795
4796
4797
    /* ===================================================================*/
4798
    /* Handle single-character metacharacters. In multiline mode, ^ disables
4799
    the setting of any following char as a first character. */
4800
4801
0
    case CHAR_CIRCUMFLEX_ACCENT:
4802
0
    previous = NULL;
4803
0
    if ((options & PCRE_MULTILINE) != 0)
4804
0
      {
4805
0
      if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET)
4806
0
        zerofirstcharflags = firstcharflags = REQ_NONE;
4807
0
      *code++ = OP_CIRCM;
4808
0
      }
4809
0
    else *code++ = OP_CIRC;
4810
0
    break;
4811
4812
0
    case CHAR_DOLLAR_SIGN:
4813
0
    previous = NULL;
4814
0
    *code++ = ((options & PCRE_MULTILINE) != 0)? OP_DOLLM : OP_DOLL;
4815
0
    break;
4816
4817
    /* There can never be a first char if '.' is first, whatever happens about
4818
    repeats. The value of reqchar doesn't change either. */
4819
4820
0
    case CHAR_DOT:
4821
0
    if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcharflags = REQ_NONE;
4822
0
    zerofirstchar = firstchar;
4823
0
    zerofirstcharflags = firstcharflags;
4824
0
    zeroreqchar = reqchar;
4825
0
    zeroreqcharflags = reqcharflags;
4826
0
    previous = code;
4827
0
    item_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace;
4828
0
    *code++ = ((options & PCRE_DOTALL) != 0)? OP_ALLANY: OP_ANY;
4829
0
    break;
4830
4831
4832
    /* ===================================================================*/
4833
    /* Character classes. If the included characters are all < 256, we build a
4834
    32-byte bitmap of the permitted characters, except in the special case
4835
    where there is only one such character. For negated classes, we build the
4836
    map as usual, then invert it at the end. However, we use a different opcode
4837
    so that data characters > 255 can be handled correctly.
4838
4839
    If the class contains characters outside the 0-255 range, a different
4840
    opcode is compiled. It may optionally have a bit map for characters < 256,
4841
    but those above are are explicitly listed afterwards. A flag byte tells
4842
    whether the bitmap is present, and whether this is a negated class or not.
4843
4844
    In JavaScript compatibility mode, an isolated ']' causes an error. In
4845
    default (Perl) mode, it is treated as a data character. */
4846
4847
0
    case CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET:
4848
0
    if ((cd->external_options & PCRE_JAVASCRIPT_COMPAT) != 0)
4849
0
      {
4850
0
      *errorcodeptr = ERR64;
4851
0
      goto FAILED;
4852
0
      }
4853
0
    goto NORMAL_CHAR;
4854
4855
    /* In another (POSIX) regex library, the ugly syntax [[:<:]] and [[:>:]] is
4856
    used for "start of word" and "end of word". As these are otherwise illegal
4857
    sequences, we don't break anything by recognizing them. They are replaced
4858
    by \b(?=\w) and \b(?<=\w) respectively. Sequences like [a[:<:]] are
4859
    erroneous and are handled by the normal code below. */
4860
4861
0
    case CHAR_LEFT_SQUARE_BRACKET:
4862
0
    if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+1, STRING_WEIRD_STARTWORD, 6) == 0)
4863
0
      {
4864
0
      nestptr = ptr + 7;
4865
0
      ptr = sub_start_of_word;
4866
0
      goto REDO_LOOP;
4867
0
      }
4868
4869
0
    if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+1, STRING_WEIRD_ENDWORD, 6) == 0)
4870
0
      {
4871
0
      nestptr = ptr + 7;
4872
0
      ptr = sub_end_of_word;
4873
0
      goto REDO_LOOP;
4874
0
      }
4875
4876
    /* Handle a real character class. */
4877
4878
0
    previous = code;
4879
0
    item_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace;
4880
4881
    /* PCRE supports POSIX class stuff inside a class. Perl gives an error if
4882
    they are encountered at the top level, so we'll do that too. */
4883
4884
0
    if ((ptr[1] == CHAR_COLON || ptr[1] == CHAR_DOT ||
4885
0
         ptr[1] == CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN) &&
4886
0
        check_posix_syntax(ptr, &tempptr))
4887
0
      {
4888
0
      *errorcodeptr = (ptr[1] == CHAR_COLON)? ERR13 : ERR31;
4889
0
      goto FAILED;
4890
0
      }
4891
4892
    /* If the first character is '^', set the negation flag and skip it. Also,
4893
    if the first few characters (either before or after ^) are \Q\E or \E we
4894
    skip them too. This makes for compatibility with Perl. */
4895
4896
0
    negate_class = FALSE;
4897
0
    for (;;)
4898
0
      {
4899
0
      c = *(++ptr);
4900
0
      if (c == CHAR_BACKSLASH)
4901
0
        {
4902
0
        if (ptr[1] == CHAR_E)
4903
0
          ptr++;
4904
0
        else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr + 1, STR_Q STR_BACKSLASH STR_E, 3) == 0)
4905
0
          ptr += 3;
4906
0
        else
4907
0
          break;
4908
0
        }
4909
0
      else if (!negate_class && c == CHAR_CIRCUMFLEX_ACCENT)
4910
0
        negate_class = TRUE;
4911
0
      else break;
4912
0
      }
4913
4914
    /* Empty classes are allowed in JavaScript compatibility mode. Otherwise,
4915
    an initial ']' is taken as a data character -- the code below handles
4916
    that. In JS mode, [] must always fail, so generate OP_FAIL, whereas
4917
    [^] must match any character, so generate OP_ALLANY. */
4918
4919
0
    if (c == CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET &&
4920
0
        (cd->external_options & PCRE_JAVASCRIPT_COMPAT) != 0)
4921
0
      {
4922
0
      *code++ = negate_class? OP_ALLANY : OP_FAIL;
4923
0
      if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcharflags = REQ_NONE;
4924
0
      zerofirstchar = firstchar;
4925
0
      zerofirstcharflags = firstcharflags;
4926
0
      break;
4927
0
      }
4928
4929
    /* If a class contains a negative special such as \S, we need to flip the
4930
    negation flag at the end, so that support for characters > 255 works
4931
    correctly (they are all included in the class). */
4932
4933
0
    should_flip_negation = FALSE;
4934
4935
    /* Extended class (xclass) will be used when characters > 255
4936
    might match. */
4937
4938
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
4939
    xclass = FALSE;
4940
    class_uchardata = code + LINK_SIZE + 2;   /* For XCLASS items */
4941
    class_uchardata_base = class_uchardata;   /* Save the start */
4942
#endif
4943
4944
    /* For optimization purposes, we track some properties of the class:
4945
    class_has_8bitchar will be non-zero if the class contains at least one <
4946
    256 character; class_one_char will be 1 if the class contains just one
4947
    character; xclass_has_prop will be TRUE if unicode property checks
4948
    are present in the class. */
4949
4950
0
    class_has_8bitchar = 0;
4951
0
    class_one_char = 0;
4952
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
4953
    xclass_has_prop = FALSE;
4954
#endif
4955
4956
    /* Initialize the 32-char bit map to all zeros. We build the map in a
4957
    temporary bit of memory, in case the class contains fewer than two
4958
    8-bit characters because in that case the compiled code doesn't use the bit
4959
    map. */
4960
4961
0
    memset(classbits, 0, 32 * sizeof(pcre_uint8));
4962
4963
    /* Process characters until ] is reached. By writing this as a "do" it
4964
    means that an initial ] is taken as a data character. At the start of the
4965
    loop, c contains the first byte of the character. */
4966
4967
0
    if (c != CHAR_NULL) do
4968
0
      {
4969
0
      const pcre_uchar *oldptr;
4970
4971
#ifdef SUPPORT_UTF
4972
      if (utf && HAS_EXTRALEN(c))
4973
        {                           /* Braces are required because the */
4974
        GETCHARLEN(c, ptr, ptr);    /* macro generates multiple statements */
4975
        }
4976
#endif
4977
4978
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
4979
      /* In the pre-compile phase, accumulate the length of any extra
4980
      data and reset the pointer. This is so that very large classes that
4981
      contain a zillion > 255 characters no longer overwrite the work space
4982
      (which is on the stack). We have to remember that there was XCLASS data,
4983
      however. */
4984
4985
      if (class_uchardata > class_uchardata_base) xclass = TRUE;
4986
4987
      if (lengthptr != NULL && class_uchardata > class_uchardata_base)
4988
        {
4989
        *lengthptr += (int)(class_uchardata - class_uchardata_base);
4990
        class_uchardata = class_uchardata_base;
4991
        }
4992
#endif
4993
4994
      /* Inside \Q...\E everything is literal except \E */
4995
4996
0
      if (inescq)
4997
0
        {
4998
0
        if (c == CHAR_BACKSLASH && ptr[1] == CHAR_E)  /* If we are at \E */
4999
0
          {
5000
0
          inescq = FALSE;                   /* Reset literal state */
5001
0
          ptr++;                            /* Skip the 'E' */
5002
0
          continue;                         /* Carry on with next */
5003
0
          }
5004
0
        goto CHECK_RANGE;                   /* Could be range if \E follows */
5005
0
        }
5006
5007
      /* Handle POSIX class names. Perl allows a negation extension of the
5008
      form [:^name:]. A square bracket that doesn't match the syntax is
5009
      treated as a literal. We also recognize the POSIX constructions
5010
      [.ch.] and [=ch=] ("collating elements") and fault them, as Perl
5011
      5.6 and 5.8 do. */
5012
5013
0
      if (c == CHAR_LEFT_SQUARE_BRACKET &&
5014
0
          (ptr[1] == CHAR_COLON || ptr[1] == CHAR_DOT ||
5015
0
           ptr[1] == CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN) && check_posix_syntax(ptr, &tempptr))
5016
0
        {
5017
0
        BOOL local_negate = FALSE;
5018
0
        int posix_class, taboffset, tabopt;
5019
0
        register const pcre_uint8 *cbits = cd->cbits;
5020
0
        pcre_uint8 pbits[32];
5021
5022
0
        if (ptr[1] != CHAR_COLON)
5023
0
          {
5024
0
          *errorcodeptr = ERR31;
5025
0
          goto FAILED;
5026
0
          }
5027
5028
0
        ptr += 2;
5029
0
        if (*ptr == CHAR_CIRCUMFLEX_ACCENT)
5030
0
          {
5031
0
          local_negate = TRUE;
5032
0
          should_flip_negation = TRUE;  /* Note negative special */
5033
0
          ptr++;
5034
0
          }
5035
5036
0
        posix_class = check_posix_name(ptr, (int)(tempptr - ptr));
5037
0
        if (posix_class < 0)
5038
0
          {
5039
0
          *errorcodeptr = ERR30;
5040
0
          goto FAILED;
5041
0
          }
5042
5043
        /* If matching is caseless, upper and lower are converted to
5044
        alpha. This relies on the fact that the class table starts with
5045
        alpha, lower, upper as the first 3 entries. */
5046
5047
0
        if ((options & PCRE_CASELESS) != 0 && posix_class <= 2)
5048
0
          posix_class = 0;
5049
5050
        /* When PCRE_UCP is set, some of the POSIX classes are converted to
5051
        different escape sequences that use Unicode properties \p or \P. Others
5052
        that are not available via \p or \P generate XCL_PROP/XCL_NOTPROP
5053
        directly. */
5054
5055
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
5056
        if ((options & PCRE_UCP) != 0)
5057
          {
5058
          unsigned int ptype = 0;
5059
          int pc = posix_class + ((local_negate)? POSIX_SUBSIZE/2 : 0);
5060
5061
          /* The posix_substitutes table specifies which POSIX classes can be
5062
          converted to \p or \P items. */
5063
5064
          if (posix_substitutes[pc] != NULL)
5065
            {
5066
            nestptr = tempptr + 1;
5067
            ptr = posix_substitutes[pc] - 1;
5068
            continue;
5069
            }
5070
5071
          /* There are three other classes that generate special property calls
5072
          that are recognized only in an XCLASS. */
5073
5074
          else switch(posix_class)
5075
            {
5076
            case PC_GRAPH:
5077
            ptype = PT_PXGRAPH;
5078
            /* Fall through */
5079
            case PC_PRINT:
5080
            if (ptype == 0) ptype = PT_PXPRINT;
5081
            /* Fall through */
5082
            case PC_PUNCT:
5083
            if (ptype == 0) ptype = PT_PXPUNCT;
5084
            *class_uchardata++ = local_negate? XCL_NOTPROP : XCL_PROP;
5085
            *class_uchardata++ = ptype;
5086
            *class_uchardata++ = 0;
5087
            xclass_has_prop = TRUE;
5088
            ptr = tempptr + 1;
5089
            continue;
5090
5091
            /* For the other POSIX classes (ascii, cntrl, xdigit) we are going
5092
            to fall through to the non-UCP case and build a bit map for
5093
            characters with code points less than 256. If we are in a negated
5094
            POSIX class, characters with code points greater than 255 must
5095
            either all match or all not match. In the special case where we
5096
            have not yet generated any xclass data, and this is the final item
5097
            in the overall class, we need do nothing: later on, the opcode
5098
            OP_NCLASS will be used to indicate that characters greater than 255
5099
            are acceptable. If we have already seen an xclass item or one may
5100
            follow (we have to assume that it might if this is not the end of
5101
            the class), explicitly list all wide codepoints, which will then
5102
            either not match or match, depending on whether the class is or is
5103
            not negated. */
5104
5105
            default:
5106
            if (local_negate &&
5107
                (xclass || tempptr[2] != CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET))
5108
              {
5109
              *class_uchardata++ = XCL_RANGE;
5110
              class_uchardata += PRIV(ord2utf)(0x100, class_uchardata);
5111
              class_uchardata += PRIV(ord2utf)(0x10ffff, class_uchardata);
5112
              }
5113
            break;
5114
            }
5115
          }
5116
#endif
5117
        /* In the non-UCP case, or when UCP makes no difference, we build the
5118
        bit map for the POSIX class in a chunk of local store because we may be
5119
        adding and subtracting from it, and we don't want to subtract bits that
5120
        may be in the main map already. At the end we or the result into the
5121
        bit map that is being built. */
5122
5123
0
        posix_class *= 3;
5124
5125
        /* Copy in the first table (always present) */
5126
5127
0
        memcpy(pbits, cbits + posix_class_maps[posix_class],
5128
0
          32 * sizeof(pcre_uint8));
5129
5130
        /* If there is a second table, add or remove it as required. */
5131
5132
0
        taboffset = posix_class_maps[posix_class + 1];
5133
0
        tabopt = posix_class_maps[posix_class + 2];
5134
5135
0
        if (taboffset >= 0)
5136
0
          {
5137
0
          if (tabopt >= 0)
5138
0
            for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) pbits[c] |= cbits[c + taboffset];
5139
0
          else
5140
0
            for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) pbits[c] &= ~cbits[c + taboffset];
5141
0
          }
5142
5143
        /* Now see if we need to remove any special characters. An option
5144
        value of 1 removes vertical space and 2 removes underscore. */
5145
5146
0
        if (tabopt < 0) tabopt = -tabopt;
5147
0
        if (tabopt == 1) pbits[1] &= ~0x3c;
5148
0
          else if (tabopt == 2) pbits[11] &= 0x7f;
5149
5150
        /* Add the POSIX table or its complement into the main table that is
5151
        being built and we are done. */
5152
5153
0
        if (local_negate)
5154
0
          for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) classbits[c] |= ~pbits[c];
5155
0
        else
5156
0
          for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) classbits[c] |= pbits[c];
5157
5158
0
        ptr = tempptr + 1;
5159
        /* Every class contains at least one < 256 character. */
5160
0
        class_has_8bitchar = 1;
5161
        /* Every class contains at least two characters. */
5162
0
        class_one_char = 2;
5163
0
        continue;    /* End of POSIX syntax handling */
5164
0
        }
5165
5166
      /* Backslash may introduce a single character, or it may introduce one
5167
      of the specials, which just set a flag. The sequence \b is a special
5168
      case. Inside a class (and only there) it is treated as backspace. We
5169
      assume that other escapes have more than one character in them, so
5170
      speculatively set both class_has_8bitchar and class_one_char bigger
5171
      than one. Unrecognized escapes fall through and are either treated
5172
      as literal characters (by default), or are faulted if
5173
      PCRE_EXTRA is set. */
5174
5175
0
      if (c == CHAR_BACKSLASH)
5176
0
        {
5177
0
        escape = check_escape(&ptr, &ec, errorcodeptr, cd->bracount, options,
5178
0
          TRUE);
5179
0
        if (*errorcodeptr != 0) goto FAILED;
5180
0
        if (escape == 0) c = ec;
5181
0
        else if (escape == ESC_b) c = CHAR_BS; /* \b is backspace in a class */
5182
0
        else if (escape == ESC_N)          /* \N is not supported in a class */
5183
0
          {
5184
0
          *errorcodeptr = ERR71;
5185
0
          goto FAILED;
5186
0
          }
5187
0
        else if (escape == ESC_Q)            /* Handle start of quoted string */
5188
0
          {
5189
0
          if (ptr[1] == CHAR_BACKSLASH && ptr[2] == CHAR_E)
5190
0
            {
5191
0
            ptr += 2; /* avoid empty string */
5192
0
            }
5193
0
          else inescq = TRUE;
5194
0
          continue;
5195
0
          }
5196
0
        else if (escape == ESC_E) continue;  /* Ignore orphan \E */
5197
5198
0
        else
5199
0
          {
5200
0
          register const pcre_uint8 *cbits = cd->cbits;
5201
          /* Every class contains at least two < 256 characters. */
5202
0
          class_has_8bitchar++;
5203
          /* Every class contains at least two characters. */
5204
0
          class_one_char += 2;
5205
5206
0
          switch (escape)
5207
0
            {
5208
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
5209
            case ESC_du:     /* These are the values given for \d etc */
5210
            case ESC_DU:     /* when PCRE_UCP is set. We replace the */
5211
            case ESC_wu:     /* escape sequence with an appropriate \p */
5212
            case ESC_WU:     /* or \P to test Unicode properties instead */
5213
            case ESC_su:     /* of the default ASCII testing. */
5214
            case ESC_SU:
5215
            nestptr = ptr;
5216
            ptr = substitutes[escape - ESC_DU] - 1;  /* Just before substitute */
5217
            class_has_8bitchar--;                /* Undo! */
5218
            continue;
5219
#endif
5220
0
            case ESC_d:
5221
0
            for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) classbits[c] |= cbits[c+cbit_digit];
5222
0
            continue;
5223
5224
0
            case ESC_D:
5225
0
            should_flip_negation = TRUE;
5226
0
            for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) classbits[c] |= ~cbits[c+cbit_digit];
5227
0
            continue;
5228
5229
0
            case ESC_w:
5230
0
            for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) classbits[c] |= cbits[c+cbit_word];
5231
0
            continue;
5232
5233
0
            case ESC_W:
5234
0
            should_flip_negation = TRUE;
5235
0
            for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) classbits[c] |= ~cbits[c+cbit_word];
5236
0
            continue;
5237
5238
            /* Perl 5.004 onwards omitted VT from \s, but restored it at Perl
5239
            5.18. Before PCRE 8.34, we had to preserve the VT bit if it was
5240
            previously set by something earlier in the character class.
5241
            Luckily, the value of CHAR_VT is 0x0b in both ASCII and EBCDIC, so
5242
            we could just adjust the appropriate bit. From PCRE 8.34 we no
5243
            longer treat \s and \S specially. */
5244
5245
0
            case ESC_s:
5246
0
            for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) classbits[c] |= cbits[c+cbit_space];
5247
0
            continue;
5248
5249
0
            case ESC_S:
5250
0
            should_flip_negation = TRUE;
5251
0
            for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) classbits[c] |= ~cbits[c+cbit_space];
5252
0
            continue;
5253
5254
            /* The rest apply in both UCP and non-UCP cases. */
5255
5256
0
            case ESC_h:
5257
0
            (void)add_list_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata, options, cd,
5258
0
              PRIV(hspace_list), NOTACHAR);
5259
0
            continue;
5260
5261
0
            case ESC_H:
5262
0
            (void)add_not_list_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata, options,
5263
0
              cd, PRIV(hspace_list));
5264
0
            continue;
5265
5266
0
            case ESC_v:
5267
0
            (void)add_list_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata, options, cd,
5268
0
              PRIV(vspace_list), NOTACHAR);
5269
0
            continue;
5270
5271
0
            case ESC_V:
5272
0
            (void)add_not_list_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata, options,
5273
0
              cd, PRIV(vspace_list));
5274
0
            continue;
5275
5276
0
            case ESC_p:
5277
0
            case ESC_P:
5278
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
5279
              {
5280
              BOOL negated;
5281
              unsigned int ptype = 0, pdata = 0;
5282
              if (!get_ucp(&ptr, &negated, &ptype, &pdata, errorcodeptr))
5283
                goto FAILED;
5284
              *class_uchardata++ = ((escape == ESC_p) != negated)?
5285
                XCL_PROP : XCL_NOTPROP;
5286
              *class_uchardata++ = ptype;
5287
              *class_uchardata++ = pdata;
5288
              xclass_has_prop = TRUE;
5289
              class_has_8bitchar--;                /* Undo! */
5290
              continue;
5291
              }
5292
#else
5293
0
            *errorcodeptr = ERR45;
5294
0
            goto FAILED;
5295
0
#endif
5296
            /* Unrecognized escapes are faulted if PCRE is running in its
5297
            strict mode. By default, for compatibility with Perl, they are
5298
            treated as literals. */
5299
5300
0
            default:
5301
0
            if ((options & PCRE_EXTRA) != 0)
5302
0
              {
5303
0
              *errorcodeptr = ERR7;
5304
0
              goto FAILED;
5305
0
              }
5306
0
            class_has_8bitchar--;    /* Undo the speculative increase. */
5307
0
            class_one_char -= 2;     /* Undo the speculative increase. */
5308
0
            c = *ptr;                /* Get the final character and fall through */
5309
0
            break;
5310
0
            }
5311
0
          }
5312
5313
        /* Fall through if the escape just defined a single character (c >= 0).
5314
        This may be greater than 256. */
5315
5316
0
        escape = 0;
5317
5318
0
        }   /* End of backslash handling */
5319
5320
      /* A character may be followed by '-' to form a range. However, Perl does
5321
      not permit ']' to be the end of the range. A '-' character at the end is
5322
      treated as a literal. Perl ignores orphaned \E sequences entirely. The
5323
      code for handling \Q and \E is messy. */
5324
5325
0
      CHECK_RANGE:
5326
0
      while (ptr[1] == CHAR_BACKSLASH && ptr[2] == CHAR_E)
5327
0
        {
5328
0
        inescq = FALSE;
5329
0
        ptr += 2;
5330
0
        }
5331
0
      oldptr = ptr;
5332
5333
      /* Remember if \r or \n were explicitly used */
5334
5335
0
      if (c == CHAR_CR || c == CHAR_NL) cd->external_flags |= PCRE_HASCRORLF;
5336
5337
      /* Check for range */
5338
5339
0
      if (!inescq && ptr[1] == CHAR_MINUS)
5340
0
        {
5341
0
        pcre_uint32 d;
5342
0
        ptr += 2;
5343
0
        while (*ptr == CHAR_BACKSLASH && ptr[1] == CHAR_E) ptr += 2;
5344
5345
        /* If we hit \Q (not followed by \E) at this point, go into escaped
5346
        mode. */
5347
5348
0
        while (*ptr == CHAR_BACKSLASH && ptr[1] == CHAR_Q)
5349
0
          {
5350
0
          ptr += 2;
5351
0
          if (*ptr == CHAR_BACKSLASH && ptr[1] == CHAR_E)
5352
0
            { ptr += 2; continue; }
5353
0
          inescq = TRUE;
5354
0
          break;
5355
0
          }
5356
5357
        /* Minus (hyphen) at the end of a class is treated as a literal, so put
5358
        back the pointer and jump to handle the character that preceded it. */
5359
5360
0
        if (*ptr == CHAR_NULL || (!inescq && *ptr == CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET))
5361
0
          {
5362
0
          ptr = oldptr;
5363
0
          goto CLASS_SINGLE_CHARACTER;
5364
0
          }
5365
5366
        /* Otherwise, we have a potential range; pick up the next character */
5367
5368
#ifdef SUPPORT_UTF
5369
        if (utf)
5370
          {                           /* Braces are required because the */
5371
          GETCHARLEN(d, ptr, ptr);    /* macro generates multiple statements */
5372
          }
5373
        else
5374
#endif
5375
0
        d = *ptr;  /* Not UTF-8 mode */
5376
5377
        /* The second part of a range can be a single-character escape
5378
        sequence, but not any of the other escapes. Perl treats a hyphen as a
5379
        literal in such circumstances. However, in Perl's warning mode, a
5380
        warning is given, so PCRE now faults it as it is almost certainly a
5381
        mistake on the user's part. */
5382
5383
0
        if (!inescq)
5384
0
          {
5385
0
          if (d == CHAR_BACKSLASH)
5386
0
            {
5387
0
            int descape;
5388
0
            descape = check_escape(&ptr, &d, errorcodeptr, cd->bracount, options, TRUE);
5389
0
            if (*errorcodeptr != 0) goto FAILED;
5390
5391
            /* 0 means a character was put into d; \b is backspace; any other
5392
            special causes an error. */
5393
5394
0
            if (descape != 0)
5395
0
              {
5396
0
              if (descape == ESC_b) d = CHAR_BS; else
5397
0
                {
5398
0
                *errorcodeptr = ERR83;
5399
0
                goto FAILED;
5400
0
                }
5401
0
              }
5402
0
            }
5403
5404
          /* A hyphen followed by a POSIX class is treated in the same way. */
5405
5406
0
          else if (d == CHAR_LEFT_SQUARE_BRACKET &&
5407
0
                   (ptr[1] == CHAR_COLON || ptr[1] == CHAR_DOT ||
5408
0
                    ptr[1] == CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN) &&
5409
0
                   check_posix_syntax(ptr, &tempptr))
5410
0
            {
5411
0
            *errorcodeptr = ERR83;
5412
0
            goto FAILED;
5413
0
            }
5414
0
          }
5415
5416
        /* Check that the two values are in the correct order. Optimize
5417
        one-character ranges. */
5418
5419
0
        if (d < c)
5420
0
          {
5421
0
          *errorcodeptr = ERR8;
5422
0
          goto FAILED;
5423
0
          }
5424
0
        if (d == c) goto CLASS_SINGLE_CHARACTER;  /* A few lines below */
5425
5426
        /* We have found a character range, so single character optimizations
5427
        cannot be done anymore. Any value greater than 1 indicates that there
5428
        is more than one character. */
5429
5430
0
        class_one_char = 2;
5431
5432
        /* Remember an explicit \r or \n, and add the range to the class. */
5433
5434
0
        if (d == CHAR_CR || d == CHAR_NL) cd->external_flags |= PCRE_HASCRORLF;
5435
5436
0
        class_has_8bitchar +=
5437
0
          add_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata, options, cd, c, d);
5438
5439
0
        continue;   /* Go get the next char in the class */
5440
0
        }
5441
5442
      /* Handle a single character - we can get here for a normal non-escape
5443
      char, or after \ that introduces a single character or for an apparent
5444
      range that isn't. Only the value 1 matters for class_one_char, so don't
5445
      increase it if it is already 2 or more ... just in case there's a class
5446
      with a zillion characters in it. */
5447
5448
0
      CLASS_SINGLE_CHARACTER:
5449
0
      if (class_one_char < 2) class_one_char++;
5450
5451
      /* If xclass_has_prop is false and class_one_char is 1, we have the first
5452
      single character in the class, and there have been no prior ranges, or
5453
      XCLASS items generated by escapes. If this is the final character in the
5454
      class, we can optimize by turning the item into a 1-character OP_CHAR[I]
5455
      if it's positive, or OP_NOT[I] if it's negative. In the positive case, it
5456
      can cause firstchar to be set. Otherwise, there can be no first char if
5457
      this item is first, whatever repeat count may follow. In the case of
5458
      reqchar, save the previous value for reinstating. */
5459
5460
0
      if (!inescq &&
5461
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
5462
          !xclass_has_prop &&
5463
#endif
5464
0
          class_one_char == 1 && ptr[1] == CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET)
5465
0
        {
5466
0
        ptr++;
5467
0
        zeroreqchar = reqchar;
5468
0
        zeroreqcharflags = reqcharflags;
5469
5470
0
        if (negate_class)
5471
0
          {
5472
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
5473
          int d;
5474
#endif
5475
0
          if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcharflags = REQ_NONE;
5476
0
          zerofirstchar = firstchar;
5477
0
          zerofirstcharflags = firstcharflags;
5478
5479
          /* For caseless UTF-8 mode when UCP support is available, check
5480
          whether this character has more than one other case. If so, generate
5481
          a special OP_NOTPROP item instead of OP_NOTI. */
5482
5483
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
5484
          if (utf && (options & PCRE_CASELESS) != 0 &&
5485
              (d = UCD_CASESET(c)) != 0)
5486
            {
5487
            *code++ = OP_NOTPROP;
5488
            *code++ = PT_CLIST;
5489
            *code++ = d;
5490
            }
5491
          else
5492
#endif
5493
          /* Char has only one other case, or UCP not available */
5494
5495
0
            {
5496
0
            *code++ = ((options & PCRE_CASELESS) != 0)? OP_NOTI: OP_NOT;
5497
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF && !defined COMPILE_PCRE32
5498
            if (utf && c > MAX_VALUE_FOR_SINGLE_CHAR)
5499
              code += PRIV(ord2utf)(c, code);
5500
            else
5501
#endif
5502
0
              *code++ = c;
5503
0
            }
5504
5505
          /* We are finished with this character class */
5506
5507
0
          goto END_CLASS;
5508
0
          }
5509
5510
        /* For a single, positive character, get the value into mcbuffer, and
5511
        then we can handle this with the normal one-character code. */
5512
5513
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF && !defined COMPILE_PCRE32
5514
        if (utf && c > MAX_VALUE_FOR_SINGLE_CHAR)
5515
          mclength = PRIV(ord2utf)(c, mcbuffer);
5516
        else
5517
#endif
5518
0
          {
5519
0
          mcbuffer[0] = c;
5520
0
          mclength = 1;
5521
0
          }
5522
0
        goto ONE_CHAR;
5523
0
        }       /* End of 1-char optimization */
5524
5525
      /* There is more than one character in the class, or an XCLASS item
5526
      has been generated. Add this character to the class. */
5527
5528
0
      class_has_8bitchar +=
5529
0
        add_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata, options, cd, c, c);
5530
0
      }
5531
5532
    /* Loop until ']' reached. This "while" is the end of the "do" far above.
5533
    If we are at the end of an internal nested string, revert to the outer
5534
    string. */
5535
5536
0
    while (((c = *(++ptr)) != CHAR_NULL ||
5537
0
           (nestptr != NULL &&
5538
0
             (ptr = nestptr, nestptr = NULL, c = *(++ptr)) != CHAR_NULL)) &&
5539
0
           (c != CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET || inescq));
5540
5541
    /* Check for missing terminating ']' */
5542
5543
0
    if (c == CHAR_NULL)
5544
0
      {
5545
0
      *errorcodeptr = ERR6;
5546
0
      goto FAILED;
5547
0
      }
5548
5549
    /* We will need an XCLASS if data has been placed in class_uchardata. In
5550
    the second phase this is a sufficient test. However, in the pre-compile
5551
    phase, class_uchardata gets emptied to prevent workspace overflow, so it
5552
    only if the very last character in the class needs XCLASS will it contain
5553
    anything at this point. For this reason, xclass gets set TRUE above when
5554
    uchar_classdata is emptied, and that's why this code is the way it is here
5555
    instead of just doing a test on class_uchardata below. */
5556
5557
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
5558
    if (class_uchardata > class_uchardata_base) xclass = TRUE;
5559
#endif
5560
5561
    /* If this is the first thing in the branch, there can be no first char
5562
    setting, whatever the repeat count. Any reqchar setting must remain
5563
    unchanged after any kind of repeat. */
5564
5565
0
    if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcharflags = REQ_NONE;
5566
0
    zerofirstchar = firstchar;
5567
0
    zerofirstcharflags = firstcharflags;
5568
0
    zeroreqchar = reqchar;
5569
0
    zeroreqcharflags = reqcharflags;
5570
5571
    /* If there are characters with values > 255, we have to compile an
5572
    extended class, with its own opcode, unless there was a negated special
5573
    such as \S in the class, and PCRE_UCP is not set, because in that case all
5574
    characters > 255 are in the class, so any that were explicitly given as
5575
    well can be ignored. If (when there are explicit characters > 255 that must
5576
    be listed) there are no characters < 256, we can omit the bitmap in the
5577
    actual compiled code. */
5578
5579
#ifdef SUPPORT_UTF
5580
    if (xclass && (xclass_has_prop || !should_flip_negation ||
5581
        (options & PCRE_UCP) != 0))
5582
#elif !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
5583
    if (xclass && (xclass_has_prop || !should_flip_negation))
5584
#endif
5585
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
5586
      {
5587
      /* For non-UCP wide characters, in a non-negative class containing \S or
5588
      similar (should_flip_negation is set), all characters greater than 255
5589
      must be in the class. */
5590
5591
      if (
5592
#if defined COMPILE_PCRE8
5593
           utf &&
5594
#endif
5595
           should_flip_negation && !negate_class && (options & PCRE_UCP) == 0)
5596
        {
5597
        *class_uchardata++ = XCL_RANGE;
5598
        if (utf)   /* Will always be utf in the 8-bit library */
5599
          {
5600
          class_uchardata += PRIV(ord2utf)(0x100, class_uchardata);
5601
          class_uchardata += PRIV(ord2utf)(0x10ffff, class_uchardata);
5602
          }
5603
        else       /* Can only happen for the 16-bit & 32-bit libraries */
5604
          {
5605
#if defined COMPILE_PCRE16
5606
          *class_uchardata++ = 0x100;
5607
          *class_uchardata++ = 0xffffu;
5608
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32
5609
          *class_uchardata++ = 0x100;
5610
          *class_uchardata++ = 0xffffffffu;
5611
#endif
5612
          }
5613
        }
5614
5615
      *class_uchardata++ = XCL_END;    /* Marks the end of extra data */
5616
      *code++ = OP_XCLASS;
5617
      code += LINK_SIZE;
5618
      *code = negate_class? XCL_NOT:0;
5619
      if (xclass_has_prop) *code |= XCL_HASPROP;
5620
5621
      /* If the map is required, move up the extra data to make room for it;
5622
      otherwise just move the code pointer to the end of the extra data. */
5623
5624
      if (class_has_8bitchar > 0)
5625
        {
5626
        *code++ |= XCL_MAP;
5627
        memmove(code + (32 / sizeof(pcre_uchar)), code,
5628
          IN_UCHARS(class_uchardata - code));
5629
        if (negate_class && !xclass_has_prop)
5630
          for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) classbits[c] = ~classbits[c];
5631
        memcpy(code, classbits, 32);
5632
        code = class_uchardata + (32 / sizeof(pcre_uchar));
5633
        }
5634
      else code = class_uchardata;
5635
5636
      /* Now fill in the complete length of the item */
5637
5638
      PUT(previous, 1, (int)(code - previous));
5639
      break;   /* End of class handling */
5640
      }
5641
5642
    /* Even though any XCLASS list is now discarded, we must allow for
5643
    its memory. */
5644
5645
    if (lengthptr != NULL)
5646
      *lengthptr += (int)(class_uchardata - class_uchardata_base);
5647
#endif
5648
5649
    /* If there are no characters > 255, or they are all to be included or
5650
    excluded, set the opcode to OP_CLASS or OP_NCLASS, depending on whether the
5651
    whole class was negated and whether there were negative specials such as \S
5652
    (non-UCP) in the class. Then copy the 32-byte map into the code vector,
5653
    negating it if necessary. */
5654
5655
0
    *code++ = (negate_class == should_flip_negation) ? OP_CLASS : OP_NCLASS;
5656
0
    if (lengthptr == NULL)    /* Save time in the pre-compile phase */
5657
0
      {
5658
0
      if (negate_class)
5659
0
        for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) classbits[c] = ~classbits[c];
5660
0
      memcpy(code, classbits, 32);
5661
0
      }
5662
0
    code += 32 / sizeof(pcre_uchar);
5663
5664
0
    END_CLASS:
5665
0
    break;
5666
5667
5668
    /* ===================================================================*/
5669
    /* Various kinds of repeat; '{' is not necessarily a quantifier, but this
5670
    has been tested above. */
5671
5672
0
    case CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET:
5673
0
    if (!is_quantifier) goto NORMAL_CHAR;
5674
0
    ptr = read_repeat_counts(ptr+1, &repeat_min, &repeat_max, errorcodeptr);
5675
0
    if (*errorcodeptr != 0) goto FAILED;
5676
0
    goto REPEAT;
5677
5678
0
    case CHAR_ASTERISK:
5679
0
    repeat_min = 0;
5680
0
    repeat_max = -1;
5681
0
    goto REPEAT;
5682
5683
0
    case CHAR_PLUS:
5684
0
    repeat_min = 1;
5685
0
    repeat_max = -1;
5686
0
    goto REPEAT;
5687
5688
0
    case CHAR_QUESTION_MARK:
5689
0
    repeat_min = 0;
5690
0
    repeat_max = 1;
5691
5692
0
    REPEAT:
5693
0
    if (previous == NULL)
5694
0
      {
5695
0
      *errorcodeptr = ERR9;
5696
0
      goto FAILED;
5697
0
      }
5698
5699
0
    if (repeat_min == 0)
5700
0
      {
5701
0
      firstchar = zerofirstchar;    /* Adjust for zero repeat */
5702
0
      firstcharflags = zerofirstcharflags;
5703
0
      reqchar = zeroreqchar;        /* Ditto */
5704
0
      reqcharflags = zeroreqcharflags;
5705
0
      }
5706
5707
    /* Remember whether this is a variable length repeat */
5708
5709
0
    reqvary = (repeat_min == repeat_max)? 0 : REQ_VARY;
5710
5711
0
    op_type = 0;                    /* Default single-char op codes */
5712
0
    possessive_quantifier = FALSE;  /* Default not possessive quantifier */
5713
5714
    /* Save start of previous item, in case we have to move it up in order to
5715
    insert something before it. */
5716
5717
0
    tempcode = previous;
5718
5719
    /* Before checking for a possessive quantifier, we must skip over
5720
    whitespace and comments in extended mode because Perl allows white space at
5721
    this point. */
5722
5723
0
    if ((options & PCRE_EXTENDED) != 0)
5724
0
      {
5725
0
      const pcre_uchar *p = ptr + 1;
5726
0
      for (;;)
5727
0
        {
5728
0
        while (MAX_255(*p) && (cd->ctypes[*p] & ctype_space) != 0) p++;
5729
0
        if (*p != CHAR_NUMBER_SIGN) break;
5730
0
        p++;
5731
0
        while (*p != CHAR_NULL)
5732
0
          {
5733
0
          if (IS_NEWLINE(p))         /* For non-fixed-length newline cases, */
5734
0
            {                        /* IS_NEWLINE sets cd->nllen. */
5735
0
            p += cd->nllen;
5736
0
            break;
5737
0
            }
5738
0
          p++;
5739
#ifdef SUPPORT_UTF
5740
          if (utf) FORWARDCHAR(p);
5741
#endif
5742
0
          }           /* Loop for comment characters */
5743
0
        }             /* Loop for multiple comments */
5744
0
      ptr = p - 1;    /* Character before the next significant one. */
5745
0
      }
5746
5747
    /* We also need to skip over (?# comments, which are not dependent on
5748
    extended mode. */
5749
5750
0
    if (ptr[1] == CHAR_LEFT_PARENTHESIS && ptr[2] == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK &&
5751
0
        ptr[3] == CHAR_NUMBER_SIGN)
5752
0
      {
5753
0
      ptr += 4;
5754
0
      while (*ptr != CHAR_NULL && *ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS) ptr++;
5755
0
      if (*ptr == CHAR_NULL)
5756
0
        {
5757
0
        *errorcodeptr = ERR18;
5758
0
        goto FAILED;
5759
0
        }
5760
0
      }
5761
5762
    /* If the next character is '+', we have a possessive quantifier. This
5763
    implies greediness, whatever the setting of the PCRE_UNGREEDY option.
5764
    If the next character is '?' this is a minimizing repeat, by default,
5765
    but if PCRE_UNGREEDY is set, it works the other way round. We change the
5766
    repeat type to the non-default. */
5767
5768
0
    if (ptr[1] == CHAR_PLUS)
5769
0
      {
5770
0
      repeat_type = 0;                  /* Force greedy */
5771
0
      possessive_quantifier = TRUE;
5772
0
      ptr++;
5773
0
      }
5774
0
    else if (ptr[1] == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK)
5775
0
      {
5776
0
      repeat_type = greedy_non_default;
5777
0
      ptr++;
5778
0
      }
5779
0
    else repeat_type = greedy_default;
5780
5781
    /* If previous was a recursion call, wrap it in atomic brackets so that
5782
    previous becomes the atomic group. All recursions were so wrapped in the
5783
    past, but it no longer happens for non-repeated recursions. In fact, the
5784
    repeated ones could be re-implemented independently so as not to need this,
5785
    but for the moment we rely on the code for repeating groups. */
5786
5787
0
    if (*previous == OP_RECURSE)
5788
0
      {
5789
0
      memmove(previous + 1 + LINK_SIZE, previous, IN_UCHARS(1 + LINK_SIZE));
5790
0
      *previous = OP_ONCE;
5791
0
      PUT(previous, 1, 2 + 2*LINK_SIZE);
5792
0
      previous[2 + 2*LINK_SIZE] = OP_KET;
5793
0
      PUT(previous, 3 + 2*LINK_SIZE, 2 + 2*LINK_SIZE);
5794
0
      code += 2 + 2 * LINK_SIZE;
5795
0
      length_prevgroup = 3 + 3*LINK_SIZE;
5796
5797
      /* When actually compiling, we need to check whether this was a forward
5798
      reference, and if so, adjust the offset. */
5799
5800
0
      if (lengthptr == NULL && cd->hwm >= cd->start_workspace + LINK_SIZE)
5801
0
        {
5802
0
        int offset = GET(cd->hwm, -LINK_SIZE);
5803
0
        if (offset == previous + 1 - cd->start_code)
5804
0
          PUT(cd->hwm, -LINK_SIZE, offset + 1 + LINK_SIZE);
5805
0
        }
5806
0
      }
5807
5808
    /* Now handle repetition for the different types of item. */
5809
5810
    /* If previous was a character or negated character match, abolish the item
5811
    and generate a repeat item instead. If a char item has a minimum of more
5812
    than one, ensure that it is set in reqchar - it might not be if a sequence
5813
    such as x{3} is the first thing in a branch because the x will have gone
5814
    into firstchar instead.  */
5815
5816
0
    if (*previous == OP_CHAR || *previous == OP_CHARI
5817
0
        || *previous == OP_NOT || *previous == OP_NOTI)
5818
0
      {
5819
0
      switch (*previous)
5820
0
        {
5821
0
        default: /* Make compiler happy. */
5822
0
        case OP_CHAR:  op_type = OP_STAR - OP_STAR; break;
5823
0
        case OP_CHARI: op_type = OP_STARI - OP_STAR; break;
5824
0
        case OP_NOT:   op_type = OP_NOTSTAR - OP_STAR; break;
5825
0
        case OP_NOTI:  op_type = OP_NOTSTARI - OP_STAR; break;
5826
0
        }
5827
5828
      /* Deal with UTF characters that take up more than one character. It's
5829
      easier to write this out separately than try to macrify it. Use c to
5830
      hold the length of the character in bytes, plus UTF_LENGTH to flag that
5831
      it's a length rather than a small character. */
5832
5833
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF && !defined COMPILE_PCRE32
5834
      if (utf && NOT_FIRSTCHAR(code[-1]))
5835
        {
5836
        pcre_uchar *lastchar = code - 1;
5837
        BACKCHAR(lastchar);
5838
        c = (int)(code - lastchar);     /* Length of UTF-8 character */
5839
        memcpy(utf_chars, lastchar, IN_UCHARS(c)); /* Save the char */
5840
        c |= UTF_LENGTH;                /* Flag c as a length */
5841
        }
5842
      else
5843
#endif /* SUPPORT_UTF */
5844
5845
      /* Handle the case of a single charater - either with no UTF support, or
5846
      with UTF disabled, or for a single character UTF character. */
5847
0
        {
5848
0
        c = code[-1];
5849
0
        if (*previous <= OP_CHARI && repeat_min > 1)
5850
0
          {
5851
0
          reqchar = c;
5852
0
          reqcharflags = req_caseopt | cd->req_varyopt;
5853
0
          }
5854
0
        }
5855
5856
0
      goto OUTPUT_SINGLE_REPEAT;   /* Code shared with single character types */
5857
0
      }
5858
5859
    /* If previous was a character type match (\d or similar), abolish it and
5860
    create a suitable repeat item. The code is shared with single-character
5861
    repeats by setting op_type to add a suitable offset into repeat_type. Note
5862
    the the Unicode property types will be present only when SUPPORT_UCP is
5863
    defined, but we don't wrap the little bits of code here because it just
5864
    makes it horribly messy. */
5865
5866
0
    else if (*previous < OP_EODN)
5867
0
      {
5868
0
      pcre_uchar *oldcode;
5869
0
      int prop_type, prop_value;
5870
0
      op_type = OP_TYPESTAR - OP_STAR;  /* Use type opcodes */
5871
0
      c = *previous;
5872
5873
0
      OUTPUT_SINGLE_REPEAT:
5874
0
      if (*previous == OP_PROP || *previous == OP_NOTPROP)
5875
0
        {
5876
0
        prop_type = previous[1];
5877
0
        prop_value = previous[2];
5878
0
        }
5879
0
      else prop_type = prop_value = -1;
5880
5881
0
      oldcode = code;
5882
0
      code = previous;                  /* Usually overwrite previous item */
5883
5884
      /* If the maximum is zero then the minimum must also be zero; Perl allows
5885
      this case, so we do too - by simply omitting the item altogether. */
5886
5887
0
      if (repeat_max == 0) goto END_REPEAT;
5888
5889
      /* Combine the op_type with the repeat_type */
5890
5891
0
      repeat_type += op_type;
5892
5893
      /* A minimum of zero is handled either as the special case * or ?, or as
5894
      an UPTO, with the maximum given. */
5895
5896
0
      if (repeat_min == 0)
5897
0
        {
5898
0
        if (repeat_max == -1) *code++ = OP_STAR + repeat_type;
5899
0
          else if (repeat_max == 1) *code++ = OP_QUERY + repeat_type;
5900
0
        else
5901
0
          {
5902
0
          *code++ = OP_UPTO + repeat_type;
5903
0
          PUT2INC(code, 0, repeat_max);
5904
0
          }
5905
0
        }
5906
5907
      /* A repeat minimum of 1 is optimized into some special cases. If the
5908
      maximum is unlimited, we use OP_PLUS. Otherwise, the original item is
5909
      left in place and, if the maximum is greater than 1, we use OP_UPTO with
5910
      one less than the maximum. */
5911
5912
0
      else if (repeat_min == 1)
5913
0
        {
5914
0
        if (repeat_max == -1)
5915
0
          *code++ = OP_PLUS + repeat_type;
5916
0
        else
5917
0
          {
5918
0
          code = oldcode;                 /* leave previous item in place */
5919
0
          if (repeat_max == 1) goto END_REPEAT;
5920
0
          *code++ = OP_UPTO + repeat_type;
5921
0
          PUT2INC(code, 0, repeat_max - 1);
5922
0
          }
5923
0
        }
5924
5925
      /* The case {n,n} is just an EXACT, while the general case {n,m} is
5926
      handled as an EXACT followed by an UPTO. */
5927
5928
0
      else
5929
0
        {
5930
0
        *code++ = OP_EXACT + op_type;  /* NB EXACT doesn't have repeat_type */
5931
0
        PUT2INC(code, 0, repeat_min);
5932
5933
        /* If the maximum is unlimited, insert an OP_STAR. Before doing so,
5934
        we have to insert the character for the previous code. For a repeated
5935
        Unicode property match, there are two extra bytes that define the
5936
        required property. In UTF-8 mode, long characters have their length in
5937
        c, with the UTF_LENGTH bit as a flag. */
5938
5939
0
        if (repeat_max < 0)
5940
0
          {
5941
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF && !defined COMPILE_PCRE32
5942
          if (utf && (c & UTF_LENGTH) != 0)
5943
            {
5944
            memcpy(code, utf_chars, IN_UCHARS(c & 7));
5945
            code += c & 7;
5946
            }
5947
          else
5948
#endif
5949
0
            {
5950
0
            *code++ = c;
5951
0
            if (prop_type >= 0)
5952
0
              {
5953
0
              *code++ = prop_type;
5954
0
              *code++ = prop_value;
5955
0
              }
5956
0
            }
5957
0
          *code++ = OP_STAR + repeat_type;
5958
0
          }
5959
5960
        /* Else insert an UPTO if the max is greater than the min, again
5961
        preceded by the character, for the previously inserted code. If the
5962
        UPTO is just for 1 instance, we can use QUERY instead. */
5963
5964
0
        else if (repeat_max != repeat_min)
5965
0
          {
5966
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF && !defined COMPILE_PCRE32
5967
          if (utf && (c & UTF_LENGTH) != 0)
5968
            {
5969
            memcpy(code, utf_chars, IN_UCHARS(c & 7));
5970
            code += c & 7;
5971
            }
5972
          else
5973
#endif
5974
0
          *code++ = c;
5975
0
          if (prop_type >= 0)
5976
0
            {
5977
0
            *code++ = prop_type;
5978
0
            *code++ = prop_value;
5979
0
            }
5980
0
          repeat_max -= repeat_min;
5981
5982
0
          if (repeat_max == 1)
5983
0
            {
5984
0
            *code++ = OP_QUERY + repeat_type;
5985
0
            }
5986
0
          else
5987
0
            {
5988
0
            *code++ = OP_UPTO + repeat_type;
5989
0
            PUT2INC(code, 0, repeat_max);
5990
0
            }
5991
0
          }
5992
0
        }
5993
5994
      /* The character or character type itself comes last in all cases. */
5995
5996
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF && !defined COMPILE_PCRE32
5997
      if (utf && (c & UTF_LENGTH) != 0)
5998
        {
5999
        memcpy(code, utf_chars, IN_UCHARS(c & 7));
6000
        code += c & 7;
6001
        }
6002
      else
6003
#endif
6004
0
      *code++ = c;
6005
6006
      /* For a repeated Unicode property match, there are two extra bytes that
6007
      define the required property. */
6008
6009
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
6010
      if (prop_type >= 0)
6011
        {
6012
        *code++ = prop_type;
6013
        *code++ = prop_value;
6014
        }
6015
#endif
6016
0
      }
6017
6018
    /* If previous was a character class or a back reference, we put the repeat
6019
    stuff after it, but just skip the item if the repeat was {0,0}. */
6020
6021
0
    else if (*previous == OP_CLASS || *previous == OP_NCLASS ||
6022
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
6023
             *previous == OP_XCLASS ||
6024
#endif
6025
0
             *previous == OP_REF   || *previous == OP_REFI ||
6026
0
             *previous == OP_DNREF || *previous == OP_DNREFI)
6027
0
      {
6028
0
      if (repeat_max == 0)
6029
0
        {
6030
0
        code = previous;
6031
0
        goto END_REPEAT;
6032
0
        }
6033
6034
0
      if (repeat_min == 0 && repeat_max == -1)
6035
0
        *code++ = OP_CRSTAR + repeat_type;
6036
0
      else if (repeat_min == 1 && repeat_max == -1)
6037
0
        *code++ = OP_CRPLUS + repeat_type;
6038
0
      else if (repeat_min == 0 && repeat_max == 1)
6039
0
        *code++ = OP_CRQUERY + repeat_type;
6040
0
      else
6041
0
        {
6042
0
        *code++ = OP_CRRANGE + repeat_type;
6043
0
        PUT2INC(code, 0, repeat_min);
6044
0
        if (repeat_max == -1) repeat_max = 0;  /* 2-byte encoding for max */
6045
0
        PUT2INC(code, 0, repeat_max);
6046
0
        }
6047
0
      }
6048
6049
    /* If previous was a bracket group, we may have to replicate it in certain
6050
    cases. Note that at this point we can encounter only the "basic" bracket
6051
    opcodes such as BRA and CBRA, as this is the place where they get converted
6052
    into the more special varieties such as BRAPOS and SBRA. A test for >=
6053
    OP_ASSERT and <= OP_COND includes ASSERT, ASSERT_NOT, ASSERTBACK,
6054
    ASSERTBACK_NOT, ONCE, ONCE_NC, BRA, BRAPOS, CBRA, CBRAPOS, and COND.
6055
    Originally, PCRE did not allow repetition of assertions, but now it does,
6056
    for Perl compatibility. */
6057
6058
0
    else if (*previous >= OP_ASSERT && *previous <= OP_COND)
6059
0
      {
6060
0
      register int i;
6061
0
      int len = (int)(code - previous);
6062
0
      size_t base_hwm_offset = item_hwm_offset;
6063
0
      pcre_uchar *bralink = NULL;
6064
0
      pcre_uchar *brazeroptr = NULL;
6065
6066
      /* Repeating a DEFINE group is pointless, but Perl allows the syntax, so
6067
      we just ignore the repeat. */
6068
6069
0
      if (*previous == OP_COND && previous[LINK_SIZE+1] == OP_DEF)
6070
0
        goto END_REPEAT;
6071
6072
      /* There is no sense in actually repeating assertions. The only potential
6073
      use of repetition is in cases when the assertion is optional. Therefore,
6074
      if the minimum is greater than zero, just ignore the repeat. If the
6075
      maximum is not zero or one, set it to 1. */
6076
6077
0
      if (*previous < OP_ONCE)    /* Assertion */
6078
0
        {
6079
0
        if (repeat_min > 0) goto END_REPEAT;
6080
0
        if (repeat_max < 0 || repeat_max > 1) repeat_max = 1;
6081
0
        }
6082
6083
      /* The case of a zero minimum is special because of the need to stick
6084
      OP_BRAZERO in front of it, and because the group appears once in the
6085
      data, whereas in other cases it appears the minimum number of times. For
6086
      this reason, it is simplest to treat this case separately, as otherwise
6087
      the code gets far too messy. There are several special subcases when the
6088
      minimum is zero. */
6089
6090
0
      if (repeat_min == 0)
6091
0
        {
6092
        /* If the maximum is also zero, we used to just omit the group from the
6093
        output altogether, like this:
6094
6095
        ** if (repeat_max == 0)
6096
        **   {
6097
        **   code = previous;
6098
        **   goto END_REPEAT;
6099
        **   }
6100
6101
        However, that fails when a group or a subgroup within it is referenced
6102
        as a subroutine from elsewhere in the pattern, so now we stick in
6103
        OP_SKIPZERO in front of it so that it is skipped on execution. As we
6104
        don't have a list of which groups are referenced, we cannot do this
6105
        selectively.
6106
6107
        If the maximum is 1 or unlimited, we just have to stick in the BRAZERO
6108
        and do no more at this point. However, we do need to adjust any
6109
        OP_RECURSE calls inside the group that refer to the group itself or any
6110
        internal or forward referenced group, because the offset is from the
6111
        start of the whole regex. Temporarily terminate the pattern while doing
6112
        this. */
6113
6114
0
        if (repeat_max <= 1)    /* Covers 0, 1, and unlimited */
6115
0
          {
6116
0
          *code = OP_END;
6117
0
          adjust_recurse(previous, 1, utf, cd, item_hwm_offset);
6118
0
          memmove(previous + 1, previous, IN_UCHARS(len));
6119
0
          code++;
6120
0
          if (repeat_max == 0)
6121
0
            {
6122
0
            *previous++ = OP_SKIPZERO;
6123
0
            goto END_REPEAT;
6124
0
            }
6125
0
          brazeroptr = previous;    /* Save for possessive optimizing */
6126
0
          *previous++ = OP_BRAZERO + repeat_type;
6127
0
          }
6128
6129
        /* If the maximum is greater than 1 and limited, we have to replicate
6130
        in a nested fashion, sticking OP_BRAZERO before each set of brackets.
6131
        The first one has to be handled carefully because it's the original
6132
        copy, which has to be moved up. The remainder can be handled by code
6133
        that is common with the non-zero minimum case below. We have to
6134
        adjust the value or repeat_max, since one less copy is required. Once
6135
        again, we may have to adjust any OP_RECURSE calls inside the group. */
6136
6137
0
        else
6138
0
          {
6139
0
          int offset;
6140
0
          *code = OP_END;
6141
0
          adjust_recurse(previous, 2 + LINK_SIZE, utf, cd, item_hwm_offset);
6142
0
          memmove(previous + 2 + LINK_SIZE, previous, IN_UCHARS(len));
6143
0
          code += 2 + LINK_SIZE;
6144
0
          *previous++ = OP_BRAZERO + repeat_type;
6145
0
          *previous++ = OP_BRA;
6146
6147
          /* We chain together the bracket offset fields that have to be
6148
          filled in later when the ends of the brackets are reached. */
6149
6150
0
          offset = (bralink == NULL)? 0 : (int)(previous - bralink);
6151
0
          bralink = previous;
6152
0
          PUTINC(previous, 0, offset);
6153
0
          }
6154
6155
0
        repeat_max--;
6156
0
        }
6157
6158
      /* If the minimum is greater than zero, replicate the group as many
6159
      times as necessary, and adjust the maximum to the number of subsequent
6160
      copies that we need. If we set a first char from the group, and didn't
6161
      set a required char, copy the latter from the former. If there are any
6162
      forward reference subroutine calls in the group, there will be entries on
6163
      the workspace list; replicate these with an appropriate increment. */
6164
6165
0
      else
6166
0
        {
6167
0
        if (repeat_min > 1)
6168
0
          {
6169
          /* In the pre-compile phase, we don't actually do the replication. We
6170
          just adjust the length as if we had. Do some paranoid checks for
6171
          potential integer overflow. The INT64_OR_DOUBLE type is a 64-bit
6172
          integer type when available, otherwise double. */
6173
6174
0
          if (lengthptr != NULL)
6175
0
            {
6176
0
            int delta = (repeat_min - 1)*length_prevgroup;
6177
0
            if ((INT64_OR_DOUBLE)(repeat_min - 1)*
6178
0
                  (INT64_OR_DOUBLE)length_prevgroup >
6179
0
                    (INT64_OR_DOUBLE)INT_MAX ||
6180
0
                OFLOW_MAX - *lengthptr < delta)
6181
0
              {
6182
0
              *errorcodeptr = ERR20;
6183
0
              goto FAILED;
6184
0
              }
6185
0
            *lengthptr += delta;
6186
0
            }
6187
6188
          /* This is compiling for real. If there is a set first byte for
6189
          the group, and we have not yet set a "required byte", set it. Make
6190
          sure there is enough workspace for copying forward references before
6191
          doing the copy. */
6192
6193
0
          else
6194
0
            {
6195
0
            if (groupsetfirstchar && reqcharflags < 0)
6196
0
              {
6197
0
              reqchar = firstchar;
6198
0
              reqcharflags = firstcharflags;
6199
0
              }
6200
6201
0
            for (i = 1; i < repeat_min; i++)
6202
0
              {
6203
0
              pcre_uchar *hc;
6204
0
              size_t this_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace;
6205
0
              memcpy(code, previous, IN_UCHARS(len));
6206
6207
0
              while (cd->hwm > cd->start_workspace + cd->workspace_size -
6208
0
                     WORK_SIZE_SAFETY_MARGIN -
6209
0
                     (this_hwm_offset - base_hwm_offset))
6210
0
                {
6211
0
                *errorcodeptr = expand_workspace(cd);
6212
0
                if (*errorcodeptr != 0) goto FAILED;
6213
0
                }
6214
6215
0
              for (hc = (pcre_uchar *)cd->start_workspace + base_hwm_offset;
6216
0
                   hc < (pcre_uchar *)cd->start_workspace + this_hwm_offset;
6217
0
                   hc += LINK_SIZE)
6218
0
                {
6219
0
                PUT(cd->hwm, 0, GET(hc, 0) + len);
6220
0
                cd->hwm += LINK_SIZE;
6221
0
                }
6222
0
              base_hwm_offset = this_hwm_offset;
6223
0
              code += len;
6224
0
              }
6225
0
            }
6226
0
          }
6227
6228
0
        if (repeat_max > 0) repeat_max -= repeat_min;
6229
0
        }
6230
6231
      /* This code is common to both the zero and non-zero minimum cases. If
6232
      the maximum is limited, it replicates the group in a nested fashion,
6233
      remembering the bracket starts on a stack. In the case of a zero minimum,
6234
      the first one was set up above. In all cases the repeat_max now specifies
6235
      the number of additional copies needed. Again, we must remember to
6236
      replicate entries on the forward reference list. */
6237
6238
0
      if (repeat_max >= 0)
6239
0
        {
6240
        /* In the pre-compile phase, we don't actually do the replication. We
6241
        just adjust the length as if we had. For each repetition we must add 1
6242
        to the length for BRAZERO and for all but the last repetition we must
6243
        add 2 + 2*LINKSIZE to allow for the nesting that occurs. Do some
6244
        paranoid checks to avoid integer overflow. The INT64_OR_DOUBLE type is
6245
        a 64-bit integer type when available, otherwise double. */
6246
6247
0
        if (lengthptr != NULL && repeat_max > 0)
6248
0
          {
6249
0
          int delta = repeat_max * (length_prevgroup + 1 + 2 + 2*LINK_SIZE) -
6250
0
                      2 - 2*LINK_SIZE;   /* Last one doesn't nest */
6251
0
          if ((INT64_OR_DOUBLE)repeat_max *
6252
0
                (INT64_OR_DOUBLE)(length_prevgroup + 1 + 2 + 2*LINK_SIZE)
6253
0
                  > (INT64_OR_DOUBLE)INT_MAX ||
6254
0
              OFLOW_MAX - *lengthptr < delta)
6255
0
            {
6256
0
            *errorcodeptr = ERR20;
6257
0
            goto FAILED;
6258
0
            }
6259
0
          *lengthptr += delta;
6260
0
          }
6261
6262
        /* This is compiling for real */
6263
6264
0
        else for (i = repeat_max - 1; i >= 0; i--)
6265
0
          {
6266
0
          pcre_uchar *hc;
6267
0
          size_t this_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace;
6268
6269
0
          *code++ = OP_BRAZERO + repeat_type;
6270
6271
          /* All but the final copy start a new nesting, maintaining the
6272
          chain of brackets outstanding. */
6273
6274
0
          if (i != 0)
6275
0
            {
6276
0
            int offset;
6277
0
            *code++ = OP_BRA;
6278
0
            offset = (bralink == NULL)? 0 : (int)(code - bralink);
6279
0
            bralink = code;
6280
0
            PUTINC(code, 0, offset);
6281
0
            }
6282
6283
0
          memcpy(code, previous, IN_UCHARS(len));
6284
6285
          /* Ensure there is enough workspace for forward references before
6286
          copying them. */
6287
6288
0
          while (cd->hwm > cd->start_workspace + cd->workspace_size -
6289
0
                 WORK_SIZE_SAFETY_MARGIN -
6290
0
                 (this_hwm_offset - base_hwm_offset))
6291
0
            {
6292
0
            *errorcodeptr = expand_workspace(cd);
6293
0
            if (*errorcodeptr != 0) goto FAILED;
6294
0
            }
6295
6296
0
          for (hc = (pcre_uchar *)cd->start_workspace + base_hwm_offset;
6297
0
               hc < (pcre_uchar *)cd->start_workspace + this_hwm_offset;
6298
0
               hc += LINK_SIZE)
6299
0
            {
6300
0
            PUT(cd->hwm, 0, GET(hc, 0) + len + ((i != 0)? 2+LINK_SIZE : 1));
6301
0
            cd->hwm += LINK_SIZE;
6302
0
            }
6303
0
          base_hwm_offset = this_hwm_offset;
6304
0
          code += len;
6305
0
          }
6306
6307
        /* Now chain through the pending brackets, and fill in their length
6308
        fields (which are holding the chain links pro tem). */
6309
6310
0
        while (bralink != NULL)
6311
0
          {
6312
0
          int oldlinkoffset;
6313
0
          int offset = (int)(code - bralink + 1);
6314
0
          pcre_uchar *bra = code - offset;
6315
0
          oldlinkoffset = GET(bra, 1);
6316
0
          bralink = (oldlinkoffset == 0)? NULL : bralink - oldlinkoffset;
6317
0
          *code++ = OP_KET;
6318
0
          PUTINC(code, 0, offset);
6319
0
          PUT(bra, 1, offset);
6320
0
          }
6321
0
        }
6322
6323
      /* If the maximum is unlimited, set a repeater in the final copy. For
6324
      ONCE brackets, that's all we need to do. However, possessively repeated
6325
      ONCE brackets can be converted into non-capturing brackets, as the
6326
      behaviour of (?:xx)++ is the same as (?>xx)++ and this saves having to
6327
      deal with possessive ONCEs specially.
6328
6329
      Otherwise, when we are doing the actual compile phase, check to see
6330
      whether this group is one that could match an empty string. If so,
6331
      convert the initial operator to the S form (e.g. OP_BRA -> OP_SBRA) so
6332
      that runtime checking can be done. [This check is also applied to ONCE
6333
      groups at runtime, but in a different way.]
6334
6335
      Then, if the quantifier was possessive and the bracket is not a
6336
      conditional, we convert the BRA code to the POS form, and the KET code to
6337
      KETRPOS. (It turns out to be convenient at runtime to detect this kind of
6338
      subpattern at both the start and at the end.) The use of special opcodes
6339
      makes it possible to reduce greatly the stack usage in pcre_exec(). If
6340
      the group is preceded by OP_BRAZERO, convert this to OP_BRAPOSZERO.
6341
6342
      Then, if the minimum number of matches is 1 or 0, cancel the possessive
6343
      flag so that the default action below, of wrapping everything inside
6344
      atomic brackets, does not happen. When the minimum is greater than 1,
6345
      there will be earlier copies of the group, and so we still have to wrap
6346
      the whole thing. */
6347
6348
0
      else
6349
0
        {
6350
0
        pcre_uchar *ketcode = code - 1 - LINK_SIZE;
6351
0
        pcre_uchar *bracode = ketcode - GET(ketcode, 1);
6352
6353
        /* Convert possessive ONCE brackets to non-capturing */
6354
6355
0
        if ((*bracode == OP_ONCE || *bracode == OP_ONCE_NC) &&
6356
0
            possessive_quantifier) *bracode = OP_BRA;
6357
6358
        /* For non-possessive ONCE brackets, all we need to do is to
6359
        set the KET. */
6360
6361
0
        if (*bracode == OP_ONCE || *bracode == OP_ONCE_NC)
6362
0
          *ketcode = OP_KETRMAX + repeat_type;
6363
6364
        /* Handle non-ONCE brackets and possessive ONCEs (which have been
6365
        converted to non-capturing above). */
6366
6367
0
        else
6368
0
          {
6369
          /* In the compile phase, check for empty string matching. */
6370
6371
0
          if (lengthptr == NULL)
6372
0
            {
6373
0
            pcre_uchar *scode = bracode;
6374
0
            do
6375
0
              {
6376
0
              if (could_be_empty_branch(scode, ketcode, utf, cd, NULL))
6377
0
                {
6378
0
                *bracode += OP_SBRA - OP_BRA;
6379
0
                break;
6380
0
                }
6381
0
              scode += GET(scode, 1);
6382
0
              }
6383
0
            while (*scode == OP_ALT);
6384
0
            }
6385
6386
          /* A conditional group with only one branch has an implicit empty
6387
          alternative branch. */
6388
6389
0
          if (*bracode == OP_COND && bracode[GET(bracode,1)] != OP_ALT)
6390
0
            *bracode = OP_SCOND;
6391
6392
          /* Handle possessive quantifiers. */
6393
6394
0
          if (possessive_quantifier)
6395
0
            {
6396
            /* For COND brackets, we wrap the whole thing in a possessively
6397
            repeated non-capturing bracket, because we have not invented POS
6398
            versions of the COND opcodes. Because we are moving code along, we
6399
            must ensure that any pending recursive references are updated. */
6400
6401
0
            if (*bracode == OP_COND || *bracode == OP_SCOND)
6402
0
              {
6403
0
              int nlen = (int)(code - bracode);
6404
0
              *code = OP_END;
6405
0
              adjust_recurse(bracode, 1 + LINK_SIZE, utf, cd, item_hwm_offset);
6406
0
              memmove(bracode + 1 + LINK_SIZE, bracode, IN_UCHARS(nlen));
6407
0
              code += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
6408
0
              nlen += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
6409
0
              *bracode = (*bracode == OP_COND)? OP_BRAPOS : OP_SBRAPOS;
6410
0
              *code++ = OP_KETRPOS;
6411
0
              PUTINC(code, 0, nlen);
6412
0
              PUT(bracode, 1, nlen);
6413
0
              }
6414
6415
            /* For non-COND brackets, we modify the BRA code and use KETRPOS. */
6416
6417
0
            else
6418
0
              {
6419
0
              *bracode += 1;              /* Switch to xxxPOS opcodes */
6420
0
              *ketcode = OP_KETRPOS;
6421
0
              }
6422
6423
            /* If the minimum is zero, mark it as possessive, then unset the
6424
            possessive flag when the minimum is 0 or 1. */
6425
6426
0
            if (brazeroptr != NULL) *brazeroptr = OP_BRAPOSZERO;
6427
0
            if (repeat_min < 2) possessive_quantifier = FALSE;
6428
0
            }
6429
6430
          /* Non-possessive quantifier */
6431
6432
0
          else *ketcode = OP_KETRMAX + repeat_type;
6433
0
          }
6434
0
        }
6435
0
      }
6436
6437
    /* If previous is OP_FAIL, it was generated by an empty class [] in
6438
    JavaScript mode. The other ways in which OP_FAIL can be generated, that is
6439
    by (*FAIL) or (?!) set previous to NULL, which gives a "nothing to repeat"
6440
    error above. We can just ignore the repeat in JS case. */
6441
6442
0
    else if (*previous == OP_FAIL) goto END_REPEAT;
6443
6444
    /* Else there's some kind of shambles */
6445
6446
0
    else
6447
0
      {
6448
0
      *errorcodeptr = ERR11;
6449
0
      goto FAILED;
6450
0
      }
6451
6452
    /* If the character following a repeat is '+', possessive_quantifier is
6453
    TRUE. For some opcodes, there are special alternative opcodes for this
6454
    case. For anything else, we wrap the entire repeated item inside OP_ONCE
6455
    brackets. Logically, the '+' notation is just syntactic sugar, taken from
6456
    Sun's Java package, but the special opcodes can optimize it.
6457
6458
    Some (but not all) possessively repeated subpatterns have already been
6459
    completely handled in the code just above. For them, possessive_quantifier
6460
    is always FALSE at this stage. Note that the repeated item starts at
6461
    tempcode, not at previous, which might be the first part of a string whose
6462
    (former) last char we repeated. */
6463
6464
0
    if (possessive_quantifier)
6465
0
      {
6466
0
      int len;
6467
6468
      /* Possessifying an EXACT quantifier has no effect, so we can ignore it.
6469
      However, QUERY, STAR, or UPTO may follow (for quantifiers such as {5,6},
6470
      {5,}, or {5,10}). We skip over an EXACT item; if the length of what
6471
      remains is greater than zero, there's a further opcode that can be
6472
      handled. If not, do nothing, leaving the EXACT alone. */
6473
6474
0
      switch(*tempcode)
6475
0
        {
6476
0
        case OP_TYPEEXACT:
6477
0
        tempcode += PRIV(OP_lengths)[*tempcode] +
6478
0
          ((tempcode[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_PROP
6479
0
          || tempcode[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_NOTPROP)? 2 : 0);
6480
0
        break;
6481
6482
        /* CHAR opcodes are used for exacts whose count is 1. */
6483
6484
0
        case OP_CHAR:
6485
0
        case OP_CHARI:
6486
0
        case OP_NOT:
6487
0
        case OP_NOTI:
6488
0
        case OP_EXACT:
6489
0
        case OP_EXACTI:
6490
0
        case OP_NOTEXACT:
6491
0
        case OP_NOTEXACTI:
6492
0
        tempcode += PRIV(OP_lengths)[*tempcode];
6493
#ifdef SUPPORT_UTF
6494
        if (utf && HAS_EXTRALEN(tempcode[-1]))
6495
          tempcode += GET_EXTRALEN(tempcode[-1]);
6496
#endif
6497
0
        break;
6498
6499
        /* For the class opcodes, the repeat operator appears at the end;
6500
        adjust tempcode to point to it. */
6501
6502
0
        case OP_CLASS:
6503
0
        case OP_NCLASS:
6504
0
        tempcode += 1 + 32/sizeof(pcre_uchar);
6505
0
        break;
6506
6507
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
6508
        case OP_XCLASS:
6509
        tempcode += GET(tempcode, 1);
6510
        break;
6511
#endif
6512
0
        }
6513
6514
      /* If tempcode is equal to code (which points to the end of the repeated
6515
      item), it means we have skipped an EXACT item but there is no following
6516
      QUERY, STAR, or UPTO; the value of len will be 0, and we do nothing. In
6517
      all other cases, tempcode will be pointing to the repeat opcode, and will
6518
      be less than code, so the value of len will be greater than 0. */
6519
6520
0
      len = (int)(code - tempcode);
6521
0
      if (len > 0)
6522
0
        {
6523
0
        unsigned int repcode = *tempcode;
6524
6525
        /* There is a table for possessifying opcodes, all of which are less
6526
        than OP_CALLOUT. A zero entry means there is no possessified version.
6527
        */
6528
6529
0
        if (repcode < OP_CALLOUT && opcode_possessify[repcode] > 0)
6530
0
          *tempcode = opcode_possessify[repcode];
6531
6532
        /* For opcode without a special possessified version, wrap the item in
6533
        ONCE brackets. Because we are moving code along, we must ensure that any
6534
        pending recursive references are updated. */
6535
6536
0
        else
6537
0
          {
6538
0
          *code = OP_END;
6539
0
          adjust_recurse(tempcode, 1 + LINK_SIZE, utf, cd, item_hwm_offset);
6540
0
          memmove(tempcode + 1 + LINK_SIZE, tempcode, IN_UCHARS(len));
6541
0
          code += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
6542
0
          len += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
6543
0
          tempcode[0] = OP_ONCE;
6544
0
          *code++ = OP_KET;
6545
0
          PUTINC(code, 0, len);
6546
0
          PUT(tempcode, 1, len);
6547
0
          }
6548
0
        }
6549
6550
#ifdef NEVER
6551
      if (len > 0) switch (*tempcode)
6552
        {
6553
        case OP_STAR:  *tempcode = OP_POSSTAR; break;
6554
        case OP_PLUS:  *tempcode = OP_POSPLUS; break;
6555
        case OP_QUERY: *tempcode = OP_POSQUERY; break;
6556
        case OP_UPTO:  *tempcode = OP_POSUPTO; break;
6557
6558
        case OP_STARI:  *tempcode = OP_POSSTARI; break;
6559
        case OP_PLUSI:  *tempcode = OP_POSPLUSI; break;
6560
        case OP_QUERYI: *tempcode = OP_POSQUERYI; break;
6561
        case OP_UPTOI:  *tempcode = OP_POSUPTOI; break;
6562
6563
        case OP_NOTSTAR:  *tempcode = OP_NOTPOSSTAR; break;
6564
        case OP_NOTPLUS:  *tempcode = OP_NOTPOSPLUS; break;
6565
        case OP_NOTQUERY: *tempcode = OP_NOTPOSQUERY; break;
6566
        case OP_NOTUPTO:  *tempcode = OP_NOTPOSUPTO; break;
6567
6568
        case OP_NOTSTARI:  *tempcode = OP_NOTPOSSTARI; break;
6569
        case OP_NOTPLUSI:  *tempcode = OP_NOTPOSPLUSI; break;
6570
        case OP_NOTQUERYI: *tempcode = OP_NOTPOSQUERYI; break;
6571
        case OP_NOTUPTOI:  *tempcode = OP_NOTPOSUPTOI; break;
6572
6573
        case OP_TYPESTAR:  *tempcode = OP_TYPEPOSSTAR; break;
6574
        case OP_TYPEPLUS:  *tempcode = OP_TYPEPOSPLUS; break;
6575
        case OP_TYPEQUERY: *tempcode = OP_TYPEPOSQUERY; break;
6576
        case OP_TYPEUPTO:  *tempcode = OP_TYPEPOSUPTO; break;
6577
6578
        case OP_CRSTAR:   *tempcode = OP_CRPOSSTAR; break;
6579
        case OP_CRPLUS:   *tempcode = OP_CRPOSPLUS; break;
6580
        case OP_CRQUERY:  *tempcode = OP_CRPOSQUERY; break;
6581
        case OP_CRRANGE:  *tempcode = OP_CRPOSRANGE; break;
6582
6583
        /* Because we are moving code along, we must ensure that any
6584
        pending recursive references are updated. */
6585
6586
        default:
6587
        *code = OP_END;
6588
        adjust_recurse(tempcode, 1 + LINK_SIZE, utf, cd, item_hwm_offset);
6589
        memmove(tempcode + 1 + LINK_SIZE, tempcode, IN_UCHARS(len));
6590
        code += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
6591
        len += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
6592
        tempcode[0] = OP_ONCE;
6593
        *code++ = OP_KET;
6594
        PUTINC(code, 0, len);
6595
        PUT(tempcode, 1, len);
6596
        break;
6597
        }
6598
#endif
6599
0
      }
6600
6601
    /* In all case we no longer have a previous item. We also set the
6602
    "follows varying string" flag for subsequently encountered reqchars if
6603
    it isn't already set and we have just passed a varying length item. */
6604
6605
0
    END_REPEAT:
6606
0
    previous = NULL;
6607
0
    cd->req_varyopt |= reqvary;
6608
0
    break;
6609
6610
6611
    /* ===================================================================*/
6612
    /* Start of nested parenthesized sub-expression, or comment or lookahead or
6613
    lookbehind or option setting or condition or all the other extended
6614
    parenthesis forms.  */
6615
6616
0
    case CHAR_LEFT_PARENTHESIS:
6617
0
    ptr++;
6618
6619
    /* Now deal with various "verbs" that can be introduced by '*'. */
6620
6621
0
    if (ptr[0] == CHAR_ASTERISK && (ptr[1] == ':'
6622
0
         || (MAX_255(ptr[1]) && ((cd->ctypes[ptr[1]] & ctype_letter) != 0))))
6623
0
      {
6624
0
      int i, namelen;
6625
0
      int arglen = 0;
6626
0
      const char *vn = verbnames;
6627
0
      const pcre_uchar *name = ptr + 1;
6628
0
      const pcre_uchar *arg = NULL;
6629
0
      previous = NULL;
6630
0
      ptr++;
6631
0
      while (MAX_255(*ptr) && (cd->ctypes[*ptr] & ctype_letter) != 0) ptr++;
6632
0
      namelen = (int)(ptr - name);
6633
6634
      /* It appears that Perl allows any characters whatsoever, other than
6635
      a closing parenthesis, to appear in arguments, so we no longer insist on
6636
      letters, digits, and underscores. */
6637
6638
0
      if (*ptr == CHAR_COLON)
6639
0
        {
6640
0
        arg = ++ptr;
6641
0
        while (*ptr != CHAR_NULL && *ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS) ptr++;
6642
0
        arglen = (int)(ptr - arg);
6643
0
        if ((unsigned int)arglen > MAX_MARK)
6644
0
          {
6645
0
          *errorcodeptr = ERR75;
6646
0
          goto FAILED;
6647
0
          }
6648
0
        }
6649
6650
0
      if (*ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS)
6651
0
        {
6652
0
        *errorcodeptr = ERR60;
6653
0
        goto FAILED;
6654
0
        }
6655
6656
      /* Scan the table of verb names */
6657
6658
0
      for (i = 0; i < verbcount; i++)
6659
0
        {
6660
0
        if (namelen == verbs[i].len &&
6661
0
            STRNCMP_UC_C8(name, vn, namelen) == 0)
6662
0
          {
6663
0
          int setverb;
6664
6665
          /* Check for open captures before ACCEPT and convert it to
6666
          ASSERT_ACCEPT if in an assertion. */
6667
6668
0
          if (verbs[i].op == OP_ACCEPT)
6669
0
            {
6670
0
            open_capitem *oc;
6671
0
            if (arglen != 0)
6672
0
              {
6673
0
              *errorcodeptr = ERR59;
6674
0
              goto FAILED;
6675
0
              }
6676
0
            cd->had_accept = TRUE;
6677
0
            for (oc = cd->open_caps; oc != NULL; oc = oc->next)
6678
0
              {
6679
0
              if (lengthptr != NULL)
6680
0
                {
6681
0
#ifdef COMPILE_PCRE8
6682
0
                *lengthptr += 1 + IMM2_SIZE;
6683
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16
6684
                *lengthptr += 2 + IMM2_SIZE;
6685
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32
6686
                *lengthptr += 4 + IMM2_SIZE;
6687
#endif
6688
0
                }
6689
0
              else
6690
0
                {
6691
0
                *code++ = OP_CLOSE;
6692
0
                PUT2INC(code, 0, oc->number);
6693
0
                }
6694
0
              }
6695
0
            setverb = *code++ =
6696
0
              (cd->assert_depth > 0)? OP_ASSERT_ACCEPT : OP_ACCEPT;
6697
6698
            /* Do not set firstchar after *ACCEPT */
6699
0
            if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcharflags = REQ_NONE;
6700
0
            }
6701
6702
          /* Handle other cases with/without an argument */
6703
6704
0
          else if (arglen == 0)
6705
0
            {
6706
0
            if (verbs[i].op < 0)   /* Argument is mandatory */
6707
0
              {
6708
0
              *errorcodeptr = ERR66;
6709
0
              goto FAILED;
6710
0
              }
6711
0
            setverb = *code++ = verbs[i].op;
6712
0
            }
6713
6714
0
          else
6715
0
            {
6716
0
            if (verbs[i].op_arg < 0)   /* Argument is forbidden */
6717
0
              {
6718
0
              *errorcodeptr = ERR59;
6719
0
              goto FAILED;
6720
0
              }
6721
0
            setverb = *code++ = verbs[i].op_arg;
6722
0
            if (lengthptr != NULL)    /* In pass 1 just add in the length */
6723
0
              {                       /* to avoid potential workspace */
6724
0
              *lengthptr += arglen;   /* overflow. */
6725
0
              *code++ = 0;
6726
0
              }
6727
0
            else
6728
0
              {
6729
0
              *code++ = arglen;
6730
0
              memcpy(code, arg, IN_UCHARS(arglen));
6731
0
              code += arglen;
6732
0
              }
6733
0
            *code++ = 0;
6734
0
            }
6735
6736
0
          switch (setverb)
6737
0
            {
6738
0
            case OP_THEN:
6739
0
            case OP_THEN_ARG:
6740
0
            cd->external_flags |= PCRE_HASTHEN;
6741
0
            break;
6742
6743
0
            case OP_PRUNE:
6744
0
            case OP_PRUNE_ARG:
6745
0
            case OP_SKIP:
6746
0
            case OP_SKIP_ARG:
6747
0
            cd->had_pruneorskip = TRUE;
6748
0
            break;
6749
0
            }
6750
6751
0
          break;  /* Found verb, exit loop */
6752
0
          }
6753
6754
0
        vn += verbs[i].len + 1;
6755
0
        }
6756
6757
0
      if (i < verbcount) continue;    /* Successfully handled a verb */
6758
0
      *errorcodeptr = ERR60;          /* Verb not recognized */
6759
0
      goto FAILED;
6760
0
      }
6761
6762
    /* Initialize for "real" parentheses */
6763
6764
0
    newoptions = options;
6765
0
    skipbytes = 0;
6766
0
    bravalue = OP_CBRA;
6767
0
    item_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace;
6768
0
    reset_bracount = FALSE;
6769
6770
    /* Deal with the extended parentheses; all are introduced by '?', and the
6771
    appearance of any of them means that this is not a capturing group. */
6772
6773
0
    if (*ptr == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK)
6774
0
      {
6775
0
      int i, set, unset, namelen;
6776
0
      int *optset;
6777
0
      const pcre_uchar *name;
6778
0
      pcre_uchar *slot;
6779
6780
0
      switch (*(++ptr))
6781
0
        {
6782
        /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */
6783
0
        case CHAR_VERTICAL_LINE:  /* Reset capture count for each branch */
6784
0
        reset_bracount = TRUE;
6785
0
        cd->dupgroups = TRUE;     /* Record (?| encountered */
6786
        /* Fall through */
6787
6788
        /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */
6789
0
        case CHAR_COLON:          /* Non-capturing bracket */
6790
0
        bravalue = OP_BRA;
6791
0
        ptr++;
6792
0
        break;
6793
6794
6795
        /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */
6796
0
        case CHAR_LEFT_PARENTHESIS:
6797
0
        bravalue = OP_COND;       /* Conditional group */
6798
0
        tempptr = ptr;
6799
6800
        /* A condition can be an assertion, a number (referring to a numbered
6801
        group's having been set), a name (referring to a named group), or 'R',
6802
        referring to recursion. R<digits> and R&name are also permitted for
6803
        recursion tests.
6804
6805
        There are ways of testing a named group: (?(name)) is used by Python;
6806
        Perl 5.10 onwards uses (?(<name>) or (?('name')).
6807
6808
        There is one unfortunate ambiguity, caused by history. 'R' can be the
6809
        recursive thing or the name 'R' (and similarly for 'R' followed by
6810
        digits). We look for a name first; if not found, we try the other case.
6811
6812
        For compatibility with auto-callouts, we allow a callout to be
6813
        specified before a condition that is an assertion. First, check for the
6814
        syntax of a callout; if found, adjust the temporary pointer that is
6815
        used to check for an assertion condition. That's all that is needed! */
6816
6817
0
        if (ptr[1] == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK && ptr[2] == CHAR_C)
6818
0
          {
6819
0
          for (i = 3;; i++) if (!IS_DIGIT(ptr[i])) break;
6820
0
          if (ptr[i] == CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS)
6821
0
            tempptr += i + 1;
6822
6823
          /* tempptr should now be pointing to the opening parenthesis of the
6824
          assertion condition. */
6825
6826
0
          if (*tempptr != CHAR_LEFT_PARENTHESIS)
6827
0
            {
6828
0
            *errorcodeptr = ERR28;
6829
0
            goto FAILED;
6830
0
            }
6831
0
          }
6832
6833
        /* For conditions that are assertions, check the syntax, and then exit
6834
        the switch. This will take control down to where bracketed groups,
6835
        including assertions, are processed. */
6836
6837
0
        if (tempptr[1] == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK &&
6838
0
              (tempptr[2] == CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN ||
6839
0
               tempptr[2] == CHAR_EXCLAMATION_MARK ||
6840
0
                 (tempptr[2] == CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN &&
6841
0
                   (tempptr[3] == CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN ||
6842
0
                    tempptr[3] == CHAR_EXCLAMATION_MARK))))
6843
0
          {
6844
0
          cd->iscondassert = TRUE;
6845
0
          break;
6846
0
          }
6847
6848
        /* Other conditions use OP_CREF/OP_DNCREF/OP_RREF/OP_DNRREF, and all
6849
        need to skip at least 1+IMM2_SIZE bytes at the start of the group. */
6850
6851
0
        code[1+LINK_SIZE] = OP_CREF;
6852
0
        skipbytes = 1+IMM2_SIZE;
6853
0
        refsign = -1;     /* => not a number */
6854
0
        namelen = -1;     /* => not a name; must set to avoid warning */
6855
0
        name = NULL;      /* Always set to avoid warning */
6856
0
        recno = 0;        /* Always set to avoid warning */
6857
6858
        /* Check for a test for recursion in a named group. */
6859
6860
0
        ptr++;
6861
0
        if (*ptr == CHAR_R && ptr[1] == CHAR_AMPERSAND)
6862
0
          {
6863
0
          terminator = -1;
6864
0
          ptr += 2;
6865
0
          code[1+LINK_SIZE] = OP_RREF;    /* Change the type of test */
6866
0
          }
6867
6868
        /* Check for a test for a named group's having been set, using the Perl
6869
        syntax (?(<name>) or (?('name'), and also allow for the original PCRE
6870
        syntax of (?(name) or for (?(+n), (?(-n), and just (?(n). */
6871
6872
0
        else if (*ptr == CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN)
6873
0
          {
6874
0
          terminator = CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN;
6875
0
          ptr++;
6876
0
          }
6877
0
        else if (*ptr == CHAR_APOSTROPHE)
6878
0
          {
6879
0
          terminator = CHAR_APOSTROPHE;
6880
0
          ptr++;
6881
0
          }
6882
0
        else
6883
0
          {
6884
0
          terminator = CHAR_NULL;
6885
0
          if (*ptr == CHAR_MINUS || *ptr == CHAR_PLUS) refsign = *ptr++;
6886
0
            else if (IS_DIGIT(*ptr)) refsign = 0;
6887
0
          }
6888
6889
        /* Handle a number */
6890
6891
0
        if (refsign >= 0)
6892
0
          {
6893
0
          while (IS_DIGIT(*ptr))
6894
0
            {
6895
0
            if (recno > INT_MAX / 10 - 1)  /* Integer overflow */
6896
0
              {
6897
0
              while (IS_DIGIT(*ptr)) ptr++;
6898
0
              *errorcodeptr = ERR61;
6899
0
              goto FAILED;
6900
0
              }
6901
0
            recno = recno * 10 + (int)(*ptr - CHAR_0);
6902
0
            ptr++;
6903
0
            }
6904
0
          }
6905
6906
        /* Otherwise we expect to read a name; anything else is an error. When
6907
        a name is one of a number of duplicates, a different opcode is used and
6908
        it needs more memory. Unfortunately we cannot tell whether a name is a
6909
        duplicate in the first pass, so we have to allow for more memory. */
6910
6911
0
        else
6912
0
          {
6913
0
          if (IS_DIGIT(*ptr))
6914
0
            {
6915
0
            *errorcodeptr = ERR84;
6916
0
            goto FAILED;
6917
0
            }
6918
0
          if (!MAX_255(*ptr) || (cd->ctypes[*ptr] & ctype_word) == 0)
6919
0
            {
6920
0
            *errorcodeptr = ERR28;   /* Assertion expected */
6921
0
            goto FAILED;
6922
0
            }
6923
0
          name = ptr++;
6924
0
          while (MAX_255(*ptr) && (cd->ctypes[*ptr] & ctype_word) != 0)
6925
0
            {
6926
0
            ptr++;
6927
0
            }
6928
0
          namelen = (int)(ptr - name);
6929
0
          if (lengthptr != NULL) skipbytes += IMM2_SIZE;
6930
0
          }
6931
6932
        /* Check the terminator */
6933
6934
0
        if ((terminator > 0 && *ptr++ != (pcre_uchar)terminator) ||
6935
0
            *ptr++ != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS)
6936
0
          {
6937
0
          ptr--;                  /* Error offset */
6938
0
          *errorcodeptr = ERR26;  /* Malformed number or name */
6939
0
          goto FAILED;
6940
0
          }
6941
6942
        /* Do no further checking in the pre-compile phase. */
6943
6944
0
        if (lengthptr != NULL) break;
6945
6946
        /* In the real compile we do the work of looking for the actual
6947
        reference. If refsign is not negative, it means we have a number in
6948
        recno. */
6949
6950
0
        if (refsign >= 0)
6951
0
          {
6952
0
          if (recno <= 0)
6953
0
            {
6954
0
            *errorcodeptr = ERR35;
6955
0
            goto FAILED;
6956
0
            }
6957
0
          if (refsign != 0) recno = (refsign == CHAR_MINUS)?
6958
0
            cd->bracount - recno + 1 : recno + cd->bracount;
6959
0
          if (recno <= 0 || recno > cd->final_bracount)
6960
0
            {
6961
0
            *errorcodeptr = ERR15;
6962
0
            goto FAILED;
6963
0
            }
6964
0
          PUT2(code, 2+LINK_SIZE, recno);
6965
0
          if (recno > cd->top_backref) cd->top_backref = recno;
6966
0
          break;
6967
0
          }
6968
6969
        /* Otherwise look for the name. */
6970
6971
0
        slot = cd->name_table;
6972
0
        for (i = 0; i < cd->names_found; i++)
6973
0
          {
6974
0
          if (STRNCMP_UC_UC(name, slot+IMM2_SIZE, namelen) == 0 &&
6975
0
            slot[IMM2_SIZE+namelen] == 0) break;
6976
0
          slot += cd->name_entry_size;
6977
0
          }
6978
6979
        /* Found the named subpattern. If the name is duplicated, add one to
6980
        the opcode to change CREF/RREF into DNCREF/DNRREF and insert
6981
        appropriate data values. Otherwise, just insert the unique subpattern
6982
        number. */
6983
6984
0
        if (i < cd->names_found)
6985
0
          {
6986
0
          int offset = i++;
6987
0
          int count = 1;
6988
0
          recno = GET2(slot, 0);   /* Number from first found */
6989
0
          if (recno > cd->top_backref) cd->top_backref = recno;
6990
0
          for (; i < cd->names_found; i++)
6991
0
            {
6992
0
            slot += cd->name_entry_size;
6993
0
            if (STRNCMP_UC_UC(name, slot+IMM2_SIZE, namelen) != 0 ||
6994
0
              (slot+IMM2_SIZE)[namelen] != 0) break;
6995
0
            count++;
6996
0
            }
6997
6998
0
          if (count > 1)
6999
0
            {
7000
0
            PUT2(code, 2+LINK_SIZE, offset);
7001
0
            PUT2(code, 2+LINK_SIZE+IMM2_SIZE, count);
7002
0
            skipbytes += IMM2_SIZE;
7003
0
            code[1+LINK_SIZE]++;
7004
0
            }
7005
0
          else  /* Not a duplicated name */
7006
0
            {
7007
0
            PUT2(code, 2+LINK_SIZE, recno);
7008
0
            }
7009
0
          }
7010
7011
        /* If terminator == CHAR_NULL it means that the name followed directly
7012
        after the opening parenthesis [e.g. (?(abc)...] and in this case there
7013
        are some further alternatives to try. For the cases where terminator !=
7014
        CHAR_NULL [things like (?(<name>... or (?('name')... or (?(R&name)... ]
7015
        we have now checked all the possibilities, so give an error. */
7016
7017
0
        else if (terminator != CHAR_NULL)
7018
0
          {
7019
0
          *errorcodeptr = ERR15;
7020
0
          goto FAILED;
7021
0
          }
7022
7023
        /* Check for (?(R) for recursion. Allow digits after R to specify a
7024
        specific group number. */
7025
7026
0
        else if (*name == CHAR_R)
7027
0
          {
7028
0
          recno = 0;
7029
0
          for (i = 1; i < namelen; i++)
7030
0
            {
7031
0
            if (!IS_DIGIT(name[i]))
7032
0
              {
7033
0
              *errorcodeptr = ERR15;
7034
0
              goto FAILED;
7035
0
              }
7036
0
            if (recno > INT_MAX / 10 - 1)   /* Integer overflow */
7037
0
              {
7038
0
              *errorcodeptr = ERR61;
7039
0
              goto FAILED;
7040
0
              }
7041
0
            recno = recno * 10 + name[i] - CHAR_0;
7042
0
            }
7043
0
          if (recno == 0) recno = RREF_ANY;
7044
0
          code[1+LINK_SIZE] = OP_RREF;      /* Change test type */
7045
0
          PUT2(code, 2+LINK_SIZE, recno);
7046
0
          }
7047
7048
        /* Similarly, check for the (?(DEFINE) "condition", which is always
7049
        false. */
7050
7051
0
        else if (namelen == 6 && STRNCMP_UC_C8(name, STRING_DEFINE, 6) == 0)
7052
0
          {
7053
0
          code[1+LINK_SIZE] = OP_DEF;
7054
0
          skipbytes = 1;
7055
0
          }
7056
7057
        /* Reference to an unidentified subpattern. */
7058
7059
0
        else
7060
0
          {
7061
0
          *errorcodeptr = ERR15;
7062
0
          goto FAILED;
7063
0
          }
7064
0
        break;
7065
7066
7067
        /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */
7068
0
        case CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN:                 /* Positive lookahead */
7069
0
        bravalue = OP_ASSERT;
7070
0
        cd->assert_depth += 1;
7071
0
        ptr++;
7072
0
        break;
7073
7074
        /* Optimize (?!) to (*FAIL) unless it is quantified - which is a weird
7075
        thing to do, but Perl allows all assertions to be quantified, and when
7076
        they contain capturing parentheses there may be a potential use for
7077
        this feature. Not that that applies to a quantified (?!) but we allow
7078
        it for uniformity. */
7079
7080
        /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */
7081
0
        case CHAR_EXCLAMATION_MARK:            /* Negative lookahead */
7082
0
        ptr++;
7083
0
        if (*ptr == CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS && ptr[1] != CHAR_ASTERISK &&
7084
0
             ptr[1] != CHAR_PLUS && ptr[1] != CHAR_QUESTION_MARK &&
7085
0
            (ptr[1] != CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET || !is_counted_repeat(ptr+2)))
7086
0
          {
7087
0
          *code++ = OP_FAIL;
7088
0
          previous = NULL;
7089
0
          continue;
7090
0
          }
7091
0
        bravalue = OP_ASSERT_NOT;
7092
0
        cd->assert_depth += 1;
7093
0
        break;
7094
7095
7096
        /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */
7097
0
        case CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN:              /* Lookbehind or named define */
7098
0
        switch (ptr[1])
7099
0
          {
7100
0
          case CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN:               /* Positive lookbehind */
7101
0
          bravalue = OP_ASSERTBACK;
7102
0
          cd->assert_depth += 1;
7103
0
          ptr += 2;
7104
0
          break;
7105
7106
0
          case CHAR_EXCLAMATION_MARK:          /* Negative lookbehind */
7107
0
          bravalue = OP_ASSERTBACK_NOT;
7108
0
          cd->assert_depth += 1;
7109
0
          ptr += 2;
7110
0
          break;
7111
7112
0
          default:                /* Could be name define, else bad */
7113
0
          if (MAX_255(ptr[1]) && (cd->ctypes[ptr[1]] & ctype_word) != 0)
7114
0
            goto DEFINE_NAME;
7115
0
          ptr++;                  /* Correct offset for error */
7116
0
          *errorcodeptr = ERR24;
7117
0
          goto FAILED;
7118
0
          }
7119
0
        break;
7120
7121
7122
        /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */
7123
0
        case CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN:           /* One-time brackets */
7124
0
        bravalue = OP_ONCE;
7125
0
        ptr++;
7126
0
        break;
7127
7128
7129
        /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */
7130
0
        case CHAR_C:                 /* Callout - may be followed by digits; */
7131
0
        previous_callout = code;     /* Save for later completion */
7132
0
        after_manual_callout = 1;    /* Skip one item before completing */
7133
0
        *code++ = OP_CALLOUT;
7134
0
          {
7135
0
          int n = 0;
7136
0
          ptr++;
7137
0
          while(IS_DIGIT(*ptr))
7138
0
            {
7139
0
            n = n * 10 + *ptr++ - CHAR_0;
7140
0
            if (n > 255)
7141
0
              {
7142
0
              *errorcodeptr = ERR38;
7143
0
              goto FAILED;
7144
0
              }
7145
0
            }
7146
0
          if (*ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS)
7147
0
            {
7148
0
            *errorcodeptr = ERR39;
7149
0
            goto FAILED;
7150
0
            }
7151
0
          *code++ = n;
7152
0
          PUT(code, 0, (int)(ptr - cd->start_pattern + 1)); /* Pattern offset */
7153
0
          PUT(code, LINK_SIZE, 0);                          /* Default length */
7154
0
          code += 2 * LINK_SIZE;
7155
0
          }
7156
0
        previous = NULL;
7157
0
        continue;
7158
7159
7160
        /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */
7161
0
        case CHAR_P:              /* Python-style named subpattern handling */
7162
0
        if (*(++ptr) == CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN ||
7163
0
            *ptr == CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN)  /* Reference or recursion */
7164
0
          {
7165
0
          is_recurse = *ptr == CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN;
7166
0
          terminator = CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS;
7167
0
          goto NAMED_REF_OR_RECURSE;
7168
0
          }
7169
0
        else if (*ptr != CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN)  /* Test for Python-style defn */
7170
0
          {
7171
0
          *errorcodeptr = ERR41;
7172
0
          goto FAILED;
7173
0
          }
7174
        /* Fall through to handle (?P< as (?< is handled */
7175
7176
7177
        /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */
7178
0
        DEFINE_NAME:    /* Come here from (?< handling */
7179
0
        case CHAR_APOSTROPHE:
7180
0
        terminator = (*ptr == CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN)?
7181
0
          CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN : CHAR_APOSTROPHE;
7182
0
        name = ++ptr;
7183
0
        if (IS_DIGIT(*ptr))
7184
0
          {
7185
0
          *errorcodeptr = ERR84;   /* Group name must start with non-digit */
7186
0
          goto FAILED;
7187
0
          }
7188
0
        while (MAX_255(*ptr) && (cd->ctypes[*ptr] & ctype_word) != 0) ptr++;
7189
0
        namelen = (int)(ptr - name);
7190
7191
        /* In the pre-compile phase, do a syntax check, remember the longest
7192
        name, and then remember the group in a vector, expanding it if
7193
        necessary. Duplicates for the same number are skipped; other duplicates
7194
        are checked for validity. In the actual compile, there is nothing to
7195
        do. */
7196
7197
0
        if (lengthptr != NULL)
7198
0
          {
7199
0
          named_group *ng;
7200
0
          pcre_uint32 number = cd->bracount + 1;
7201
7202
0
          if (*ptr != (pcre_uchar)terminator)
7203
0
            {
7204
0
            *errorcodeptr = ERR42;
7205
0
            goto FAILED;
7206
0
            }
7207
7208
0
          if (cd->names_found >= MAX_NAME_COUNT)
7209
0
            {
7210
0
            *errorcodeptr = ERR49;
7211
0
            goto FAILED;
7212
0
            }
7213
7214
0
          if (namelen + IMM2_SIZE + 1 > cd->name_entry_size)
7215
0
            {
7216
0
            cd->name_entry_size = namelen + IMM2_SIZE + 1;
7217
0
            if (namelen > MAX_NAME_SIZE)
7218
0
              {
7219
0
              *errorcodeptr = ERR48;
7220
0
              goto FAILED;
7221
0
              }
7222
0
            }
7223
7224
          /* Scan the list to check for duplicates. For duplicate names, if the
7225
          number is the same, break the loop, which causes the name to be
7226
          discarded; otherwise, if DUPNAMES is not set, give an error.
7227
          If it is set, allow the name with a different number, but continue
7228
          scanning in case this is a duplicate with the same number. For
7229
          non-duplicate names, give an error if the number is duplicated. */
7230
7231
0
          ng = cd->named_groups;
7232
0
          for (i = 0; i < cd->names_found; i++, ng++)
7233
0
            {
7234
0
            if (namelen == ng->length &&
7235
0
                STRNCMP_UC_UC(name, ng->name, namelen) == 0)
7236
0
              {
7237
0
              if (ng->number == number) break;
7238
0
              if ((options & PCRE_DUPNAMES) == 0)
7239
0
                {
7240
0
                *errorcodeptr = ERR43;
7241
0
                goto FAILED;
7242
0
                }
7243
0
              cd->dupnames = TRUE;  /* Duplicate names exist */
7244
0
              }
7245
0
            else if (ng->number == number)
7246
0
              {
7247
0
              *errorcodeptr = ERR65;
7248
0
              goto FAILED;
7249
0
              }
7250
0
            }
7251
7252
0
          if (i >= cd->names_found)     /* Not a duplicate with same number */
7253
0
            {
7254
            /* Increase the list size if necessary */
7255
7256
0
            if (cd->names_found >= cd->named_group_list_size)
7257
0
              {
7258
0
              int newsize = cd->named_group_list_size * 2;
7259
0
              named_group *newspace = (PUBL(malloc))
7260
0
                (newsize * sizeof(named_group));
7261
7262
0
              if (newspace == NULL)
7263
0
                {
7264
0
                *errorcodeptr = ERR21;
7265
0
                goto FAILED;
7266
0
                }
7267
7268
0
              memcpy(newspace, cd->named_groups,
7269
0
                cd->named_group_list_size * sizeof(named_group));
7270
0
              if (cd->named_group_list_size > NAMED_GROUP_LIST_SIZE)
7271
0
                (PUBL(free))((void *)cd->named_groups);
7272
0
              cd->named_groups = newspace;
7273
0
              cd->named_group_list_size = newsize;
7274
0
              }
7275
7276
0
            cd->named_groups[cd->names_found].name = name;
7277
0
            cd->named_groups[cd->names_found].length = namelen;
7278
0
            cd->named_groups[cd->names_found].number = number;
7279
0
            cd->names_found++;
7280
0
            }
7281
0
          }
7282
7283
0
        ptr++;                    /* Move past > or ' in both passes. */
7284
0
        goto NUMBERED_GROUP;
7285
7286
7287
        /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */
7288
0
        case CHAR_AMPERSAND:            /* Perl recursion/subroutine syntax */
7289
0
        terminator = CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS;
7290
0
        is_recurse = TRUE;
7291
        /* Fall through */
7292
7293
        /* We come here from the Python syntax above that handles both
7294
        references (?P=name) and recursion (?P>name), as well as falling
7295
        through from the Perl recursion syntax (?&name). We also come here from
7296
        the Perl \k<name> or \k'name' back reference syntax and the \k{name}
7297
        .NET syntax, and the Oniguruma \g<...> and \g'...' subroutine syntax. */
7298
7299
0
        NAMED_REF_OR_RECURSE:
7300
0
        name = ++ptr;
7301
0
        if (IS_DIGIT(*ptr))
7302
0
          {
7303
0
          *errorcodeptr = ERR84;   /* Group name must start with non-digit */
7304
0
          goto FAILED;
7305
0
          }
7306
0
        while (MAX_255(*ptr) && (cd->ctypes[*ptr] & ctype_word) != 0) ptr++;
7307
0
        namelen = (int)(ptr - name);
7308
7309
        /* In the pre-compile phase, do a syntax check. We used to just set
7310
        a dummy reference number, because it was not used in the first pass.
7311
        However, with the change of recursive back references to be atomic,
7312
        we have to look for the number so that this state can be identified, as
7313
        otherwise the incorrect length is computed. If it's not a backwards
7314
        reference, the dummy number will do. */
7315
7316
0
        if (lengthptr != NULL)
7317
0
          {
7318
0
          named_group *ng;
7319
0
          recno = 0;
7320
7321
0
          if (namelen == 0)
7322
0
            {
7323
0
            *errorcodeptr = ERR62;
7324
0
            goto FAILED;
7325
0
            }
7326
0
          if (*ptr != (pcre_uchar)terminator)
7327
0
            {
7328
0
            *errorcodeptr = ERR42;
7329
0
            goto FAILED;
7330
0
            }
7331
0
          if (namelen > MAX_NAME_SIZE)
7332
0
            {
7333
0
            *errorcodeptr = ERR48;
7334
0
            goto FAILED;
7335
0
            }
7336
7337
          /* Count named back references. */
7338
7339
0
          if (!is_recurse) cd->namedrefcount++;
7340
7341
          /* We have to allow for a named reference to a duplicated name (this
7342
          cannot be determined until the second pass). This needs an extra
7343
          16-bit data item. */
7344
7345
0
          *lengthptr += IMM2_SIZE;
7346
7347
          /* If this is a forward reference and we are within a (?|...) group,
7348
          the reference may end up as the number of a group which we are
7349
          currently inside, that is, it could be a recursive reference. In the
7350
          real compile this will be picked up and the reference wrapped with
7351
          OP_ONCE to make it atomic, so we must space in case this occurs. */
7352
7353
          /* In fact, this can happen for a non-forward reference because
7354
          another group with the same number might be created later. This
7355
          issue is fixed "properly" in PCRE2. As PCRE1 is now in maintenance
7356
          only mode, we finesse the bug by allowing more memory always. */
7357
7358
0
          *lengthptr += 4 + 4*LINK_SIZE;
7359
7360
          /* It is even worse than that. The current reference may be to an
7361
          existing named group with a different number (so apparently not
7362
          recursive) but which later on is also attached to a group with the
7363
          current number. This can only happen if $(| has been previous
7364
          encountered. In that case, we allow yet more memory, just in case.
7365
          (Again, this is fixed "properly" in PCRE2. */
7366
7367
0
          if (cd->dupgroups) *lengthptr += 4 + 4*LINK_SIZE;
7368
7369
          /* Otherwise, check for recursion here. The name table does not exist
7370
          in the first pass; instead we must scan the list of names encountered
7371
          so far in order to get the number. If the name is not found, leave
7372
          the value of recno as 0 for a forward reference. */
7373
7374
          /* This patch (removing "else") fixes a problem when a reference is
7375
          to multiple identically named nested groups from within the nest.
7376
          Once again, it is not the "proper" fix, and it results in an
7377
          over-allocation of memory. */
7378
7379
          /* else */
7380
0
            {
7381
0
            ng = cd->named_groups;
7382
0
            for (i = 0; i < cd->names_found; i++, ng++)
7383
0
              {
7384
0
              if (namelen == ng->length &&
7385
0
                  STRNCMP_UC_UC(name, ng->name, namelen) == 0)
7386
0
                {
7387
0
                open_capitem *oc;
7388
0
                recno = ng->number;
7389
0
                if (is_recurse) break;
7390
0
                for (oc = cd->open_caps; oc != NULL; oc = oc->next)
7391
0
                  {
7392
0
                  if (oc->number == recno)
7393
0
                    {
7394
0
                    oc->flag = TRUE;
7395
0
                    break;
7396
0
                    }
7397
0
                  }
7398
0
                }
7399
0
              }
7400
0
            }
7401
0
          }
7402
7403
        /* In the real compile, search the name table. We check the name
7404
        first, and then check that we have reached the end of the name in the
7405
        table. That way, if the name is longer than any in the table, the
7406
        comparison will fail without reading beyond the table entry. */
7407
7408
0
        else
7409
0
          {
7410
0
          slot = cd->name_table;
7411
0
          for (i = 0; i < cd->names_found; i++)
7412
0
            {
7413
0
            if (STRNCMP_UC_UC(name, slot+IMM2_SIZE, namelen) == 0 &&
7414
0
                slot[IMM2_SIZE+namelen] == 0)
7415
0
              break;
7416
0
            slot += cd->name_entry_size;
7417
0
            }
7418
7419
0
          if (i < cd->names_found)
7420
0
            {
7421
0
            recno = GET2(slot, 0);
7422
0
            }
7423
0
          else
7424
0
            {
7425
0
            *errorcodeptr = ERR15;
7426
0
            goto FAILED;
7427
0
            }
7428
0
          }
7429
7430
        /* In both phases, for recursions, we can now go to the code than
7431
        handles numerical recursion. */
7432
7433
0
        if (is_recurse) goto HANDLE_RECURSION;
7434
7435
        /* In the second pass we must see if the name is duplicated. If so, we
7436
        generate a different opcode. */
7437
7438
0
        if (lengthptr == NULL && cd->dupnames)
7439
0
          {
7440
0
          int count = 1;
7441
0
          unsigned int index = i;
7442
0
          pcre_uchar *cslot = slot + cd->name_entry_size;
7443
7444
0
          for (i++; i < cd->names_found; i++)
7445
0
            {
7446
0
            if (STRCMP_UC_UC(slot + IMM2_SIZE, cslot + IMM2_SIZE) != 0) break;
7447
0
            count++;
7448
0
            cslot += cd->name_entry_size;
7449
0
            }
7450
7451
0
          if (count > 1)
7452
0
            {
7453
0
            if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcharflags = REQ_NONE;
7454
0
            previous = code;
7455
0
            item_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace;
7456
0
            *code++ = ((options & PCRE_CASELESS) != 0)? OP_DNREFI : OP_DNREF;
7457
0
            PUT2INC(code, 0, index);
7458
0
            PUT2INC(code, 0, count);
7459
7460
            /* Process each potentially referenced group. */
7461
7462
0
            for (; slot < cslot; slot += cd->name_entry_size)
7463
0
              {
7464
0
              open_capitem *oc;
7465
0
              recno = GET2(slot, 0);
7466
0
              cd->backref_map |= (recno < 32)? (1U << recno) : 1;
7467
0
              if (recno > cd->top_backref) cd->top_backref = recno;
7468
7469
              /* Check to see if this back reference is recursive, that it, it
7470
              is inside the group that it references. A flag is set so that the
7471
              group can be made atomic. */
7472
7473
0
              for (oc = cd->open_caps; oc != NULL; oc = oc->next)
7474
0
                {
7475
0
                if (oc->number == recno)
7476
0
                  {
7477
0
                  oc->flag = TRUE;
7478
0
                  break;
7479
0
                  }
7480
0
                }
7481
0
              }
7482
7483
0
            continue;  /* End of back ref handling */
7484
0
            }
7485
0
          }
7486
7487
        /* First pass, or a non-duplicated name. */
7488
7489
0
        goto HANDLE_REFERENCE;
7490
7491
7492
        /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */
7493
0
        case CHAR_R:              /* Recursion, same as (?0) */
7494
0
        recno = 0;
7495
0
        if (*(++ptr) != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS)
7496
0
          {
7497
0
          *errorcodeptr = ERR29;
7498
0
          goto FAILED;
7499
0
          }
7500
0
        goto HANDLE_RECURSION;
7501
7502
7503
        /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */
7504
0
        case CHAR_MINUS: case CHAR_PLUS:  /* Recursion or subroutine */
7505
0
        case CHAR_0: case CHAR_1: case CHAR_2: case CHAR_3: case CHAR_4:
7506
0
        case CHAR_5: case CHAR_6: case CHAR_7: case CHAR_8: case CHAR_9:
7507
0
          {
7508
0
          const pcre_uchar *called;
7509
0
          terminator = CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS;
7510
7511
          /* Come here from the \g<...> and \g'...' code (Oniguruma
7512
          compatibility). However, the syntax has been checked to ensure that
7513
          the ... are a (signed) number, so that neither ERR63 nor ERR29 will
7514
          be called on this path, nor with the jump to OTHER_CHAR_AFTER_QUERY
7515
          ever be taken. */
7516
7517
0
          HANDLE_NUMERICAL_RECURSION:
7518
7519
0
          if ((refsign = *ptr) == CHAR_PLUS)
7520
0
            {
7521
0
            ptr++;
7522
0
            if (!IS_DIGIT(*ptr))
7523
0
              {
7524
0
              *errorcodeptr = ERR63;
7525
0
              goto FAILED;
7526
0
              }
7527
0
            }
7528
0
          else if (refsign == CHAR_MINUS)
7529
0
            {
7530
0
            if (!IS_DIGIT(ptr[1]))
7531
0
              goto OTHER_CHAR_AFTER_QUERY;
7532
0
            ptr++;
7533
0
            }
7534
7535
0
          recno = 0;
7536
0
          while(IS_DIGIT(*ptr))
7537
0
            {
7538
0
            if (recno > INT_MAX / 10 - 1) /* Integer overflow */
7539
0
              {
7540
0
              while (IS_DIGIT(*ptr)) ptr++;
7541
0
              *errorcodeptr = ERR61;
7542
0
              goto FAILED;
7543
0
              }
7544
0
            recno = recno * 10 + *ptr++ - CHAR_0;
7545
0
            }
7546
7547
0
          if (*ptr != (pcre_uchar)terminator)
7548
0
            {
7549
0
            *errorcodeptr = ERR29;
7550
0
            goto FAILED;
7551
0
            }
7552
7553
0
          if (refsign == CHAR_MINUS)
7554
0
            {
7555
0
            if (recno == 0)
7556
0
              {
7557
0
              *errorcodeptr = ERR58;
7558
0
              goto FAILED;
7559
0
              }
7560
0
            recno = cd->bracount - recno + 1;
7561
0
            if (recno <= 0)
7562
0
              {
7563
0
              *errorcodeptr = ERR15;
7564
0
              goto FAILED;
7565
0
              }
7566
0
            }
7567
0
          else if (refsign == CHAR_PLUS)
7568
0
            {
7569
0
            if (recno == 0)
7570
0
              {
7571
0
              *errorcodeptr = ERR58;
7572
0
              goto FAILED;
7573
0
              }
7574
0
            recno += cd->bracount;
7575
0
            }
7576
7577
          /* Come here from code above that handles a named recursion */
7578
7579
0
          HANDLE_RECURSION:
7580
7581
0
          previous = code;
7582
0
          item_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace;
7583
0
          called = cd->start_code;
7584
7585
          /* When we are actually compiling, find the bracket that is being
7586
          referenced. Temporarily end the regex in case it doesn't exist before
7587
          this point. If we end up with a forward reference, first check that
7588
          the bracket does occur later so we can give the error (and position)
7589
          now. Then remember this forward reference in the workspace so it can
7590
          be filled in at the end. */
7591
7592
0
          if (lengthptr == NULL)
7593
0
            {
7594
0
            *code = OP_END;
7595
0
            if (recno != 0)
7596
0
              called = PRIV(find_bracket)(cd->start_code, utf, recno);
7597
7598
            /* Forward reference */
7599
7600
0
            if (called == NULL)
7601
0
              {
7602
0
              if (recno > cd->final_bracount)
7603
0
                {
7604
0
                *errorcodeptr = ERR15;
7605
0
                goto FAILED;
7606
0
                }
7607
7608
              /* Fudge the value of "called" so that when it is inserted as an
7609
              offset below, what it actually inserted is the reference number
7610
              of the group. Then remember the forward reference. */
7611
7612
0
              called = cd->start_code + recno;
7613
0
              if (cd->hwm >= cd->start_workspace + cd->workspace_size -
7614
0
                  WORK_SIZE_SAFETY_MARGIN)
7615
0
                {
7616
0
                *errorcodeptr = expand_workspace(cd);
7617
0
                if (*errorcodeptr != 0) goto FAILED;
7618
0
                }
7619
0
              PUTINC(cd->hwm, 0, (int)(code + 1 - cd->start_code));
7620
0
              }
7621
7622
            /* If not a forward reference, and the subpattern is still open,
7623
            this is a recursive call. We check to see if this is a left
7624
            recursion that could loop for ever, and diagnose that case. We
7625
            must not, however, do this check if we are in a conditional
7626
            subpattern because the condition might be testing for recursion in
7627
            a pattern such as /(?(R)a+|(?R)b)/, which is perfectly valid.
7628
            Forever loops are also detected at runtime, so those that occur in
7629
            conditional subpatterns will be picked up then. */
7630
7631
0
            else if (GET(called, 1) == 0 && cond_depth <= 0 &&
7632
0
                     could_be_empty(called, code, bcptr, utf, cd))
7633
0
              {
7634
0
              *errorcodeptr = ERR40;
7635
0
              goto FAILED;
7636
0
              }
7637
0
            }
7638
7639
          /* Insert the recursion/subroutine item. It does not have a set first
7640
          character (relevant if it is repeated, because it will then be
7641
          wrapped with ONCE brackets). */
7642
7643
0
          *code = OP_RECURSE;
7644
0
          PUT(code, 1, (int)(called - cd->start_code));
7645
0
          code += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
7646
0
          groupsetfirstchar = FALSE;
7647
0
          }
7648
7649
        /* Can't determine a first byte now */
7650
7651
0
        if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcharflags = REQ_NONE;
7652
0
        zerofirstchar = firstchar;
7653
0
        zerofirstcharflags = firstcharflags;
7654
0
        continue;
7655
7656
7657
        /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */
7658
0
        default:              /* Other characters: check option setting */
7659
0
        OTHER_CHAR_AFTER_QUERY:
7660
0
        set = unset = 0;
7661
0
        optset = &set;
7662
7663
0
        while (*ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS && *ptr != CHAR_COLON)
7664
0
          {
7665
0
          switch (*ptr++)
7666
0
            {
7667
0
            case CHAR_MINUS: optset = &unset; break;
7668
7669
0
            case CHAR_J:    /* Record that it changed in the external options */
7670
0
            *optset |= PCRE_DUPNAMES;
7671
0
            cd->external_flags |= PCRE_JCHANGED;
7672
0
            break;
7673
7674
0
            case CHAR_i: *optset |= PCRE_CASELESS; break;
7675
0
            case CHAR_m: *optset |= PCRE_MULTILINE; break;
7676
0
            case CHAR_s: *optset |= PCRE_DOTALL; break;
7677
0
            case CHAR_x: *optset |= PCRE_EXTENDED; break;
7678
0
            case CHAR_U: *optset |= PCRE_UNGREEDY; break;
7679
0
            case CHAR_X: *optset |= PCRE_EXTRA; break;
7680
7681
0
            default:  *errorcodeptr = ERR12;
7682
0
                      ptr--;    /* Correct the offset */
7683
0
                      goto FAILED;
7684
0
            }
7685
0
          }
7686
7687
        /* Set up the changed option bits, but don't change anything yet. */
7688
7689
0
        newoptions = (options | set) & (~unset);
7690
7691
        /* If the options ended with ')' this is not the start of a nested
7692
        group with option changes, so the options change at this level.
7693
        If we are not at the pattern start, reset the greedy defaults and the
7694
        case value for firstchar and reqchar. */
7695
7696
0
        if (*ptr == CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS)
7697
0
          {
7698
0
          greedy_default = ((newoptions & PCRE_UNGREEDY) != 0);
7699
0
          greedy_non_default = greedy_default ^ 1;
7700
0
          req_caseopt = ((newoptions & PCRE_CASELESS) != 0)? REQ_CASELESS:0;
7701
7702
          /* Change options at this level, and pass them back for use
7703
          in subsequent branches. */
7704
7705
0
          *optionsptr = options = newoptions;
7706
0
          previous = NULL;       /* This item can't be repeated */
7707
0
          continue;              /* It is complete */
7708
0
          }
7709
7710
        /* If the options ended with ':' we are heading into a nested group
7711
        with possible change of options. Such groups are non-capturing and are
7712
        not assertions of any kind. All we need to do is skip over the ':';
7713
        the newoptions value is handled below. */
7714
7715
0
        bravalue = OP_BRA;
7716
0
        ptr++;
7717
0
        }     /* End of switch for character following (? */
7718
0
      }       /* End of (? handling */
7719
7720
    /* Opening parenthesis not followed by '*' or '?'. If PCRE_NO_AUTO_CAPTURE
7721
    is set, all unadorned brackets become non-capturing and behave like (?:...)
7722
    brackets. */
7723
7724
0
    else if ((options & PCRE_NO_AUTO_CAPTURE) != 0)
7725
0
      {
7726
0
      bravalue = OP_BRA;
7727
0
      }
7728
7729
    /* Else we have a capturing group. */
7730
7731
0
    else
7732
0
      {
7733
0
      NUMBERED_GROUP:
7734
0
      cd->bracount += 1;
7735
0
      PUT2(code, 1+LINK_SIZE, cd->bracount);
7736
0
      skipbytes = IMM2_SIZE;
7737
0
      }
7738
7739
    /* Process nested bracketed regex. First check for parentheses nested too
7740
    deeply. */
7741
7742
0
    if ((cd->parens_depth += 1) > PARENS_NEST_LIMIT)
7743
0
      {
7744
0
      *errorcodeptr = ERR82;
7745
0
      goto FAILED;
7746
0
      }
7747
7748
    /* All assertions used not to be repeatable, but this was changed for Perl
7749
    compatibility. All kinds can now be repeated except for assertions that are
7750
    conditions (Perl also forbids these to be repeated). We copy code into a
7751
    non-register variable (tempcode) in order to be able to pass its address
7752
    because some compilers complain otherwise. At the start of a conditional
7753
    group whose condition is an assertion, cd->iscondassert is set. We unset it
7754
    here so as to allow assertions later in the group to be quantified. */
7755
7756
0
    if (bravalue >= OP_ASSERT && bravalue <= OP_ASSERTBACK_NOT &&
7757
0
        cd->iscondassert)
7758
0
      {
7759
0
      previous = NULL;
7760
0
      cd->iscondassert = FALSE;
7761
0
      }
7762
0
    else
7763
0
      {
7764
0
      previous = code;
7765
0
      item_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace;
7766
0
      }
7767
7768
0
    *code = bravalue;
7769
0
    tempcode = code;
7770
0
    tempreqvary = cd->req_varyopt;        /* Save value before bracket */
7771
0
    tempbracount = cd->bracount;          /* Save value before bracket */
7772
0
    length_prevgroup = 0;                 /* Initialize for pre-compile phase */
7773
7774
0
    if (!compile_regex(
7775
0
         newoptions,                      /* The complete new option state */
7776
0
         &tempcode,                       /* Where to put code (updated) */
7777
0
         &ptr,                            /* Input pointer (updated) */
7778
0
         errorcodeptr,                    /* Where to put an error message */
7779
0
         (bravalue == OP_ASSERTBACK ||
7780
0
          bravalue == OP_ASSERTBACK_NOT), /* TRUE if back assert */
7781
0
         reset_bracount,                  /* True if (?| group */
7782
0
         skipbytes,                       /* Skip over bracket number */
7783
0
         cond_depth +
7784
0
           ((bravalue == OP_COND)?1:0),   /* Depth of condition subpatterns */
7785
0
         &subfirstchar,                   /* For possible first char */
7786
0
         &subfirstcharflags,
7787
0
         &subreqchar,                     /* For possible last char */
7788
0
         &subreqcharflags,
7789
0
         bcptr,                           /* Current branch chain */
7790
0
         cd,                              /* Tables block */
7791
0
         (lengthptr == NULL)? NULL :      /* Actual compile phase */
7792
0
           &length_prevgroup              /* Pre-compile phase */
7793
0
         ))
7794
0
      goto FAILED;
7795
7796
0
    cd->parens_depth -= 1;
7797
7798
    /* If this was an atomic group and there are no capturing groups within it,
7799
    generate OP_ONCE_NC instead of OP_ONCE. */
7800
7801
0
    if (bravalue == OP_ONCE && cd->bracount <= tempbracount)
7802
0
      *code = OP_ONCE_NC;
7803
7804
0
    if (bravalue >= OP_ASSERT && bravalue <= OP_ASSERTBACK_NOT)
7805
0
      cd->assert_depth -= 1;
7806
7807
    /* At the end of compiling, code is still pointing to the start of the
7808
    group, while tempcode has been updated to point past the end of the group.
7809
    The pattern pointer (ptr) is on the bracket.
7810
7811
    If this is a conditional bracket, check that there are no more than
7812
    two branches in the group, or just one if it's a DEFINE group. We do this
7813
    in the real compile phase, not in the pre-pass, where the whole group may
7814
    not be available. */
7815
7816
0
    if (bravalue == OP_COND && lengthptr == NULL)
7817
0
      {
7818
0
      pcre_uchar *tc = code;
7819
0
      int condcount = 0;
7820
7821
0
      do {
7822
0
         condcount++;
7823
0
         tc += GET(tc,1);
7824
0
         }
7825
0
      while (*tc != OP_KET);
7826
7827
      /* A DEFINE group is never obeyed inline (the "condition" is always
7828
      false). It must have only one branch. */
7829
7830
0
      if (code[LINK_SIZE+1] == OP_DEF)
7831
0
        {
7832
0
        if (condcount > 1)
7833
0
          {
7834
0
          *errorcodeptr = ERR54;
7835
0
          goto FAILED;
7836
0
          }
7837
0
        bravalue = OP_DEF;   /* Just a flag to suppress char handling below */
7838
0
        }
7839
7840
      /* A "normal" conditional group. If there is just one branch, we must not
7841
      make use of its firstchar or reqchar, because this is equivalent to an
7842
      empty second branch. */
7843
7844
0
      else
7845
0
        {
7846
0
        if (condcount > 2)
7847
0
          {
7848
0
          *errorcodeptr = ERR27;
7849
0
          goto FAILED;
7850
0
          }
7851
0
        if (condcount == 1) subfirstcharflags = subreqcharflags = REQ_NONE;
7852
0
        }
7853
0
      }
7854
7855
    /* Error if hit end of pattern */
7856
7857
0
    if (*ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS)
7858
0
      {
7859
0
      *errorcodeptr = ERR14;
7860
0
      goto FAILED;
7861
0
      }
7862
7863
    /* In the pre-compile phase, update the length by the length of the group,
7864
    less the brackets at either end. Then reduce the compiled code to just a
7865
    set of non-capturing brackets so that it doesn't use much memory if it is
7866
    duplicated by a quantifier.*/
7867
7868
0
    if (lengthptr != NULL)
7869
0
      {
7870
0
      if (OFLOW_MAX - *lengthptr < length_prevgroup - 2 - 2*LINK_SIZE)
7871
0
        {
7872
0
        *errorcodeptr = ERR20;
7873
0
        goto FAILED;
7874
0
        }
7875
0
      *lengthptr += length_prevgroup - 2 - 2*LINK_SIZE;
7876
0
      code++;   /* This already contains bravalue */
7877
0
      PUTINC(code, 0, 1 + LINK_SIZE);
7878
0
      *code++ = OP_KET;
7879
0
      PUTINC(code, 0, 1 + LINK_SIZE);
7880
0
      break;    /* No need to waste time with special character handling */
7881
0
      }
7882
7883
    /* Otherwise update the main code pointer to the end of the group. */
7884
7885
0
    code = tempcode;
7886
7887
    /* For a DEFINE group, required and first character settings are not
7888
    relevant. */
7889
7890
0
    if (bravalue == OP_DEF) break;
7891
7892
    /* Handle updating of the required and first characters for other types of
7893
    group. Update for normal brackets of all kinds, and conditions with two
7894
    branches (see code above). If the bracket is followed by a quantifier with
7895
    zero repeat, we have to back off. Hence the definition of zeroreqchar and
7896
    zerofirstchar outside the main loop so that they can be accessed for the
7897
    back off. */
7898
7899
0
    zeroreqchar = reqchar;
7900
0
    zeroreqcharflags = reqcharflags;
7901
0
    zerofirstchar = firstchar;
7902
0
    zerofirstcharflags = firstcharflags;
7903
0
    groupsetfirstchar = FALSE;
7904
7905
0
    if (bravalue >= OP_ONCE)
7906
0
      {
7907
      /* If we have not yet set a firstchar in this branch, take it from the
7908
      subpattern, remembering that it was set here so that a repeat of more
7909
      than one can replicate it as reqchar if necessary. If the subpattern has
7910
      no firstchar, set "none" for the whole branch. In both cases, a zero
7911
      repeat forces firstchar to "none". */
7912
7913
0
      if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET)
7914
0
        {
7915
0
        if (subfirstcharflags >= 0)
7916
0
          {
7917
0
          firstchar = subfirstchar;
7918
0
          firstcharflags = subfirstcharflags;
7919
0
          groupsetfirstchar = TRUE;
7920
0
          }
7921
0
        else firstcharflags = REQ_NONE;
7922
0
        zerofirstcharflags = REQ_NONE;
7923
0
        }
7924
7925
      /* If firstchar was previously set, convert the subpattern's firstchar
7926
      into reqchar if there wasn't one, using the vary flag that was in
7927
      existence beforehand. */
7928
7929
0
      else if (subfirstcharflags >= 0 && subreqcharflags < 0)
7930
0
        {
7931
0
        subreqchar = subfirstchar;
7932
0
        subreqcharflags = subfirstcharflags | tempreqvary;
7933
0
        }
7934
7935
      /* If the subpattern set a required byte (or set a first byte that isn't
7936
      really the first byte - see above), set it. */
7937
7938
0
      if (subreqcharflags >= 0)
7939
0
        {
7940
0
        reqchar = subreqchar;
7941
0
        reqcharflags = subreqcharflags;
7942
0
        }
7943
0
      }
7944
7945
    /* For a forward assertion, we take the reqchar, if set, provided that the
7946
    group has also set a first char. This can be helpful if the pattern that
7947
    follows the assertion doesn't set a different char. For example, it's
7948
    useful for /(?=abcde).+/. We can't set firstchar for an assertion, however
7949
    because it leads to incorrect effect for patterns such as /(?=a)a.+/ when
7950
    the "real" "a" would then become a reqchar instead of a firstchar. This is
7951
    overcome by a scan at the end if there's no firstchar, looking for an
7952
    asserted first char. */
7953
7954
0
    else if (bravalue == OP_ASSERT && subreqcharflags >= 0 &&
7955
0
             subfirstcharflags >= 0)
7956
0
      {
7957
0
      reqchar = subreqchar;
7958
0
      reqcharflags = subreqcharflags;
7959
0
      }
7960
0
    break;     /* End of processing '(' */
7961
7962
7963
    /* ===================================================================*/
7964
    /* Handle metasequences introduced by \. For ones like \d, the ESC_ values
7965
    are arranged to be the negation of the corresponding OP_values in the
7966
    default case when PCRE_UCP is not set. For the back references, the values
7967
    are negative the reference number. Only back references and those types
7968
    that consume a character may be repeated. We can test for values between
7969
    ESC_b and ESC_Z for the latter; this may have to change if any new ones are
7970
    ever created. */
7971
7972
0
    case CHAR_BACKSLASH:
7973
0
    tempptr = ptr;
7974
0
    escape = check_escape(&ptr, &ec, errorcodeptr, cd->bracount, options, FALSE);
7975
0
    if (*errorcodeptr != 0) goto FAILED;
7976
7977
0
    if (escape == 0)                  /* The escape coded a single character */
7978
0
      c = ec;
7979
0
    else
7980
0
      {
7981
      /* For metasequences that actually match a character, we disable the
7982
      setting of a first character if it hasn't already been set. */
7983
7984
0
      if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET && escape > ESC_b && escape < ESC_Z)
7985
0
        firstcharflags = REQ_NONE;
7986
7987
      /* Set values to reset to if this is followed by a zero repeat. */
7988
7989
0
      zerofirstchar = firstchar;
7990
0
      zerofirstcharflags = firstcharflags;
7991
0
      zeroreqchar = reqchar;
7992
0
      zeroreqcharflags = reqcharflags;
7993
7994
      /* \g<name> or \g'name' is a subroutine call by name and \g<n> or \g'n'
7995
      is a subroutine call by number (Oniguruma syntax). In fact, the value
7996
      ESC_g is returned only for these cases. So we don't need to check for <
7997
      or ' if the value is ESC_g. For the Perl syntax \g{n} the value is
7998
      -n, and for the Perl syntax \g{name} the result is ESC_k (as
7999
      that is a synonym for a named back reference). */
8000
8001
0
      if (escape == ESC_g)
8002
0
        {
8003
0
        const pcre_uchar *p;
8004
0
        pcre_uint32 cf;
8005
8006
0
        item_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace;   /* Normally this is set when '(' is read */
8007
0
        terminator = (*(++ptr) == CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN)?
8008
0
          CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN : CHAR_APOSTROPHE;
8009
8010
        /* These two statements stop the compiler for warning about possibly
8011
        unset variables caused by the jump to HANDLE_NUMERICAL_RECURSION. In
8012
        fact, because we do the check for a number below, the paths that
8013
        would actually be in error are never taken. */
8014
8015
0
        skipbytes = 0;
8016
0
        reset_bracount = FALSE;
8017
8018
        /* If it's not a signed or unsigned number, treat it as a name. */
8019
8020
0
        cf = ptr[1];
8021
0
        if (cf != CHAR_PLUS && cf != CHAR_MINUS && !IS_DIGIT(cf))
8022
0
          {
8023
0
          is_recurse = TRUE;
8024
0
          goto NAMED_REF_OR_RECURSE;
8025
0
          }
8026
8027
        /* Signed or unsigned number (cf = ptr[1]) is known to be plus or minus
8028
        or a digit. */
8029
8030
0
        p = ptr + 2;
8031
0
        while (IS_DIGIT(*p)) p++;
8032
0
        if (*p != (pcre_uchar)terminator)
8033
0
          {
8034
0
          *errorcodeptr = ERR57;
8035
0
          goto FAILED;
8036
0
          }
8037
0
        ptr++;
8038
0
        goto HANDLE_NUMERICAL_RECURSION;
8039
0
        }
8040
8041
      /* \k<name> or \k'name' is a back reference by name (Perl syntax).
8042
      We also support \k{name} (.NET syntax).  */
8043
8044
0
      if (escape == ESC_k)
8045
0
        {
8046
0
        if ((ptr[1] != CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN &&
8047
0
          ptr[1] != CHAR_APOSTROPHE && ptr[1] != CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET))
8048
0
          {
8049
0
          *errorcodeptr = ERR69;
8050
0
          goto FAILED;
8051
0
          }
8052
0
        is_recurse = FALSE;
8053
0
        terminator = (*(++ptr) == CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN)?
8054
0
          CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN : (*ptr == CHAR_APOSTROPHE)?
8055
0
          CHAR_APOSTROPHE : CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET;
8056
0
        goto NAMED_REF_OR_RECURSE;
8057
0
        }
8058
8059
      /* Back references are handled specially; must disable firstchar if
8060
      not set to cope with cases like (?=(\w+))\1: which would otherwise set
8061
      ':' later. */
8062
8063
0
      if (escape < 0)
8064
0
        {
8065
0
        open_capitem *oc;
8066
0
        recno = -escape;
8067
8068
        /* Come here from named backref handling when the reference is to a
8069
        single group (i.e. not to a duplicated name. */
8070
8071
0
        HANDLE_REFERENCE:
8072
0
        if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET) zerofirstcharflags = firstcharflags = REQ_NONE;
8073
0
        previous = code;
8074
0
        item_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace;
8075
0
        *code++ = ((options & PCRE_CASELESS) != 0)? OP_REFI : OP_REF;
8076
0
        PUT2INC(code, 0, recno);
8077
0
        cd->backref_map |= (recno < 32)? (1U << recno) : 1;
8078
0
        if (recno > cd->top_backref) cd->top_backref = recno;
8079
8080
        /* Check to see if this back reference is recursive, that it, it
8081
        is inside the group that it references. A flag is set so that the
8082
        group can be made atomic. */
8083
8084
0
        for (oc = cd->open_caps; oc != NULL; oc = oc->next)
8085
0
          {
8086
0
          if (oc->number == recno)
8087
0
            {
8088
0
            oc->flag = TRUE;
8089
0
            break;
8090
0
            }
8091
0
          }
8092
0
        }
8093
8094
      /* So are Unicode property matches, if supported. */
8095
8096
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
8097
      else if (escape == ESC_P || escape == ESC_p)
8098
        {
8099
        BOOL negated;
8100
        unsigned int ptype = 0, pdata = 0;
8101
        if (!get_ucp(&ptr, &negated, &ptype, &pdata, errorcodeptr))
8102
          goto FAILED;
8103
        previous = code;
8104
        item_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace;
8105
        *code++ = ((escape == ESC_p) != negated)? OP_PROP : OP_NOTPROP;
8106
        *code++ = ptype;
8107
        *code++ = pdata;
8108
        }
8109
#else
8110
8111
      /* If Unicode properties are not supported, \X, \P, and \p are not
8112
      allowed. */
8113
8114
0
      else if (escape == ESC_X || escape == ESC_P || escape == ESC_p)
8115
0
        {
8116
0
        *errorcodeptr = ERR45;
8117
0
        goto FAILED;
8118
0
        }
8119
0
#endif
8120
8121
      /* For the rest (including \X when Unicode properties are supported), we
8122
      can obtain the OP value by negating the escape value in the default
8123
      situation when PCRE_UCP is not set. When it *is* set, we substitute
8124
      Unicode property tests. Note that \b and \B do a one-character
8125
      lookbehind, and \A also behaves as if it does. */
8126
8127
0
      else
8128
0
        {
8129
0
        if ((escape == ESC_b || escape == ESC_B || escape == ESC_A) &&
8130
0
             cd->max_lookbehind == 0)
8131
0
          cd->max_lookbehind = 1;
8132
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
8133
        if (escape >= ESC_DU && escape <= ESC_wu)
8134
          {
8135
          nestptr = ptr + 1;                   /* Where to resume */
8136
          ptr = substitutes[escape - ESC_DU] - 1;  /* Just before substitute */
8137
          }
8138
        else
8139
#endif
8140
        /* In non-UTF-8 mode, we turn \C into OP_ALLANY instead of OP_ANYBYTE
8141
        so that it works in DFA mode and in lookbehinds. */
8142
8143
0
          {
8144
0
          previous = (escape > ESC_b && escape < ESC_Z)? code : NULL;
8145
0
          item_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace;
8146
0
          *code++ = (!utf && escape == ESC_C)? OP_ALLANY : escape;
8147
0
          }
8148
0
        }
8149
0
      continue;
8150
0
      }
8151
8152
    /* We have a data character whose value is in c. In UTF-8 mode it may have
8153
    a value > 127. We set its representation in the length/buffer, and then
8154
    handle it as a data character. */
8155
8156
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF && !defined COMPILE_PCRE32
8157
    if (utf && c > MAX_VALUE_FOR_SINGLE_CHAR)
8158
      mclength = PRIV(ord2utf)(c, mcbuffer);
8159
    else
8160
#endif
8161
8162
0
     {
8163
0
     mcbuffer[0] = c;
8164
0
     mclength = 1;
8165
0
     }
8166
0
    goto ONE_CHAR;
8167
8168
8169
    /* ===================================================================*/
8170
    /* Handle a literal character. It is guaranteed not to be whitespace or #
8171
    when the extended flag is set. If we are in a UTF mode, it may be a
8172
    multi-unit literal character. */
8173
8174
0
    default:
8175
0
    NORMAL_CHAR:
8176
0
    mclength = 1;
8177
0
    mcbuffer[0] = c;
8178
8179
#ifdef SUPPORT_UTF
8180
    if (utf && HAS_EXTRALEN(c))
8181
      ACROSSCHAR(TRUE, ptr[1], mcbuffer[mclength++] = *(++ptr));
8182
#endif
8183
8184
    /* At this point we have the character's bytes in mcbuffer, and the length
8185
    in mclength. When not in UTF-8 mode, the length is always 1. */
8186
8187
0
    ONE_CHAR:
8188
0
    previous = code;
8189
0
    item_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace;
8190
8191
    /* For caseless UTF-8 mode when UCP support is available, check whether
8192
    this character has more than one other case. If so, generate a special
8193
    OP_PROP item instead of OP_CHARI. */
8194
8195
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
8196
    if (utf && (options & PCRE_CASELESS) != 0)
8197
      {
8198
      GETCHAR(c, mcbuffer);
8199
      if ((c = UCD_CASESET(c)) != 0)
8200
        {
8201
        *code++ = OP_PROP;
8202
        *code++ = PT_CLIST;
8203
        *code++ = c;
8204
        if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET)
8205
          firstcharflags = zerofirstcharflags = REQ_NONE;
8206
        break;
8207
        }
8208
      }
8209
#endif
8210
8211
    /* Caseful matches, or not one of the multicase characters. */
8212
8213
0
    *code++ = ((options & PCRE_CASELESS) != 0)? OP_CHARI : OP_CHAR;
8214
0
    for (c = 0; c < mclength; c++) *code++ = mcbuffer[c];
8215
8216
    /* Remember if \r or \n were seen */
8217
8218
0
    if (mcbuffer[0] == CHAR_CR || mcbuffer[0] == CHAR_NL)
8219
0
      cd->external_flags |= PCRE_HASCRORLF;
8220
8221
    /* Set the first and required bytes appropriately. If no previous first
8222
    byte, set it from this character, but revert to none on a zero repeat.
8223
    Otherwise, leave the firstchar value alone, and don't change it on a zero
8224
    repeat. */
8225
8226
0
    if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET)
8227
0
      {
8228
0
      zerofirstcharflags = REQ_NONE;
8229
0
      zeroreqchar = reqchar;
8230
0
      zeroreqcharflags = reqcharflags;
8231
8232
      /* If the character is more than one byte long, we can set firstchar
8233
      only if it is not to be matched caselessly. */
8234
8235
0
      if (mclength == 1 || req_caseopt == 0)
8236
0
        {
8237
0
        firstchar = mcbuffer[0];
8238
0
        firstcharflags = req_caseopt;
8239
8240
0
        if (mclength != 1)
8241
0
          {
8242
0
          reqchar = code[-1];
8243
0
          reqcharflags = cd->req_varyopt;
8244
0
          }
8245
0
        }
8246
0
      else firstcharflags = reqcharflags = REQ_NONE;
8247
0
      }
8248
8249
    /* firstchar was previously set; we can set reqchar only if the length is
8250
    1 or the matching is caseful. */
8251
8252
0
    else
8253
0
      {
8254
0
      zerofirstchar = firstchar;
8255
0
      zerofirstcharflags = firstcharflags;
8256
0
      zeroreqchar = reqchar;
8257
0
      zeroreqcharflags = reqcharflags;
8258
0
      if (mclength == 1 || req_caseopt == 0)
8259
0
        {
8260
0
        reqchar = code[-1];
8261
0
        reqcharflags = req_caseopt | cd->req_varyopt;
8262
0
        }
8263
0
      }
8264
8265
0
    break;            /* End of literal character handling */
8266
0
    }
8267
0
  }                   /* end of big loop */
8268
8269
8270
/* Control never reaches here by falling through, only by a goto for all the
8271
error states. Pass back the position in the pattern so that it can be displayed
8272
to the user for diagnosing the error. */
8273
8274
0
FAILED:
8275
0
*ptrptr = ptr;
8276
0
return FALSE;
8277
0
}
8278
8279
8280
8281
/*************************************************
8282
*     Compile sequence of alternatives           *
8283
*************************************************/
8284
8285
/* On entry, ptr is pointing past the bracket character, but on return it
8286
points to the closing bracket, or vertical bar, or end of string. The code
8287
variable is pointing at the byte into which the BRA operator has been stored.
8288
This function is used during the pre-compile phase when we are trying to find
8289
out the amount of memory needed, as well as during the real compile phase. The
8290
value of lengthptr distinguishes the two phases.
8291
8292
Arguments:
8293
  options           option bits, including any changes for this subpattern
8294
  codeptr           -> the address of the current code pointer
8295
  ptrptr            -> the address of the current pattern pointer
8296
  errorcodeptr      -> pointer to error code variable
8297
  lookbehind        TRUE if this is a lookbehind assertion
8298
  reset_bracount    TRUE to reset the count for each branch
8299
  skipbytes         skip this many bytes at start (for brackets and OP_COND)
8300
  cond_depth        depth of nesting for conditional subpatterns
8301
  firstcharptr      place to put the first required character
8302
  firstcharflagsptr place to put the first character flags, or a negative number
8303
  reqcharptr        place to put the last required character
8304
  reqcharflagsptr   place to put the last required character flags, or a negative number
8305
  bcptr             pointer to the chain of currently open branches
8306
  cd                points to the data block with tables pointers etc.
8307
  lengthptr         NULL during the real compile phase
8308
                    points to length accumulator during pre-compile phase
8309
8310
Returns:            TRUE on success
8311
*/
8312
8313
static BOOL
8314
compile_regex(int options, pcre_uchar **codeptr, const pcre_uchar **ptrptr,
8315
  int *errorcodeptr, BOOL lookbehind, BOOL reset_bracount, int skipbytes,
8316
  int cond_depth,
8317
  pcre_uint32 *firstcharptr, pcre_int32 *firstcharflagsptr,
8318
  pcre_uint32 *reqcharptr, pcre_int32 *reqcharflagsptr,
8319
  branch_chain *bcptr, compile_data *cd, int *lengthptr)
8320
0
{
8321
0
const pcre_uchar *ptr = *ptrptr;
8322
0
pcre_uchar *code = *codeptr;
8323
0
pcre_uchar *last_branch = code;
8324
0
pcre_uchar *start_bracket = code;
8325
0
pcre_uchar *reverse_count = NULL;
8326
0
open_capitem capitem;
8327
0
int capnumber = 0;
8328
0
pcre_uint32 firstchar, reqchar;
8329
0
pcre_int32 firstcharflags, reqcharflags;
8330
0
pcre_uint32 branchfirstchar, branchreqchar;
8331
0
pcre_int32 branchfirstcharflags, branchreqcharflags;
8332
0
int length;
8333
0
unsigned int orig_bracount;
8334
0
unsigned int max_bracount;
8335
0
branch_chain bc;
8336
0
size_t save_hwm_offset;
8337
8338
/* If set, call the external function that checks for stack availability. */
8339
8340
0
if (PUBL(stack_guard) != NULL && PUBL(stack_guard)())
8341
0
  {
8342
0
  *errorcodeptr= ERR85;
8343
0
  return FALSE;
8344
0
  }
8345
8346
/* Miscellaneous initialization */
8347
8348
0
bc.outer = bcptr;
8349
0
bc.current_branch = code;
8350
8351
0
firstchar = reqchar = 0;
8352
0
firstcharflags = reqcharflags = REQ_UNSET;
8353
8354
0
save_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace;
8355
8356
/* Accumulate the length for use in the pre-compile phase. Start with the
8357
length of the BRA and KET and any extra bytes that are required at the
8358
beginning. We accumulate in a local variable to save frequent testing of
8359
lenthptr for NULL. We cannot do this by looking at the value of code at the
8360
start and end of each alternative, because compiled items are discarded during
8361
the pre-compile phase so that the work space is not exceeded. */
8362
8363
0
length = 2 + 2*LINK_SIZE + skipbytes;
8364
8365
/* WARNING: If the above line is changed for any reason, you must also change
8366
the code that abstracts option settings at the start of the pattern and makes
8367
them global. It tests the value of length for (2 + 2*LINK_SIZE) in the
8368
pre-compile phase to find out whether anything has yet been compiled or not. */
8369
8370
/* If this is a capturing subpattern, add to the chain of open capturing items
8371
so that we can detect them if (*ACCEPT) is encountered. This is also used to
8372
detect groups that contain recursive back references to themselves. Note that
8373
only OP_CBRA need be tested here; changing this opcode to one of its variants,
8374
e.g. OP_SCBRAPOS, happens later, after the group has been compiled. */
8375
8376
0
if (*code == OP_CBRA)
8377
0
  {
8378
0
  capnumber = GET2(code, 1 + LINK_SIZE);
8379
0
  capitem.number = capnumber;
8380
0
  capitem.next = cd->open_caps;
8381
0
  capitem.flag = FALSE;
8382
0
  cd->open_caps = &capitem;
8383
0
  }
8384
8385
/* Offset is set zero to mark that this bracket is still open */
8386
8387
0
PUT(code, 1, 0);
8388
0
code += 1 + LINK_SIZE + skipbytes;
8389
8390
/* Loop for each alternative branch */
8391
8392
0
orig_bracount = max_bracount = cd->bracount;
8393
0
for (;;)
8394
0
  {
8395
  /* For a (?| group, reset the capturing bracket count so that each branch
8396
  uses the same numbers. */
8397
8398
0
  if (reset_bracount) cd->bracount = orig_bracount;
8399
8400
  /* Set up dummy OP_REVERSE if lookbehind assertion */
8401
8402
0
  if (lookbehind)
8403
0
    {
8404
0
    *code++ = OP_REVERSE;
8405
0
    reverse_count = code;
8406
0
    PUTINC(code, 0, 0);
8407
0
    length += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
8408
0
    }
8409
8410
  /* Now compile the branch; in the pre-compile phase its length gets added
8411
  into the length. */
8412
8413
0
  if (!compile_branch(&options, &code, &ptr, errorcodeptr, &branchfirstchar,
8414
0
        &branchfirstcharflags, &branchreqchar, &branchreqcharflags, &bc,
8415
0
        cond_depth, cd, (lengthptr == NULL)? NULL : &length))
8416
0
    {
8417
0
    *ptrptr = ptr;
8418
0
    return FALSE;
8419
0
    }
8420
8421
  /* Keep the highest bracket count in case (?| was used and some branch
8422
  has fewer than the rest. */
8423
8424
0
  if (cd->bracount > max_bracount) max_bracount = cd->bracount;
8425
8426
  /* In the real compile phase, there is some post-processing to be done. */
8427
8428
0
  if (lengthptr == NULL)
8429
0
    {
8430
    /* If this is the first branch, the firstchar and reqchar values for the
8431
    branch become the values for the regex. */
8432
8433
0
    if (*last_branch != OP_ALT)
8434
0
      {
8435
0
      firstchar = branchfirstchar;
8436
0
      firstcharflags = branchfirstcharflags;
8437
0
      reqchar = branchreqchar;
8438
0
      reqcharflags = branchreqcharflags;
8439
0
      }
8440
8441
    /* If this is not the first branch, the first char and reqchar have to
8442
    match the values from all the previous branches, except that if the
8443
    previous value for reqchar didn't have REQ_VARY set, it can still match,
8444
    and we set REQ_VARY for the regex. */
8445
8446
0
    else
8447
0
      {
8448
      /* If we previously had a firstchar, but it doesn't match the new branch,
8449
      we have to abandon the firstchar for the regex, but if there was
8450
      previously no reqchar, it takes on the value of the old firstchar. */
8451
8452
0
      if (firstcharflags >= 0 &&
8453
0
          (firstcharflags != branchfirstcharflags || firstchar != branchfirstchar))
8454
0
        {
8455
0
        if (reqcharflags < 0)
8456
0
          {
8457
0
          reqchar = firstchar;
8458
0
          reqcharflags = firstcharflags;
8459
0
          }
8460
0
        firstcharflags = REQ_NONE;
8461
0
        }
8462
8463
      /* If we (now or from before) have no firstchar, a firstchar from the
8464
      branch becomes a reqchar if there isn't a branch reqchar. */
8465
8466
0
      if (firstcharflags < 0 && branchfirstcharflags >= 0 && branchreqcharflags < 0)
8467
0
        {
8468
0
        branchreqchar = branchfirstchar;
8469
0
        branchreqcharflags = branchfirstcharflags;
8470
0
        }
8471
8472
      /* Now ensure that the reqchars match */
8473
8474
0
      if (((reqcharflags & ~REQ_VARY) != (branchreqcharflags & ~REQ_VARY)) ||
8475
0
          reqchar != branchreqchar)
8476
0
        reqcharflags = REQ_NONE;
8477
0
      else
8478
0
        {
8479
0
        reqchar = branchreqchar;
8480
0
        reqcharflags |= branchreqcharflags; /* To "or" REQ_VARY */
8481
0
        }
8482
0
      }
8483
8484
    /* If lookbehind, check that this branch matches a fixed-length string, and
8485
    put the length into the OP_REVERSE item. Temporarily mark the end of the
8486
    branch with OP_END. If the branch contains OP_RECURSE, the result is -3
8487
    because there may be forward references that we can't check here. Set a
8488
    flag to cause another lookbehind check at the end. Why not do it all at the
8489
    end? Because common, erroneous checks are picked up here and the offset of
8490
    the problem can be shown. */
8491
8492
0
    if (lookbehind)
8493
0
      {
8494
0
      int fixed_length;
8495
0
      *code = OP_END;
8496
0
      fixed_length = find_fixedlength(last_branch,  (options & PCRE_UTF8) != 0,
8497
0
        FALSE, cd, NULL);
8498
0
      DPRINTF(("fixed length = %d\n", fixed_length));
8499
0
      if (fixed_length == -3)
8500
0
        {
8501
0
        cd->check_lookbehind = TRUE;
8502
0
        }
8503
0
      else if (fixed_length < 0)
8504
0
        {
8505
0
        *errorcodeptr = (fixed_length == -2)? ERR36 :
8506
0
                        (fixed_length == -4)? ERR70: ERR25;
8507
0
        *ptrptr = ptr;
8508
0
        return FALSE;
8509
0
        }
8510
0
      else
8511
0
        {
8512
0
        if (fixed_length > cd->max_lookbehind)
8513
0
          cd->max_lookbehind = fixed_length;
8514
0
        PUT(reverse_count, 0, fixed_length);
8515
0
        }
8516
0
      }
8517
0
    }
8518
8519
  /* Reached end of expression, either ')' or end of pattern. In the real
8520
  compile phase, go back through the alternative branches and reverse the chain
8521
  of offsets, with the field in the BRA item now becoming an offset to the
8522
  first alternative. If there are no alternatives, it points to the end of the
8523
  group. The length in the terminating ket is always the length of the whole
8524
  bracketed item. Return leaving the pointer at the terminating char. */
8525
8526
0
  if (*ptr != CHAR_VERTICAL_LINE)
8527
0
    {
8528
0
    if (lengthptr == NULL)
8529
0
      {
8530
0
      int branch_length = (int)(code - last_branch);
8531
0
      do
8532
0
        {
8533
0
        int prev_length = GET(last_branch, 1);
8534
0
        PUT(last_branch, 1, branch_length);
8535
0
        branch_length = prev_length;
8536
0
        last_branch -= branch_length;
8537
0
        }
8538
0
      while (branch_length > 0);
8539
0
      }
8540
8541
    /* Fill in the ket */
8542
8543
0
    *code = OP_KET;
8544
0
    PUT(code, 1, (int)(code - start_bracket));
8545
0
    code += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
8546
8547
    /* If it was a capturing subpattern, check to see if it contained any
8548
    recursive back references. If so, we must wrap it in atomic brackets.
8549
    Because we are moving code along, we must ensure that any pending recursive
8550
    references are updated. In any event, remove the block from the chain. */
8551
8552
0
    if (capnumber > 0)
8553
0
      {
8554
0
      if (cd->open_caps->flag)
8555
0
        {
8556
0
        *code = OP_END;
8557
0
        adjust_recurse(start_bracket, 1 + LINK_SIZE,
8558
0
          (options & PCRE_UTF8) != 0, cd, save_hwm_offset);
8559
0
        memmove(start_bracket + 1 + LINK_SIZE, start_bracket,
8560
0
          IN_UCHARS(code - start_bracket));
8561
0
        *start_bracket = OP_ONCE;
8562
0
        code += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
8563
0
        PUT(start_bracket, 1, (int)(code - start_bracket));
8564
0
        *code = OP_KET;
8565
0
        PUT(code, 1, (int)(code - start_bracket));
8566
0
        code += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
8567
0
        length += 2 + 2*LINK_SIZE;
8568
0
        }
8569
0
      cd->open_caps = cd->open_caps->next;
8570
0
      }
8571
8572
    /* Retain the highest bracket number, in case resetting was used. */
8573
8574
0
    cd->bracount = max_bracount;
8575
8576
    /* Set values to pass back */
8577
8578
0
    *codeptr = code;
8579
0
    *ptrptr = ptr;
8580
0
    *firstcharptr = firstchar;
8581
0
    *firstcharflagsptr = firstcharflags;
8582
0
    *reqcharptr = reqchar;
8583
0
    *reqcharflagsptr = reqcharflags;
8584
0
    if (lengthptr != NULL)
8585
0
      {
8586
0
      if (OFLOW_MAX - *lengthptr < length)
8587
0
        {
8588
0
        *errorcodeptr = ERR20;
8589
0
        return FALSE;
8590
0
        }
8591
0
      *lengthptr += length;
8592
0
      }
8593
0
    return TRUE;
8594
0
    }
8595
8596
  /* Another branch follows. In the pre-compile phase, we can move the code
8597
  pointer back to where it was for the start of the first branch. (That is,
8598
  pretend that each branch is the only one.)
8599
8600
  In the real compile phase, insert an ALT node. Its length field points back
8601
  to the previous branch while the bracket remains open. At the end the chain
8602
  is reversed. It's done like this so that the start of the bracket has a
8603
  zero offset until it is closed, making it possible to detect recursion. */
8604
8605
0
  if (lengthptr != NULL)
8606
0
    {
8607
0
    code = *codeptr + 1 + LINK_SIZE + skipbytes;
8608
0
    length += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
8609
0
    }
8610
0
  else
8611
0
    {
8612
0
    *code = OP_ALT;
8613
0
    PUT(code, 1, (int)(code - last_branch));
8614
0
    bc.current_branch = last_branch = code;
8615
0
    code += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
8616
0
    }
8617
8618
0
  ptr++;
8619
0
  }
8620
/* Control never reaches here */
8621
0
}
8622
8623
8624
8625
8626
/*************************************************
8627
*          Check for anchored expression         *
8628
*************************************************/
8629
8630
/* Try to find out if this is an anchored regular expression. Consider each
8631
alternative branch. If they all start with OP_SOD or OP_CIRC, or with a bracket
8632
all of whose alternatives start with OP_SOD or OP_CIRC (recurse ad lib), then
8633
it's anchored. However, if this is a multiline pattern, then only OP_SOD will
8634
be found, because ^ generates OP_CIRCM in that mode.
8635
8636
We can also consider a regex to be anchored if OP_SOM starts all its branches.
8637
This is the code for \G, which means "match at start of match position, taking
8638
into account the match offset".
8639
8640
A branch is also implicitly anchored if it starts with .* and DOTALL is set,
8641
because that will try the rest of the pattern at all possible matching points,
8642
so there is no point trying again.... er ....
8643
8644
.... except when the .* appears inside capturing parentheses, and there is a
8645
subsequent back reference to those parentheses. We haven't enough information
8646
to catch that case precisely.
8647
8648
At first, the best we could do was to detect when .* was in capturing brackets
8649
and the highest back reference was greater than or equal to that level.
8650
However, by keeping a bitmap of the first 31 back references, we can catch some
8651
of the more common cases more precisely.
8652
8653
... A second exception is when the .* appears inside an atomic group, because
8654
this prevents the number of characters it matches from being adjusted.
8655
8656
Arguments:
8657
  code           points to start of expression (the bracket)
8658
  bracket_map    a bitmap of which brackets we are inside while testing; this
8659
                  handles up to substring 31; after that we just have to take
8660
                  the less precise approach
8661
  cd             points to the compile data block
8662
  atomcount      atomic group level
8663
8664
Returns:     TRUE or FALSE
8665
*/
8666
8667
static BOOL
8668
is_anchored(register const pcre_uchar *code, unsigned int bracket_map,
8669
  compile_data *cd, int atomcount)
8670
0
{
8671
0
do {
8672
0
   const pcre_uchar *scode = first_significant_code(
8673
0
     code + PRIV(OP_lengths)[*code], FALSE);
8674
0
   register int op = *scode;
8675
8676
   /* Non-capturing brackets */
8677
8678
0
   if (op == OP_BRA  || op == OP_BRAPOS ||
8679
0
       op == OP_SBRA || op == OP_SBRAPOS)
8680
0
     {
8681
0
     if (!is_anchored(scode, bracket_map, cd, atomcount)) return FALSE;
8682
0
     }
8683
8684
   /* Capturing brackets */
8685
8686
0
   else if (op == OP_CBRA  || op == OP_CBRAPOS ||
8687
0
            op == OP_SCBRA || op == OP_SCBRAPOS)
8688
0
     {
8689
0
     int n = GET2(scode, 1+LINK_SIZE);
8690
0
     int new_map = bracket_map | ((n < 32)? (1U << n) : 1);
8691
0
     if (!is_anchored(scode, new_map, cd, atomcount)) return FALSE;
8692
0
     }
8693
8694
   /* Positive forward assertion */
8695
8696
0
   else if (op == OP_ASSERT)
8697
0
     {
8698
0
     if (!is_anchored(scode, bracket_map, cd, atomcount)) return FALSE;
8699
0
     }
8700
8701
   /* Condition; not anchored if no second branch */
8702
8703
0
   else if (op == OP_COND)
8704
0
     {
8705
0
     if (scode[GET(scode,1)] != OP_ALT) return FALSE;
8706
0
     if (!is_anchored(scode, bracket_map, cd, atomcount)) return FALSE;
8707
0
     }
8708
8709
   /* Atomic groups */
8710
8711
0
   else if (op == OP_ONCE || op == OP_ONCE_NC)
8712
0
     {
8713
0
     if (!is_anchored(scode, bracket_map, cd, atomcount + 1))
8714
0
       return FALSE;
8715
0
     }
8716
8717
   /* .* is not anchored unless DOTALL is set (which generates OP_ALLANY) and
8718
   it isn't in brackets that are or may be referenced or inside an atomic
8719
   group. */
8720
8721
0
   else if ((op == OP_TYPESTAR || op == OP_TYPEMINSTAR ||
8722
0
             op == OP_TYPEPOSSTAR))
8723
0
     {
8724
0
     if (scode[1] != OP_ALLANY || (bracket_map & cd->backref_map) != 0 ||
8725
0
         atomcount > 0 || cd->had_pruneorskip)
8726
0
       return FALSE;
8727
0
     }
8728
8729
   /* Check for explicit anchoring */
8730
8731
0
   else if (op != OP_SOD && op != OP_SOM && op != OP_CIRC) return FALSE;
8732
8733
0
   code += GET(code, 1);
8734
0
   }
8735
0
while (*code == OP_ALT);   /* Loop for each alternative */
8736
0
return TRUE;
8737
0
}
8738
8739
8740
8741
/*************************************************
8742
*         Check for starting with ^ or .*        *
8743
*************************************************/
8744
8745
/* This is called to find out if every branch starts with ^ or .* so that
8746
"first char" processing can be done to speed things up in multiline
8747
matching and for non-DOTALL patterns that start with .* (which must start at
8748
the beginning or after \n). As in the case of is_anchored() (see above), we
8749
have to take account of back references to capturing brackets that contain .*
8750
because in that case we can't make the assumption. Also, the appearance of .*
8751
inside atomic brackets or in an assertion, or in a pattern that contains *PRUNE
8752
or *SKIP does not count, because once again the assumption no longer holds.
8753
8754
Arguments:
8755
  code           points to start of expression (the bracket)
8756
  bracket_map    a bitmap of which brackets we are inside while testing; this
8757
                  handles up to substring 31; after that we just have to take
8758
                  the less precise approach
8759
  cd             points to the compile data
8760
  atomcount      atomic group level
8761
  inassert       TRUE if in an assertion
8762
8763
Returns:         TRUE or FALSE
8764
*/
8765
8766
static BOOL
8767
is_startline(const pcre_uchar *code, unsigned int bracket_map,
8768
  compile_data *cd, int atomcount, BOOL inassert)
8769
0
{
8770
0
do {
8771
0
   const pcre_uchar *scode = first_significant_code(
8772
0
     code + PRIV(OP_lengths)[*code], FALSE);
8773
0
   register int op = *scode;
8774
8775
   /* If we are at the start of a conditional assertion group, *both* the
8776
   conditional assertion *and* what follows the condition must satisfy the test
8777
   for start of line. Other kinds of condition fail. Note that there may be an
8778
   auto-callout at the start of a condition. */
8779
8780
0
   if (op == OP_COND)
8781
0
     {
8782
0
     scode += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
8783
0
     if (*scode == OP_CALLOUT) scode += PRIV(OP_lengths)[OP_CALLOUT];
8784
0
     switch (*scode)
8785
0
       {
8786
0
       case OP_CREF:
8787
0
       case OP_DNCREF:
8788
0
       case OP_RREF:
8789
0
       case OP_DNRREF:
8790
0
       case OP_DEF:
8791
0
       case OP_FAIL:
8792
0
       return FALSE;
8793
8794
0
       default:     /* Assertion */
8795
0
       if (!is_startline(scode, bracket_map, cd, atomcount, TRUE)) return FALSE;
8796
0
       do scode += GET(scode, 1); while (*scode == OP_ALT);
8797
0
       scode += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
8798
0
       break;
8799
0
       }
8800
0
     scode = first_significant_code(scode, FALSE);
8801
0
     op = *scode;
8802
0
     }
8803
8804
   /* Non-capturing brackets */
8805
8806
0
   if (op == OP_BRA  || op == OP_BRAPOS ||
8807
0
       op == OP_SBRA || op == OP_SBRAPOS)
8808
0
     {
8809
0
     if (!is_startline(scode, bracket_map, cd, atomcount, inassert)) return FALSE;
8810
0
     }
8811
8812
   /* Capturing brackets */
8813
8814
0
   else if (op == OP_CBRA  || op == OP_CBRAPOS ||
8815
0
            op == OP_SCBRA || op == OP_SCBRAPOS)
8816
0
     {
8817
0
     int n = GET2(scode, 1+LINK_SIZE);
8818
0
     int new_map = bracket_map | ((n < 32)? (1U << n) : 1);
8819
0
     if (!is_startline(scode, new_map, cd, atomcount, inassert)) return FALSE;
8820
0
     }
8821
8822
   /* Positive forward assertions */
8823
8824
0
   else if (op == OP_ASSERT)
8825
0
     {
8826
0
     if (!is_startline(scode, bracket_map, cd, atomcount, TRUE)) return FALSE;
8827
0
     }
8828
8829
   /* Atomic brackets */
8830
8831
0
   else if (op == OP_ONCE || op == OP_ONCE_NC)
8832
0
     {
8833
0
     if (!is_startline(scode, bracket_map, cd, atomcount + 1, inassert)) return FALSE;
8834
0
     }
8835
8836
   /* .* means "start at start or after \n" if it isn't in atomic brackets or
8837
   brackets that may be referenced or an assertion, as long as the pattern does
8838
   not contain *PRUNE or *SKIP, because these break the feature. Consider, for
8839
   example, /.*?a(*PRUNE)b/ with the subject "aab", which matches "ab", i.e.
8840
   not at the start of a line. */
8841
8842
0
   else if (op == OP_TYPESTAR || op == OP_TYPEMINSTAR || op == OP_TYPEPOSSTAR)
8843
0
     {
8844
0
     if (scode[1] != OP_ANY || (bracket_map & cd->backref_map) != 0 ||
8845
0
         atomcount > 0 || cd->had_pruneorskip || inassert)
8846
0
       return FALSE;
8847
0
     }
8848
8849
   /* Check for explicit circumflex; anything else gives a FALSE result. Note
8850
   in particular that this includes atomic brackets OP_ONCE and OP_ONCE_NC
8851
   because the number of characters matched by .* cannot be adjusted inside
8852
   them. */
8853
8854
0
   else if (op != OP_CIRC && op != OP_CIRCM) return FALSE;
8855
8856
   /* Move on to the next alternative */
8857
8858
0
   code += GET(code, 1);
8859
0
   }
8860
0
while (*code == OP_ALT);  /* Loop for each alternative */
8861
0
return TRUE;
8862
0
}
8863
8864
8865
8866
/*************************************************
8867
*       Check for asserted fixed first char      *
8868
*************************************************/
8869
8870
/* During compilation, the "first char" settings from forward assertions are
8871
discarded, because they can cause conflicts with actual literals that follow.
8872
However, if we end up without a first char setting for an unanchored pattern,
8873
it is worth scanning the regex to see if there is an initial asserted first
8874
char. If all branches start with the same asserted char, or with a
8875
non-conditional bracket all of whose alternatives start with the same asserted
8876
char (recurse ad lib), then we return that char, with the flags set to zero or
8877
REQ_CASELESS; otherwise return zero with REQ_NONE in the flags.
8878
8879
Arguments:
8880
  code       points to start of expression (the bracket)
8881
  flags      points to the first char flags, or to REQ_NONE
8882
  inassert   TRUE if in an assertion
8883
8884
Returns:     the fixed first char, or 0 with REQ_NONE in flags
8885
*/
8886
8887
static pcre_uint32
8888
find_firstassertedchar(const pcre_uchar *code, pcre_int32 *flags,
8889
  BOOL inassert)
8890
0
{
8891
0
register pcre_uint32 c = 0;
8892
0
int cflags = REQ_NONE;
8893
8894
0
*flags = REQ_NONE;
8895
0
do {
8896
0
   pcre_uint32 d;
8897
0
   int dflags;
8898
0
   int xl = (*code == OP_CBRA || *code == OP_SCBRA ||
8899
0
             *code == OP_CBRAPOS || *code == OP_SCBRAPOS)? IMM2_SIZE:0;
8900
0
   const pcre_uchar *scode = first_significant_code(code + 1+LINK_SIZE + xl,
8901
0
     TRUE);
8902
0
   register pcre_uchar op = *scode;
8903
8904
0
   switch(op)
8905
0
     {
8906
0
     default:
8907
0
     return 0;
8908
8909
0
     case OP_BRA:
8910
0
     case OP_BRAPOS:
8911
0
     case OP_CBRA:
8912
0
     case OP_SCBRA:
8913
0
     case OP_CBRAPOS:
8914
0
     case OP_SCBRAPOS:
8915
0
     case OP_ASSERT:
8916
0
     case OP_ONCE:
8917
0
     case OP_ONCE_NC:
8918
0
     d = find_firstassertedchar(scode, &dflags, op == OP_ASSERT);
8919
0
     if (dflags < 0)
8920
0
       return 0;
8921
0
     if (cflags < 0) { c = d; cflags = dflags; } else if (c != d || cflags != dflags) return 0;
8922
0
     break;
8923
8924
0
     case OP_EXACT:
8925
0
     scode += IMM2_SIZE;
8926
     /* Fall through */
8927
8928
0
     case OP_CHAR:
8929
0
     case OP_PLUS:
8930
0
     case OP_MINPLUS:
8931
0
     case OP_POSPLUS:
8932
0
     if (!inassert) return 0;
8933
0
     if (cflags < 0) { c = scode[1]; cflags = 0; }
8934
0
       else if (c != scode[1]) return 0;
8935
0
     break;
8936
8937
0
     case OP_EXACTI:
8938
0
     scode += IMM2_SIZE;
8939
     /* Fall through */
8940
8941
0
     case OP_CHARI:
8942
0
     case OP_PLUSI:
8943
0
     case OP_MINPLUSI:
8944
0
     case OP_POSPLUSI:
8945
0
     if (!inassert) return 0;
8946
0
     if (cflags < 0) { c = scode[1]; cflags = REQ_CASELESS; }
8947
0
       else if (c != scode[1]) return 0;
8948
0
     break;
8949
0
     }
8950
8951
0
   code += GET(code, 1);
8952
0
   }
8953
0
while (*code == OP_ALT);
8954
8955
0
*flags = cflags;
8956
0
return c;
8957
0
}
8958
8959
8960
8961
/*************************************************
8962
*     Add an entry to the name/number table      *
8963
*************************************************/
8964
8965
/* This function is called between compiling passes to add an entry to the
8966
name/number table, maintaining alphabetical order. Checking for permitted
8967
and forbidden duplicates has already been done.
8968
8969
Arguments:
8970
  cd           the compile data block
8971
  name         the name to add
8972
  length       the length of the name
8973
  groupno      the group number
8974
8975
Returns:       nothing
8976
*/
8977
8978
static void
8979
add_name(compile_data *cd, const pcre_uchar *name, int length,
8980
  unsigned int groupno)
8981
0
{
8982
0
int i;
8983
0
pcre_uchar *slot = cd->name_table;
8984
8985
0
for (i = 0; i < cd->names_found; i++)
8986
0
  {
8987
0
  int crc = memcmp(name, slot+IMM2_SIZE, IN_UCHARS(length));
8988
0
  if (crc == 0 && slot[IMM2_SIZE+length] != 0)
8989
0
    crc = -1; /* Current name is a substring */
8990
8991
  /* Make space in the table and break the loop for an earlier name. For a
8992
  duplicate or later name, carry on. We do this for duplicates so that in the
8993
  simple case (when ?(| is not used) they are in order of their numbers. In all
8994
  cases they are in the order in which they appear in the pattern. */
8995
8996
0
  if (crc < 0)
8997
0
    {
8998
0
    memmove(slot + cd->name_entry_size, slot,
8999
0
      IN_UCHARS((cd->names_found - i) * cd->name_entry_size));
9000
0
    break;
9001
0
    }
9002
9003
  /* Continue the loop for a later or duplicate name */
9004
9005
0
  slot += cd->name_entry_size;
9006
0
  }
9007
9008
0
PUT2(slot, 0, groupno);
9009
0
memcpy(slot + IMM2_SIZE, name, IN_UCHARS(length));
9010
0
slot[IMM2_SIZE + length] = 0;
9011
0
cd->names_found++;
9012
0
}
9013
9014
9015
9016
/*************************************************
9017
*        Compile a Regular Expression            *
9018
*************************************************/
9019
9020
/* This function takes a string and returns a pointer to a block of store
9021
holding a compiled version of the expression. The original API for this
9022
function had no error code return variable; it is retained for backwards
9023
compatibility. The new function is given a new name.
9024
9025
Arguments:
9026
  pattern       the regular expression
9027
  options       various option bits
9028
  errorcodeptr  pointer to error code variable (pcre_compile2() only)
9029
                  can be NULL if you don't want a code value
9030
  errorptr      pointer to pointer to error text
9031
  erroroffset   ptr offset in pattern where error was detected
9032
  tables        pointer to character tables or NULL
9033
9034
Returns:        pointer to compiled data block, or NULL on error,
9035
                with errorptr and erroroffset set
9036
*/
9037
9038
#if defined COMPILE_PCRE8
9039
PCRE_EXP_DEFN pcre * PCRE_CALL_CONVENTION
9040
pcre_compile(const char *pattern, int options, const char **errorptr,
9041
  int *erroroffset, const unsigned char *tables)
9042
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16
9043
PCRE_EXP_DEFN pcre16 * PCRE_CALL_CONVENTION
9044
pcre16_compile(PCRE_SPTR16 pattern, int options, const char **errorptr,
9045
  int *erroroffset, const unsigned char *tables)
9046
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32
9047
PCRE_EXP_DEFN pcre32 * PCRE_CALL_CONVENTION
9048
pcre32_compile(PCRE_SPTR32 pattern, int options, const char **errorptr,
9049
  int *erroroffset, const unsigned char *tables)
9050
#endif
9051
0
{
9052
0
#if defined COMPILE_PCRE8
9053
0
return pcre_compile2(pattern, options, NULL, errorptr, erroroffset, tables);
9054
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16
9055
return pcre16_compile2(pattern, options, NULL, errorptr, erroroffset, tables);
9056
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32
9057
return pcre32_compile2(pattern, options, NULL, errorptr, erroroffset, tables);
9058
#endif
9059
0
}
9060
9061
9062
#if defined COMPILE_PCRE8
9063
PCRE_EXP_DEFN pcre * PCRE_CALL_CONVENTION
9064
pcre_compile2(const char *pattern, int options, int *errorcodeptr,
9065
  const char **errorptr, int *erroroffset, const unsigned char *tables)
9066
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16
9067
PCRE_EXP_DEFN pcre16 * PCRE_CALL_CONVENTION
9068
pcre16_compile2(PCRE_SPTR16 pattern, int options, int *errorcodeptr,
9069
  const char **errorptr, int *erroroffset, const unsigned char *tables)
9070
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32
9071
PCRE_EXP_DEFN pcre32 * PCRE_CALL_CONVENTION
9072
pcre32_compile2(PCRE_SPTR32 pattern, int options, int *errorcodeptr,
9073
  const char **errorptr, int *erroroffset, const unsigned char *tables)
9074
#endif
9075
0
{
9076
0
REAL_PCRE *re;
9077
0
int length = 1;  /* For final END opcode */
9078
0
pcre_int32 firstcharflags, reqcharflags;
9079
0
pcre_uint32 firstchar, reqchar;
9080
0
pcre_uint32 limit_match = PCRE_UINT32_MAX;
9081
0
pcre_uint32 limit_recursion = PCRE_UINT32_MAX;
9082
0
int newline;
9083
0
int errorcode = 0;
9084
0
int skipatstart = 0;
9085
0
BOOL utf;
9086
0
BOOL never_utf = FALSE;
9087
0
size_t size;
9088
0
pcre_uchar *code;
9089
0
const pcre_uchar *codestart;
9090
0
const pcre_uchar *ptr;
9091
0
compile_data compile_block;
9092
0
compile_data *cd = &compile_block;
9093
9094
/* This space is used for "compiling" into during the first phase, when we are
9095
computing the amount of memory that is needed. Compiled items are thrown away
9096
as soon as possible, so that a fairly large buffer should be sufficient for
9097
this purpose. The same space is used in the second phase for remembering where
9098
to fill in forward references to subpatterns. That may overflow, in which case
9099
new memory is obtained from malloc(). */
9100
9101
0
pcre_uchar cworkspace[COMPILE_WORK_SIZE];
9102
9103
/* This vector is used for remembering name groups during the pre-compile. In a
9104
similar way to cworkspace, it can be expanded using malloc() if necessary. */
9105
9106
0
named_group named_groups[NAMED_GROUP_LIST_SIZE];
9107
0
cd->named_groups = named_groups;
9108
0
cd->named_group_list_size = NAMED_GROUP_LIST_SIZE;
9109
9110
/* Set this early so that early errors get offset 0. */
9111
9112
0
ptr = (const pcre_uchar *)pattern;
9113
9114
/* We can't pass back an error message if errorptr is NULL; I guess the best we
9115
can do is just return NULL, but we can set a code value if there is a code
9116
pointer. */
9117
9118
0
if (errorptr == NULL)
9119
0
  {
9120
0
  if (errorcodeptr != NULL) *errorcodeptr = 99;
9121
0
  return NULL;
9122
0
  }
9123
9124
0
*errorptr = NULL;
9125
0
if (errorcodeptr != NULL) *errorcodeptr = ERR0;
9126
9127
/* However, we can give a message for this error */
9128
9129
0
if (erroroffset == NULL)
9130
0
  {
9131
0
  errorcode = ERR16;
9132
0
  goto PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN2;
9133
0
  }
9134
9135
0
*erroroffset = 0;
9136
9137
/* Set up pointers to the individual character tables */
9138
9139
0
if (tables == NULL) tables = PRIV(default_tables);
9140
0
cd->lcc = tables + lcc_offset;
9141
0
cd->fcc = tables + fcc_offset;
9142
0
cd->cbits = tables + cbits_offset;
9143
0
cd->ctypes = tables + ctypes_offset;
9144
9145
/* Check that all undefined public option bits are zero */
9146
9147
0
if ((options & ~PUBLIC_COMPILE_OPTIONS) != 0)
9148
0
  {
9149
0
  errorcode = ERR17;
9150
0
  goto PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN;
9151
0
  }
9152
9153
/* If PCRE_NEVER_UTF is set, remember it. */
9154
9155
0
if ((options & PCRE_NEVER_UTF) != 0) never_utf = TRUE;
9156
9157
/* Check for global one-time settings at the start of the pattern, and remember
9158
the offset for later. */
9159
9160
0
cd->external_flags = 0;   /* Initialize here for LIMIT_MATCH/RECURSION */
9161
9162
0
while (ptr[skipatstart] == CHAR_LEFT_PARENTHESIS &&
9163
0
       ptr[skipatstart+1] == CHAR_ASTERISK)
9164
0
  {
9165
0
  int newnl = 0;
9166
0
  int newbsr = 0;
9167
9168
/* For completeness and backward compatibility, (*UTFn) is supported in the
9169
relevant libraries, but (*UTF) is generic and always supported. Note that
9170
PCRE_UTF8 == PCRE_UTF16 == PCRE_UTF32. */
9171
9172
0
#ifdef COMPILE_PCRE8
9173
0
  if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_UTF8_RIGHTPAR, 5) == 0)
9174
0
    { skipatstart += 7; options |= PCRE_UTF8; continue; }
9175
0
#endif
9176
#ifdef COMPILE_PCRE16
9177
  if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_UTF16_RIGHTPAR, 6) == 0)
9178
    { skipatstart += 8; options |= PCRE_UTF16; continue; }
9179
#endif
9180
#ifdef COMPILE_PCRE32
9181
  if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_UTF32_RIGHTPAR, 6) == 0)
9182
    { skipatstart += 8; options |= PCRE_UTF32; continue; }
9183
#endif
9184
9185
0
  else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_UTF_RIGHTPAR, 4) == 0)
9186
0
    { skipatstart += 6; options |= PCRE_UTF8; continue; }
9187
0
  else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_UCP_RIGHTPAR, 4) == 0)
9188
0
    { skipatstart += 6; options |= PCRE_UCP; continue; }
9189
0
  else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_NO_AUTO_POSSESS_RIGHTPAR, 16) == 0)
9190
0
    { skipatstart += 18; options |= PCRE_NO_AUTO_POSSESS; continue; }
9191
0
  else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_NO_START_OPT_RIGHTPAR, 13) == 0)
9192
0
    { skipatstart += 15; options |= PCRE_NO_START_OPTIMIZE; continue; }
9193
9194
0
  else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_LIMIT_MATCH_EQ, 12) == 0)
9195
0
    {
9196
0
    pcre_uint32 c = 0;
9197
0
    int p = skipatstart + 14;
9198
0
    while (isdigit(ptr[p]))
9199
0
      {
9200
0
      if (c > PCRE_UINT32_MAX / 10 - 1) break;   /* Integer overflow */
9201
0
      c = c*10 + ptr[p++] - CHAR_0;
9202
0
      }
9203
0
    if (ptr[p++] != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS) break;
9204
0
    if (c < limit_match)
9205
0
      {
9206
0
      limit_match = c;
9207
0
      cd->external_flags |= PCRE_MLSET;
9208
0
      }
9209
0
    skipatstart = p;
9210
0
    continue;
9211
0
    }
9212
9213
0
  else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_LIMIT_RECURSION_EQ, 16) == 0)
9214
0
    {
9215
0
    pcre_uint32 c = 0;
9216
0
    int p = skipatstart + 18;
9217
0
    while (isdigit(ptr[p]))
9218
0
      {
9219
0
      if (c > PCRE_UINT32_MAX / 10 - 1) break;   /* Integer overflow check */
9220
0
      c = c*10 + ptr[p++] - CHAR_0;
9221
0
      }
9222
0
    if (ptr[p++] != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS) break;
9223
0
    if (c < limit_recursion)
9224
0
      {
9225
0
      limit_recursion = c;
9226
0
      cd->external_flags |= PCRE_RLSET;
9227
0
      }
9228
0
    skipatstart = p;
9229
0
    continue;
9230
0
    }
9231
9232
0
  if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_CR_RIGHTPAR, 3) == 0)
9233
0
    { skipatstart += 5; newnl = PCRE_NEWLINE_CR; }
9234
0
  else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_LF_RIGHTPAR, 3)  == 0)
9235
0
    { skipatstart += 5; newnl = PCRE_NEWLINE_LF; }
9236
0
  else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_CRLF_RIGHTPAR, 5)  == 0)
9237
0
    { skipatstart += 7; newnl = PCRE_NEWLINE_CR + PCRE_NEWLINE_LF; }
9238
0
  else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_ANY_RIGHTPAR, 4) == 0)
9239
0
    { skipatstart += 6; newnl = PCRE_NEWLINE_ANY; }
9240
0
  else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_ANYCRLF_RIGHTPAR, 8) == 0)
9241
0
    { skipatstart += 10; newnl = PCRE_NEWLINE_ANYCRLF; }
9242
9243
0
  else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_BSR_ANYCRLF_RIGHTPAR, 12) == 0)
9244
0
    { skipatstart += 14; newbsr = PCRE_BSR_ANYCRLF; }
9245
0
  else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_BSR_UNICODE_RIGHTPAR, 12) == 0)
9246
0
    { skipatstart += 14; newbsr = PCRE_BSR_UNICODE; }
9247
9248
0
  if (newnl != 0)
9249
0
    options = (options & ~PCRE_NEWLINE_BITS) | newnl;
9250
0
  else if (newbsr != 0)
9251
0
    options = (options & ~(PCRE_BSR_ANYCRLF|PCRE_BSR_UNICODE)) | newbsr;
9252
0
  else break;
9253
0
  }
9254
9255
/* PCRE_UTF(16|32) have the same value as PCRE_UTF8. */
9256
0
utf = (options & PCRE_UTF8) != 0;
9257
0
if (utf && never_utf)
9258
0
  {
9259
0
  errorcode = ERR78;
9260
0
  goto PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN2;
9261
0
  }
9262
9263
/* Can't support UTF unless PCRE has been compiled to include the code. The
9264
return of an error code from PRIV(valid_utf)() is a new feature, introduced in
9265
release 8.13. It is passed back from pcre_[dfa_]exec(), but at the moment is
9266
not used here. */
9267
9268
#ifdef SUPPORT_UTF
9269
if (utf && (options & PCRE_NO_UTF8_CHECK) == 0 &&
9270
     (errorcode = PRIV(valid_utf)((PCRE_PUCHAR)pattern, -1, erroroffset)) != 0)
9271
  {
9272
#if defined COMPILE_PCRE8
9273
  errorcode = ERR44;
9274
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16
9275
  errorcode = ERR74;
9276
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32
9277
  errorcode = ERR77;
9278
#endif
9279
  goto PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN2;
9280
  }
9281
#else
9282
0
if (utf)
9283
0
  {
9284
0
  errorcode = ERR32;
9285
0
  goto PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN;
9286
0
  }
9287
0
#endif
9288
9289
/* Can't support UCP unless PCRE has been compiled to include the code. */
9290
9291
0
#ifndef SUPPORT_UCP
9292
0
if ((options & PCRE_UCP) != 0)
9293
0
  {
9294
0
  errorcode = ERR67;
9295
0
  goto PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN;
9296
0
  }
9297
0
#endif
9298
9299
/* Check validity of \R options. */
9300
9301
0
if ((options & (PCRE_BSR_ANYCRLF|PCRE_BSR_UNICODE)) ==
9302
0
     (PCRE_BSR_ANYCRLF|PCRE_BSR_UNICODE))
9303
0
  {
9304
0
  errorcode = ERR56;
9305
0
  goto PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN;
9306
0
  }
9307
9308
/* Handle different types of newline. The three bits give seven cases. The
9309
current code allows for fixed one- or two-byte sequences, plus "any" and
9310
"anycrlf". */
9311
9312
0
switch (options & PCRE_NEWLINE_BITS)
9313
0
  {
9314
0
  case 0: newline = NEWLINE; break;   /* Build-time default */
9315
0
  case PCRE_NEWLINE_CR: newline = CHAR_CR; break;
9316
0
  case PCRE_NEWLINE_LF: newline = CHAR_NL; break;
9317
0
  case PCRE_NEWLINE_CR+
9318
0
       PCRE_NEWLINE_LF: newline = (CHAR_CR << 8) | CHAR_NL; break;
9319
0
  case PCRE_NEWLINE_ANY: newline = -1; break;
9320
0
  case PCRE_NEWLINE_ANYCRLF: newline = -2; break;
9321
0
  default: errorcode = ERR56; goto PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN;
9322
0
  }
9323
9324
0
if (newline == -2)
9325
0
  {
9326
0
  cd->nltype = NLTYPE_ANYCRLF;
9327
0
  }
9328
0
else if (newline < 0)
9329
0
  {
9330
0
  cd->nltype = NLTYPE_ANY;
9331
0
  }
9332
0
else
9333
0
  {
9334
0
  cd->nltype = NLTYPE_FIXED;
9335
0
  if (newline > 255)
9336
0
    {
9337
0
    cd->nllen = 2;
9338
0
    cd->nl[0] = (newline >> 8) & 255;
9339
0
    cd->nl[1] = newline & 255;
9340
0
    }
9341
0
  else
9342
0
    {
9343
0
    cd->nllen = 1;
9344
0
    cd->nl[0] = newline;
9345
0
    }
9346
0
  }
9347
9348
/* Maximum back reference and backref bitmap. The bitmap records up to 31 back
9349
references to help in deciding whether (.*) can be treated as anchored or not.
9350
*/
9351
9352
0
cd->top_backref = 0;
9353
0
cd->backref_map = 0;
9354
9355
/* Reflect pattern for debugging output */
9356
9357
0
DPRINTF(("------------------------------------------------------------------\n"));
9358
#ifdef PCRE_DEBUG
9359
print_puchar(stdout, (PCRE_PUCHAR)pattern);
9360
#endif
9361
0
DPRINTF(("\n"));
9362
9363
/* Pretend to compile the pattern while actually just accumulating the length
9364
of memory required. This behaviour is triggered by passing a non-NULL final
9365
argument to compile_regex(). We pass a block of workspace (cworkspace) for it
9366
to compile parts of the pattern into; the compiled code is discarded when it is
9367
no longer needed, so hopefully this workspace will never overflow, though there
9368
is a test for its doing so. */
9369
9370
0
cd->bracount = cd->final_bracount = 0;
9371
0
cd->names_found = 0;
9372
0
cd->name_entry_size = 0;
9373
0
cd->name_table = NULL;
9374
0
cd->dupnames = FALSE;
9375
0
cd->dupgroups = FALSE;
9376
0
cd->namedrefcount = 0;
9377
0
cd->start_code = cworkspace;
9378
0
cd->hwm = cworkspace;
9379
0
cd->iscondassert = FALSE;
9380
0
cd->start_workspace = cworkspace;
9381
0
cd->workspace_size = COMPILE_WORK_SIZE;
9382
0
cd->start_pattern = (const pcre_uchar *)pattern;
9383
0
cd->end_pattern = (const pcre_uchar *)(pattern + STRLEN_UC((const pcre_uchar *)pattern));
9384
0
cd->req_varyopt = 0;
9385
0
cd->parens_depth = 0;
9386
0
cd->assert_depth = 0;
9387
0
cd->max_lookbehind = 0;
9388
0
cd->external_options = options;
9389
0
cd->open_caps = NULL;
9390
9391
/* Now do the pre-compile. On error, errorcode will be set non-zero, so we
9392
don't need to look at the result of the function here. The initial options have
9393
been put into the cd block so that they can be changed if an option setting is
9394
found within the regex right at the beginning. Bringing initial option settings
9395
outside can help speed up starting point checks. */
9396
9397
0
ptr += skipatstart;
9398
0
code = cworkspace;
9399
0
*code = OP_BRA;
9400
9401
0
(void)compile_regex(cd->external_options, &code, &ptr, &errorcode, FALSE,
9402
0
  FALSE, 0, 0, &firstchar, &firstcharflags, &reqchar, &reqcharflags, NULL,
9403
0
  cd, &length);
9404
0
if (errorcode != 0) goto PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN;
9405
9406
0
DPRINTF(("end pre-compile: length=%d workspace=%d\n", length,
9407
0
  (int)(cd->hwm - cworkspace)));
9408
9409
0
if (length > MAX_PATTERN_SIZE)
9410
0
  {
9411
0
  errorcode = ERR20;
9412
0
  goto PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN;
9413
0
  }
9414
9415
/* Compute the size of the data block for storing the compiled pattern. Integer
9416
overflow should no longer be possible because nowadays we limit the maximum
9417
value of cd->names_found and cd->name_entry_size. */
9418
9419
0
size = sizeof(REAL_PCRE) +
9420
0
  (length + cd->names_found * cd->name_entry_size) * sizeof(pcre_uchar);
9421
9422
/* Get the memory. */
9423
9424
0
re = (REAL_PCRE *)(PUBL(malloc))(size);
9425
0
if (re == NULL)
9426
0
  {
9427
0
  errorcode = ERR21;
9428
0
  goto PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN;
9429
0
  }
9430
9431
/* Put in the magic number, and save the sizes, initial options, internal
9432
flags, and character table pointer. NULL is used for the default character
9433
tables. The nullpad field is at the end; it's there to help in the case when a
9434
regex compiled on a system with 4-byte pointers is run on another with 8-byte
9435
pointers. */
9436
9437
0
re->magic_number = MAGIC_NUMBER;
9438
0
re->size = (int)size;
9439
0
re->options = cd->external_options;
9440
0
re->flags = cd->external_flags;
9441
0
re->limit_match = limit_match;
9442
0
re->limit_recursion = limit_recursion;
9443
0
re->first_char = 0;
9444
0
re->req_char = 0;
9445
0
re->name_table_offset = sizeof(REAL_PCRE) / sizeof(pcre_uchar);
9446
0
re->name_entry_size = cd->name_entry_size;
9447
0
re->name_count = cd->names_found;
9448
0
re->ref_count = 0;
9449
0
re->tables = (tables == PRIV(default_tables))? NULL : tables;
9450
0
re->nullpad = NULL;
9451
#ifdef COMPILE_PCRE32
9452
re->dummy = 0;
9453
#else
9454
0
re->dummy1 = re->dummy2 = re->dummy3 = 0;
9455
0
#endif
9456
9457
/* The starting points of the name/number translation table and of the code are
9458
passed around in the compile data block. The start/end pattern and initial
9459
options are already set from the pre-compile phase, as is the name_entry_size
9460
field. Reset the bracket count and the names_found field. Also reset the hwm
9461
field; this time it's used for remembering forward references to subpatterns.
9462
*/
9463
9464
0
cd->final_bracount = cd->bracount;  /* Save for checking forward references */
9465
0
cd->parens_depth = 0;
9466
0
cd->assert_depth = 0;
9467
0
cd->bracount = 0;
9468
0
cd->max_lookbehind = 0;
9469
0
cd->name_table = (pcre_uchar *)re + re->name_table_offset;
9470
0
codestart = cd->name_table + re->name_entry_size * re->name_count;
9471
0
cd->start_code = codestart;
9472
0
cd->hwm = (pcre_uchar *)(cd->start_workspace);
9473
0
cd->iscondassert = FALSE;
9474
0
cd->req_varyopt = 0;
9475
0
cd->had_accept = FALSE;
9476
0
cd->had_pruneorskip = FALSE;
9477
0
cd->check_lookbehind = FALSE;
9478
0
cd->open_caps = NULL;
9479
9480
/* If any named groups were found, create the name/number table from the list
9481
created in the first pass. */
9482
9483
0
if (cd->names_found > 0)
9484
0
  {
9485
0
  int i = cd->names_found;
9486
0
  named_group *ng = cd->named_groups;
9487
0
  cd->names_found = 0;
9488
0
  for (; i > 0; i--, ng++)
9489
0
    add_name(cd, ng->name, ng->length, ng->number);
9490
0
  if (cd->named_group_list_size > NAMED_GROUP_LIST_SIZE)
9491
0
    (PUBL(free))((void *)cd->named_groups);
9492
0
  cd->named_group_list_size = 0;   /* So we don't free it twice */
9493
0
  }
9494
9495
/* Set up a starting, non-extracting bracket, then compile the expression. On
9496
error, errorcode will be set non-zero, so we don't need to look at the result
9497
of the function here. */
9498
9499
0
ptr = (const pcre_uchar *)pattern + skipatstart;
9500
0
code = (pcre_uchar *)codestart;
9501
0
*code = OP_BRA;
9502
0
(void)compile_regex(re->options, &code, &ptr, &errorcode, FALSE, FALSE, 0, 0,
9503
0
  &firstchar, &firstcharflags, &reqchar, &reqcharflags, NULL, cd, NULL);
9504
0
re->top_bracket = cd->bracount;
9505
0
re->top_backref = cd->top_backref;
9506
0
re->max_lookbehind = cd->max_lookbehind;
9507
0
re->flags = cd->external_flags | PCRE_MODE;
9508
9509
0
if (cd->had_accept)
9510
0
  {
9511
0
  reqchar = 0;              /* Must disable after (*ACCEPT) */
9512
0
  reqcharflags = REQ_NONE;
9513
0
  }
9514
9515
/* If not reached end of pattern on success, there's an excess bracket. */
9516
9517
0
if (errorcode == 0 && *ptr != CHAR_NULL) errorcode = ERR22;
9518
9519
/* Fill in the terminating state and check for disastrous overflow, but
9520
if debugging, leave the test till after things are printed out. */
9521
9522
0
*code++ = OP_END;
9523
9524
0
#ifndef PCRE_DEBUG
9525
0
if (code - codestart > length) errorcode = ERR23;
9526
0
#endif
9527
9528
#ifdef SUPPORT_VALGRIND
9529
/* If the estimated length exceeds the really used length, mark the extra
9530
allocated memory as unaddressable, so that any out-of-bound reads can be
9531
detected. */
9532
VALGRIND_MAKE_MEM_NOACCESS(code, (length - (code - codestart)) * sizeof(pcre_uchar));
9533
#endif
9534
9535
/* Fill in any forward references that are required. There may be repeated
9536
references; optimize for them, as searching a large regex takes time. */
9537
9538
0
if (cd->hwm > cd->start_workspace)
9539
0
  {
9540
0
  int prev_recno = -1;
9541
0
  const pcre_uchar *groupptr = NULL;
9542
0
  while (errorcode == 0 && cd->hwm > cd->start_workspace)
9543
0
    {
9544
0
    int offset, recno;
9545
0
    cd->hwm -= LINK_SIZE;
9546
0
    offset = GET(cd->hwm, 0);
9547
9548
    /* Check that the hwm handling hasn't gone wrong. This whole area is
9549
    rewritten in PCRE2 because there are some obscure cases. */
9550
9551
0
    if (offset == 0 || codestart[offset-1] != OP_RECURSE)
9552
0
      {
9553
0
      errorcode = ERR10;
9554
0
      break;
9555
0
      }
9556
9557
0
    recno = GET(codestart, offset);
9558
0
    if (recno != prev_recno)
9559
0
      {
9560
0
      groupptr = PRIV(find_bracket)(codestart, utf, recno);
9561
0
      prev_recno = recno;
9562
0
      }
9563
0
    if (groupptr == NULL) errorcode = ERR53;
9564
0
      else PUT(((pcre_uchar *)codestart), offset, (int)(groupptr - codestart));
9565
0
    }
9566
0
  }
9567
9568
/* If the workspace had to be expanded, free the new memory. Set the pointer to
9569
NULL to indicate that forward references have been filled in. */
9570
9571
0
if (cd->workspace_size > COMPILE_WORK_SIZE)
9572
0
  (PUBL(free))((void *)cd->start_workspace);
9573
0
cd->start_workspace = NULL;
9574
9575
/* Give an error if there's back reference to a non-existent capturing
9576
subpattern. */
9577
9578
0
if (errorcode == 0 && re->top_backref > re->top_bracket) errorcode = ERR15;
9579
9580
/* Unless disabled, check whether any single character iterators can be
9581
auto-possessified. The function overwrites the appropriate opcode values, so
9582
the type of the pointer must be cast. NOTE: the intermediate variable "temp" is
9583
used in this code because at least one compiler gives a warning about loss of
9584
"const" attribute if the cast (pcre_uchar *)codestart is used directly in the
9585
function call. */
9586
9587
0
if (errorcode == 0 && (options & PCRE_NO_AUTO_POSSESS) == 0)
9588
0
  {
9589
0
  pcre_uchar *temp = (pcre_uchar *)codestart;
9590
0
  auto_possessify(temp, utf, cd);
9591
0
  }
9592
9593
/* If there were any lookbehind assertions that contained OP_RECURSE
9594
(recursions or subroutine calls), a flag is set for them to be checked here,
9595
because they may contain forward references. Actual recursions cannot be fixed
9596
length, but subroutine calls can. It is done like this so that those without
9597
OP_RECURSE that are not fixed length get a diagnosic with a useful offset. The
9598
exceptional ones forgo this. We scan the pattern to check that they are fixed
9599
length, and set their lengths. */
9600
9601
0
if (errorcode == 0 && cd->check_lookbehind)
9602
0
  {
9603
0
  pcre_uchar *cc = (pcre_uchar *)codestart;
9604
9605
  /* Loop, searching for OP_REVERSE items, and process those that do not have
9606
  their length set. (Actually, it will also re-process any that have a length
9607
  of zero, but that is a pathological case, and it does no harm.) When we find
9608
  one, we temporarily terminate the branch it is in while we scan it. */
9609
9610
0
  for (cc = (pcre_uchar *)PRIV(find_bracket)(codestart, utf, -1);
9611
0
       cc != NULL;
9612
0
       cc = (pcre_uchar *)PRIV(find_bracket)(cc, utf, -1))
9613
0
    {
9614
0
    if (GET(cc, 1) == 0)
9615
0
      {
9616
0
      int fixed_length;
9617
0
      pcre_uchar *be = cc - 1 - LINK_SIZE + GET(cc, -LINK_SIZE);
9618
0
      int end_op = *be;
9619
0
      *be = OP_END;
9620
0
      fixed_length = find_fixedlength(cc, (re->options & PCRE_UTF8) != 0, TRUE,
9621
0
        cd, NULL);
9622
0
      *be = end_op;
9623
0
      DPRINTF(("fixed length = %d\n", fixed_length));
9624
0
      if (fixed_length < 0)
9625
0
        {
9626
0
        errorcode = (fixed_length == -2)? ERR36 :
9627
0
                    (fixed_length == -4)? ERR70 : ERR25;
9628
0
        break;
9629
0
        }
9630
0
      if (fixed_length > cd->max_lookbehind) cd->max_lookbehind = fixed_length;
9631
0
      PUT(cc, 1, fixed_length);
9632
0
      }
9633
0
    cc += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
9634
0
    }
9635
0
  }
9636
9637
/* Failed to compile, or error while post-processing */
9638
9639
0
if (errorcode != 0)
9640
0
  {
9641
0
  (PUBL(free))(re);
9642
0
  PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN:
9643
0
  if (cd->named_group_list_size > NAMED_GROUP_LIST_SIZE)
9644
0
    (PUBL(free))((void *)cd->named_groups);
9645
0
  *erroroffset = (int)(ptr - (const pcre_uchar *)pattern);
9646
0
  PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN2:
9647
0
  *errorptr = find_error_text(errorcode);
9648
0
  if (errorcodeptr != NULL) *errorcodeptr = errorcode;
9649
0
  return NULL;
9650
0
  }
9651
9652
/* If the anchored option was not passed, set the flag if we can determine that
9653
the pattern is anchored by virtue of ^ characters or \A or anything else, such
9654
as starting with non-atomic .* when DOTALL is set and there are no occurrences
9655
of *PRUNE or *SKIP.
9656
9657
Otherwise, if we know what the first byte has to be, save it, because that
9658
speeds up unanchored matches no end. If not, see if we can set the
9659
PCRE_STARTLINE flag. This is helpful for multiline matches when all branches
9660
start with ^. and also when all branches start with non-atomic .* for
9661
non-DOTALL matches when *PRUNE and SKIP are not present. */
9662
9663
0
if ((re->options & PCRE_ANCHORED) == 0)
9664
0
  {
9665
0
  if (is_anchored(codestart, 0, cd, 0)) re->options |= PCRE_ANCHORED;
9666
0
  else
9667
0
    {
9668
0
    if (firstcharflags < 0)
9669
0
      firstchar = find_firstassertedchar(codestart, &firstcharflags, FALSE);
9670
0
    if (firstcharflags >= 0)   /* Remove caseless flag for non-caseable chars */
9671
0
      {
9672
0
#if defined COMPILE_PCRE8
9673
0
      re->first_char = firstchar & 0xff;
9674
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16
9675
      re->first_char = firstchar & 0xffff;
9676
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32
9677
      re->first_char = firstchar;
9678
#endif
9679
0
      if ((firstcharflags & REQ_CASELESS) != 0)
9680
0
        {
9681
#if defined SUPPORT_UCP && !(defined COMPILE_PCRE8)
9682
        /* We ignore non-ASCII first chars in 8 bit mode. */
9683
        if (utf)
9684
          {
9685
          if (re->first_char < 128)
9686
            {
9687
            if (cd->fcc[re->first_char] != re->first_char)
9688
              re->flags |= PCRE_FCH_CASELESS;
9689
            }
9690
          else if (UCD_OTHERCASE(re->first_char) != re->first_char)
9691
            re->flags |= PCRE_FCH_CASELESS;
9692
          }
9693
        else
9694
#endif
9695
0
        if (MAX_255(re->first_char)
9696
0
            && cd->fcc[re->first_char] != re->first_char)
9697
0
          re->flags |= PCRE_FCH_CASELESS;
9698
0
        }
9699
9700
0
      re->flags |= PCRE_FIRSTSET;
9701
0
      }
9702
9703
0
    else if (is_startline(codestart, 0, cd, 0, FALSE)) re->flags |= PCRE_STARTLINE;
9704
0
    }
9705
0
  }
9706
9707
/* For an anchored pattern, we use the "required byte" only if it follows a
9708
variable length item in the regex. Remove the caseless flag for non-caseable
9709
bytes. */
9710
9711
0
if (reqcharflags >= 0 &&
9712
0
     ((re->options & PCRE_ANCHORED) == 0 || (reqcharflags & REQ_VARY) != 0))
9713
0
  {
9714
0
#if defined COMPILE_PCRE8
9715
0
  re->req_char = reqchar & 0xff;
9716
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16
9717
  re->req_char = reqchar & 0xffff;
9718
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32
9719
  re->req_char = reqchar;
9720
#endif
9721
0
  if ((reqcharflags & REQ_CASELESS) != 0)
9722
0
    {
9723
#if defined SUPPORT_UCP && !(defined COMPILE_PCRE8)
9724
    /* We ignore non-ASCII first chars in 8 bit mode. */
9725
    if (utf)
9726
      {
9727
      if (re->req_char < 128)
9728
        {
9729
        if (cd->fcc[re->req_char] != re->req_char)
9730
          re->flags |= PCRE_RCH_CASELESS;
9731
        }
9732
      else if (UCD_OTHERCASE(re->req_char) != re->req_char)
9733
        re->flags |= PCRE_RCH_CASELESS;
9734
      }
9735
    else
9736
#endif
9737
0
    if (MAX_255(re->req_char) && cd->fcc[re->req_char] != re->req_char)
9738
0
      re->flags |= PCRE_RCH_CASELESS;
9739
0
    }
9740
9741
0
  re->flags |= PCRE_REQCHSET;
9742
0
  }
9743
9744
/* Print out the compiled data if debugging is enabled. This is never the
9745
case when building a production library. */
9746
9747
#ifdef PCRE_DEBUG
9748
printf("Length = %d top_bracket = %d top_backref = %d\n",
9749
  length, re->top_bracket, re->top_backref);
9750
9751
printf("Options=%08x\n", re->options);
9752
9753
if ((re->flags & PCRE_FIRSTSET) != 0)
9754
  {
9755
  pcre_uchar ch = re->first_char;
9756
  const char *caseless =
9757
    ((re->flags & PCRE_FCH_CASELESS) == 0)? "" : " (caseless)";
9758
  if (PRINTABLE(ch)) printf("First char = %c%s\n", ch, caseless);
9759
    else printf("First char = \\x%02x%s\n", ch, caseless);
9760
  }
9761
9762
if ((re->flags & PCRE_REQCHSET) != 0)
9763
  {
9764
  pcre_uchar ch = re->req_char;
9765
  const char *caseless =
9766
    ((re->flags & PCRE_RCH_CASELESS) == 0)? "" : " (caseless)";
9767
  if (PRINTABLE(ch)) printf("Req char = %c%s\n", ch, caseless);
9768
    else printf("Req char = \\x%02x%s\n", ch, caseless);
9769
  }
9770
9771
#if defined COMPILE_PCRE8
9772
pcre_printint((pcre *)re, stdout, TRUE);
9773
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16
9774
pcre16_printint((pcre *)re, stdout, TRUE);
9775
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32
9776
pcre32_printint((pcre *)re, stdout, TRUE);
9777
#endif
9778
9779
/* This check is done here in the debugging case so that the code that
9780
was compiled can be seen. */
9781
9782
if (code - codestart > length)
9783
  {
9784
  (PUBL(free))(re);
9785
  *errorptr = find_error_text(ERR23);
9786
  *erroroffset = ptr - (pcre_uchar *)pattern;
9787
  if (errorcodeptr != NULL) *errorcodeptr = ERR23;
9788
  return NULL;
9789
  }
9790
#endif   /* PCRE_DEBUG */
9791
9792
/* Check for a pattern than can match an empty string, so that this information
9793
can be provided to applications. */
9794
9795
0
do
9796
0
  {
9797
0
  if (could_be_empty_branch(codestart, code, utf, cd, NULL))
9798
0
    {
9799
0
    re->flags |= PCRE_MATCH_EMPTY;
9800
0
    break;
9801
0
    }
9802
0
  codestart += GET(codestart, 1);
9803
0
  }
9804
0
while (*codestart == OP_ALT);
9805
9806
0
#if defined COMPILE_PCRE8
9807
0
return (pcre *)re;
9808
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16
9809
return (pcre16 *)re;
9810
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32
9811
return (pcre32 *)re;
9812
#endif
9813
0
}
9814
9815
/* End of pcre_compile.c */